Autocad

March 14, 2017 | Author: Brijraj Pandey | Category: N/A
Share Embed Donate


Short Description

autocad...

Description

AutoCAD® 2008

AutoCAD Customization Guide

January 2007

Copyright© 2007 Autodesk, Inc. All Rights Reserved This publication, or parts thereof, may not be reproduced in any form, by any method, for any purpose. AUTODESK, INC., MAKES NO WARRANTY, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE REGARDING THESE MATERIALS, AND MAKES SUCH MATERIALS AVAILABLE SOLELY ON AN "AS-IS" BASIS. IN NO EVENT SHALL AUTODESK, INC., BE LIABLE TO ANYONE FOR SPECIAL, COLLATERAL, INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES IN CONNECTION WITH OR ARISING OUT OF ACQUISITION OR USE OF THESE MATERIALS. THE SOLE AND EXCLUSIVE LIABILITY TO AUTODESK, INC., REGARDLESS OF THE FORM OF ACTION, SHALL NOT EXCEED THE PURCHASE PRICE, IF ANY, OF THE MATERIALS DESCRIBED HEREIN. Autodesk, Inc., reserves the right to revise and improve its products as it sees fit. This publication describes the state of the product at the time of publication, and may not reflect the product at all times in the future.

Autodesk Trademarks The following are registered trademarks or trademarks of Autodesk, Inc., in the USA and other countries: 3DEC (design/logo), 3December, 3December.com, 3ds Max, ActiveShapes, Actrix, ADI, Alias, Alias (swirl design/logo), AliasStudio, Alias|Wavefront (design/logo), ATC, AUGI, AutoCAD, AutoCAD Learning Assistance, AutoCAD LT, AutoCAD Simulator, AutoCAD SQL Extension, AutoCAD SQL Interface, Autodesk, Autodesk Envision, Autodesk Insight, Autodesk Intent, Autodesk Inventor, Autodesk Map, Autodesk MapGuide, Autodesk Streamline, AutoLISP, AutoSnap, AutoSketch, AutoTrack, Backdraft, Built with ObjectARX (logo), Burn, Buzzsaw, CAiCE, Can You Imagine, Character Studio, Cinestream, Civil 3D, Cleaner, Cleaner Central, ClearScale, Colour Warper, Combustion, Communication Specification, Constructware, Content Explorer, Create>what's>Next> (design/logo), Dancing Baby (image), DesignCenter, Design Doctor, Designer's Toolkit, DesignKids, DesignProf, DesignServer, DesignStudio, Design|Studio (design/logo), Design Your World, Design Your World (design/logo), DWF, DWG, DWG (logo), DWG TrueConvert, DWG TrueView, DXF, EditDV, Education by Design, Extending the Design Team, FBX, Filmbox, FMDesktop, GDX Driver, Gmax, Heads-up Design, Heidi, HOOPS, HumanIK, i-drop, iMOUT, Incinerator, IntroDV, Kaydara, Kaydara (design/logo), LocationLogic, Lustre, Maya, Mechanical Desktop, MotionBuilder, ObjectARX, ObjectDBX, Open Reality, PolarSnap, PortfolioWall, Powered with Autodesk Technology, Productstream, ProjectPoint, Reactor, RealDWG, Real-time Roto, Render Queue, Revit, Showcase, SketchBook, StudioTools, Topobase, Toxik, Visual, Visual Bridge, Visual Construction, Visual Drainage, Visual Hydro, Visual Landscape, Visual Roads, Visual Survey, Visual Syllabus, Visual Toolbox, Visual Tugboat, Visual LISP, Voice Reality, Volo, and Wiretap. The following are registered trademarks or trademarks of Autodesk Canada Co. in the USA and/or Canada and other countries: Backburner, Discreet, Fire, Flame, Flint, Frost, Inferno, Multi-Master Editing, River, Smoke, Sparks, Stone, Wire.

Third Party Trademarks All other brand names, product names or trademarks belong to their respective holders.

Third Party Software Program Credits ACIS Copyright © 1989-2001 Spatial Corp. Copyright © 1999-2000 The Apache Software Foundation. All rights reserved. This product includes software developed by the Apache Software Foundation (http://www.apache.org) subject to its license terms and conditions (http://xml.apache.org/dist/LICENSE.txt). Typefaces from the Bitstream® typeface library Copyright © 1992. HLM © Copyright D-Cubed Ltd. 1996-2006. HLM is a trademark of D-Cubed Ltd. AutoCAD® 2008 and AutoCAD LT® 2008 are produced under a license of data derived from DIC Color Guide® from Dainippon Ink and Chemicals, Inc. Copyright © Dainippon Ink and Chemicals, Inc. All rights reserved. DIC and DIC Color Guide are registered trademarks of Dainippon Ink and Chemicals, Inc. Portions of this software are based on the work of the Independent JPEG Group. Active Delivery™ 2.0 © 1999-2004 Inner Media, Inc. All rights reserved. ISYS and the ISYS logo are registered trademarks or trademarks of ISYS® Search Software Inc. Copyright © 1988-1997 Sam Leffler. Copyright © 1991-1997 Silicon Graphics, Inc. Copyright © Lingea s.r.o. 2006. The New Features Workshop contains Macromedia Flash™ Player software by Macromedia, Inc. Copyright © 1995-2005 Macromedia, Inc. All rights reserved. Macromedia® and Flash® are registered trademarks or trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States or other countries. Copyright © 1996-2006 Macrovision Corporation. All rights reserved. Copyright © 1996-2006 Microsoft Corporation. All rights reserved. Copyright © 2002 Joseph M. O'Leary. PANTONE® Colors displayed in the software application or in the user documentation may not match -PANTONE-identified standards. Consult current PANTONE Color Publications for accurate color. PANTONE® and other Pantone, Inc. trademarks are the property of Pantone, Inc. © Pantone, Inc., 2004. Pantone, Inc. is the copyright owner of color data and/or software which are licensed to Autodesk, Inc., to distribute for use only in combination with certain Autodesk software products. PANTONE Color Data and/or Software shall not be copied onto another disk or into memory unless as part of the execution of this Autodesk software product. Typefaces from Payne Loving Trust © 1992, 1996. All rights reserved. RAL DESIGN © RAL, Sankt Augustin, 2004. RAL CLASSIC © RAL, Sankt Augustin, 2004. Representation of the RAL Colors is done with the approval of RAL Deutsches Institut für Gütesicherung und Kennzeichnung e.V. (RAL German Institute for Quality Assurance and Certification, re. Assoc.), D-53757 Sankt Augustin.

This product includes code licensed from RSA Security, Inc. Some portions licensed from IBM are available at http://oss.software.ibm.com/icu4j/. The Sentry Spelling-Checker Engine Copyright © 1994-2003 Wintertree Software, Inc. Portions of this product include one or more Boost libraries. Use of the Boost libraries is subject to its license agreement http://www.boost.org/LICENSE_1_0.txt.

GOVERNMENT USE Use, duplication, or disclosure by the U.S. Government is subject to restrictions as set forth in FAR 12.212 (Commercial Computer Software-Restricted Rights) and DFAR 227.7202 (Rights in Technical Data and Computer Software), as applicable.

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10

Contents

Chapter 1

Customization Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1

Chapter 2

Basic Customization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 Overview of Customization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Organize Program and Support Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Overview of File Organization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Multiple Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Multiple Drawing Folders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Customize a Publish to Web Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Define Custom Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Define External Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Create Command Aliases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21

Chapter 3

Custom Linetypes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Overview of Linetype Definitions . Simple Custom Linetypes . . . . . Text in Custom Linetypes . . . . . Shapes in Custom Linetypes . . .

Chapter 4

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. . . .

. 24 . 25 . 28 . 31

Custom Hatch Patterns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Overview of Hatch Pattern Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Hatch Patterns with Dashed Lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39

v

Hatch Patterns with Multiple Lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43

Chapter 5

Customize the User Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Overview of Customize User Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Important Customization Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 How Customization Has Changed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Overview of the Customize User Interface Editor . . . . . . . . . 59 Work with Customization Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 Basics of Customization Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 Migrate and Transfer Customizations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Create and Load a Partial CUI File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Create an Enterprise CUI File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Customize Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Create, Edit, and Reuse Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Find Command Names and Search Strings . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 Control the Display of Command Labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Create Images for Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Create Status Line Help Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Create Macros . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Use Special Control Characters in Macros . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 Pause for User Input in Macros . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Provide International Support in Macros . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Use Built-in Commands in Macros . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Repeat Commands in Macros . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Use Single Object Selection Mode in Macros . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Use Macros to Swap User Interface Elements . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Use Conditional Expressions in Macros . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Use AutoLISP in Macros . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 Customize Toolbars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Create and Edit Toolbars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Add or Switch Toolbar Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 Create Pull-Down and Shortcut Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Create a Pull-Down Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Create a Shortcut Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Create Submenus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 Reference Pull-Down or Shortcut Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 Swap and Insert Pull-Down Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Customize Dashboard Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 Create and Edit Dashboard Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 Add or Switch Dashboard Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 Add Shortcut Keys and Temporary Override Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 Create a Double Click Action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 Customize Mouse Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 Accept Coordinate Entry in Button Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Customize Legacy Interface Elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Create Tablet Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221

vi | Contents

Customize Tablet Buttons . Create Screen Menus . . . . Create Image Tile Menus . . Load an AutoLISP File . . . . . . Customize Workspaces . . . . . . Customize User Interface FAQs .

Chapter 6

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. . . . . .

. 224 . 225 . 229 . 235 . 236 . 259

DIESEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Customize the Status Line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 Overview of the MODEMACRO System Variable . . . . . . . . . 266 Set MODEMACRO Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267 Set MODEMACRO with AutoLISP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 DIESEL Expressions in Macros . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272 Catalog of DIESEL Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276 + (addition) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276 - (subtraction) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 * (multiplication) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 / (division) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 = (equal to) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 < (less than) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 > (greater than) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 != (not equal to) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 = (greater than or equal to) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 and . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 angtos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 edtime . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285 eq . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 eval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288 fix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 getenv . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 getvar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290 if . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 nth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 or . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 rtos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 strlen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 substr . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 upper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296 xor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297 DIESEL Error Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298

Chapter 7

Slides and Command Scripts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301 Create Slides . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302

Contents | vii

Overview of Slides . . . . . . . . View Slides . . . . . . . . . . . . Create and View Slide Libraries . Create Command Scripts . . . . . . . Overview of Command Scripts . Run Scripts at Startup . . . . . . Run Slide Shows from Scripts . .

Chapter 8

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. . . . . . .

. 302 . 304 . 305 . 307 . 307 . 310 . 312

Introduction to Programming Interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . 317 ActiveX Automation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 Overview of ActiveX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 Define a Command to Start Your Application . . . . . . . . . . 320 Start an Application from a Menu or Toolbar . . . . . . . . . . . 321 AutoCAD VBA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 Overview of AutoCAD VBA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 Use AutoCAD VBA Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324 Automatically Load and Execute VBA Projects . . . . . . . . . . 326 AutoLISP and Visual LISP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 Overview of AutoLISP and Visual LISP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 Use AutoLISP Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 Automatically Load and Run AutoLISP Routines . . . . . . . . . 332 Overview of AutoLISP Automatic Loading . . . . . . . . . 332 The ACAD.LSP File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334 The ACADDOC.LSP File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335 The MNL File for an AutoLISP Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . 337 Prevent AutoLISP Errors When Loading Startup Files . . . . 338 S::STARTUP Function: Postinitialization Execution . . . . . 339 ObjectARX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341 Overview of ObjectARX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341 Use ObjectARX Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342 Automatically Load ObjectARX Applications . . . . . . . . . . . 344 .NET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 Overview of .NET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 Loading Managed Applications in AutoCAD . . . . . . . . . . . 346

Chapter 9

Shapes and Shape Fonts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349 Overview of Shape Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Create Shape Definition Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Shape Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vector Length and Direction Code . . . . . . . . . . Special Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Codes 0, 1, and 2: End of Shape and Draw Mode Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Codes 3 and 4: Size Control . . . . . . . . . . . Codes 5 and 6: Location Save/Restore . . . . . .

viii | Contents

. . . . .

. . . . .

. . . . .

. . . . .

. . . . .

. 350 . 352 . 352 . 354 . 356

. . . . . . 357 . . . . . . 358 . . . . . . 359

Code 7: Subshape . . . . . . . . . . . . . Codes 8 and 9: X-Y Displacements . . . . Code 00A: Octant Arc . . . . . . . . . . . Code 00B: Fractional Arc . . . . . . . . . Codes 00C and 00D: Bulge-Specified Arcs . Code 00E: Flag Vertical Text Command . . Text Font Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sample Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Extended Simplex Roman . . . . . . . . . Extended Standard Font for UNICODE . . Big Font Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Define a Big Font . . . . . . . . . . . . . Define an Extended Big Font File . . . . . Use Big Font Text in a Drawing . . . . . . Use a Big Font to Extend a Font . . . . . . Unicode Font Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . Superscripts and Subscripts in SHX Files . . . .

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

. 360 . 361 . 362 . 364 . 365 . 367 . 368 . 370 . 371 . 399 . 419 . 419 . 421 . 428 . 430 . 432 . 434

Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 437

Contents | ix

x

Customization Guide

1

The Customization Guide tells experienced users how to customize AutoCAD. To browse the Customization Guide, use the Contents tab on the left side of the Help window.

1

2

2

Basic Customization

Your dealer can offer you independently developed

In this chapter

applications that can further tailor AutoCAD to your needs.



Overview of Customization



Organize Program and Support Files



Customize a Publish to Web Template



Define Custom Commands

3

Overview of Customization AutoCAD can be customized in simple ways. For example, you can change the directory structure or move a button from one toolbar to another. If you want to change the interface further, you can edit the CUI file and use DIESEL code to create customizations with your own commands. You can also use a number of powerful application programming interfaces (APIs) to add to and modify AutoCAD to suit your needs. The list that follows is arranged from least to most complex: ■

Organize files. You can organize program, support, and drawing files. For example, you can make a separate folder for each project that includes only the support files that project needs.



Customize Tool Palettes. You can create a tool by dragging objects from your drawing onto a tool palette. You can create a tool palette by right-clicking on the Tool Palettes title bar and selecting New Palette. For information about customizing tool palettes, see “Customize Tool Palettes” in the User's Guide.



Create custom templates. Use templates to define common parameters when you publish a drawing using the Publish to Web wizard.



Run external programs and utilities from within AutoCAD. You can, for example, copy a disk or delete a file from within AutoCAD by adding the appropriate external command to the program parameters (PGP) file, acad.pgp.



Define command aliases. You can define simple abbreviations, or aliases, for frequently used commands from within AutoCAD by adding the command to the PGP file acad.pgp. For example, you might want to start the BLOCK command by entering b.



Create custom linetypes, hatch patterns, shapes, and text fonts. You can create linetypes, hatch patterns, shapes, and text fonts that conform to your company standards and working methods.



Customize the user interface. The CUI file controls many aspects of the user interface, including the behavior of your pointing device buttons and the functionality and appearance of pull-down, tablet, and image tile menus, toolbars, and accelerator keys. You can edit or create a CUI file to add commands or combine commands and assign them to a menu, toolbar, or other location.

4 | Chapter 2 Basic Customization



Customize the status line. You can use the DIESEL string expression language and the MODEMACRO system variable to provide additional information at the status line, such as the date and time, system variable settings, or retrievable information using AutoLISP®.



Automate repetitive tasks by writing scripts. A script is an ASCII text file containing commands that are processed like a batch file when you run the script. For example, if a set of drawings needs to be plotted a certain way, you can write a script that opens each drawing, hides and displays various layers, and issues PLOT commands. You can use scripts with slides to create automated presentations like those used at trade shows. A slide is a “snapshot” of the drawing area that cannot be edited. Slides can also be used in image tile menus and dialog boxes.

In addition to the methods described in the Customization Guide, there are application programming interfaces (APIs) available for customizing AutoCAD. Introduction to Programming Interfaces (page 317) briefly describes these APIs and provides cross-references to more information. See also: ■

“Organize Program and Support Files”



“Customize Toolbars”



“Customize a Publish to Web Template”



“Create Command Aliases”



“Custom Linetypes”



“Custom Hatch Patterns ”



“Customize the User Interface”



“DIESEL”



“Customize the Status Line ”



“Introduction to Programming Interfaces”



“Slides and Command Scripts”

Overview of Customization | 5

Quick Reference Commands CUSTOMIZE Customizes tool palettes CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts REDEFINE Restores AutoCAD internal commands overridden by UNDEFINE UNDEFINE Allows an application-defined command to override an internal command

System Variables TOOLTIPS Controls the display of tooltips on toolbars

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Organize Program and Support Files You can change the default directory structure for the program and support files to suit your needs.

6 | Chapter 2 Basic Customization

Overview of File Organization AutoCAD uses support files for purposes such as storing customization definitions, loading AutoLISP and ObjectARX applications, and describing text fonts. The default directory structure for the AutoCAD program and support files is designed to efficiently organize those files into logical groups. If this organization does not suit your needs, you can change it. However, some applications look for certain files in specific locations, and you should verify that your modifications do not conflict with the requirements of those applications. Without the full path, including drive and directory, AutoCAD can locate only those files that are found in the library search path. The location of the support folder changed in AutoCAD 2007. The location of local customizable files is stored in the LOCALROOTPREFIX system variable. The location of roamable customizable files is stored in the ROAMABLEROOTPREFIX system variable. If a network supports roaming, customizable files in the user's roaming profile are available on the machine the user is logged onto. The following LISP script creates the CUSTFILES command, which launches Windows® Explorer in the correct folder. (defun c:custfiles () (command "shell" (strcat "explorer \"" (getvar "roamablerootprefix") "\"") ) (princ) )

Library Search Path The library search path specifies where the program searches for files when you do not specify a full path name, as follows: ■

Current directory. (This is typically determined by the “Start In” setting in your shortcut icon.)



Directory that contains the current drawing file.



Directories listed in the search path specified on the Files tab in OPTIONS. (See Specify Search Paths and File Locations in the User's Guide.)



Directory that contains the AutoCAD program files.

Overview of File Organization | 7

Depending on the current environment, two or more directories may be the same. If a file is not in this search path, you must specify both its path name and file name before AutoCAD can find it. For example, if you want to insert the part5.dwg drawing into your current drawing and it is not in the library search path, you must specify its full path name, as shown here: Command: insert Enter block name or [?]: /files2/olddwgs/part5 If the drawing exists in that location, AutoCAD prompts you to finish the INSERT command in the usual manner.

Directory Structure AutoCAD uses tree-structured directories and subdirectories. It is recommended that you keep supplemental files (such as AutoLISP applications and customization files) separate from the AutoCAD program and support files. This makes it easier to track possible conflicts and to upgrade each application without affecting the others. The default location for AutoCAD is in the Program Files folder. You can create a new directory on the same level (for example, /AcadApps) and store your custom AutoLISP and VBA macros, customization files, and other third-party applications in subdirectories on the next level. If you want to maintain multiple drawing directories (for separate job files), you can create a directory such as /AcadJobs with subdirectories for each job.

Command Search Procedure When you enter a command, AutoCAD goes through a series of steps to evaluate the validity of the command name. A command can be a built-in command or system variable, an external command or alias defined in the acad.pgp file, or a user-defined AutoLISP command. Commands can also be defined by ObjectARX applications or a device driver command. You can enter a command on the command prompt or choose a command from the appropriate menu. Commands can also be entered from a script file or by an AutoLISP or ObjectARX application. The following list describes the search order AutoCAD uses to validate a command name. 1 If the input is a null response (SPACEBAR or ENTER), AutoCAD uses the name of the last command issued. HELP is the default.

8 | Chapter 2 Basic Customization

2 AutoCAD checks the command name against the list of built-in commands. If the command is in the list and is not preceded by a period (.), AutoCAD then checks the command against a list of undefined commands. If the command is undefined, the search continues. Otherwise, the command is run, unless another reason prevents it from doing so. Running it transparently or in Perspective mode might be impossible. 3 AutoCAD checks the command name against the names of commands defined by a device driver, and then by those defined by the display driver. 4 AutoCAD checks the command name against the external commands defined in the program parameters file (acad.pgp). If the command name corresponds to a defined external command, that command runs, and the search is complete. 5 AutoCAD checks the command name against the list of commands defined by AutoLISP or ObjectARX applications. At this point, an autoloaded command is loaded. 6 AutoCAD checks the command name against the list of system variables. If the command name is in the list, AutoCAD executes the SETVAR command, using the input as the variable name. 7 If the command name corresponds to a command alias defined in the program parameters file, AutoCAD uses the expanded command name and continues the search, starting a new search against the list of built-in commands. 8 If all the preceding steps fail, the search terminates with a warning message about illegal command names. See also: ■

Overview of AutoLISP Automatic Loading (page 332)



“Specify Search Paths and File Locations” in the User's Guide

Overview of File Organization | 9

Quick Reference Commands OPTIONS Customizes the program settings

System Variables LOCALROOTPREFIX Stores the full path to the root folder where local customizable files were installed ROAMABLEROOTPREFIX Stores the full path to the root folder where roamable customizable files were installed

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Multiple Configurations If you use more than one pointing device or use different plotters, you can set up more than one configuration file to make it easy to switch between devices. When you configure AutoCAD for a pointing device and plotter drivers, the information you supply is recorded in a configuration file. The default location of the acad2008.cfg configuration file is listed in the Options dialog box, Files tab, under Help and Miscellaneous File Names, but you can specify an alternative path or file name. Typically, only a single configuration is necessary, but you may need multiple configurations. For example, if you use a mouse for most of your work but occasionally require a large digitizing tablet, you can set up your system to handle multiple configurations rather than reconfiguring each time you change a device.

10 | Chapter 2 Basic Customization

The configuration file stores the values of many AutoCAD system variables and the configuration options defined in the Options dialog box. If you want different settings for these system variables and operating parameters, you can save those values to different configuration files. For a list of the system variables and where they are stored, see System Variables in the Command Reference. To take advantage of multiple configurations, you must set up AutoCAD to use different configuration files. Use the /c switch to specify alternative configuration files at startup. See also: ■

“Customize Startup” in the User's Guide

Quick Reference Commands OPTIONS Customizes the program settings

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Multiple Drawing Folders Keeping your drawing and other associated files in separate directories makes it easier to perform basic file maintenance. Keeping your drawing files and other associated files in separate directories makes it easier to perform basic file maintenance. The scenario described in

Multiple Drawing Folders | 11

this topic is based on the sample directory structure described in Overview of File Organization (page 7), but you can expand or alter it to meet your needs. You can set up the /AcadJobs directory to contain your drawing subdirectories. The drawing subdirectories can contain other subdirectories that hold related support files for a particular drawing type or job. The /AcadJobs/Job1/Support directory can contain blocks and AutoLISP files specific to the drawing files in /AcadJobs/Job1. Specifying support (with no path prefix) in the Support path adds the support directory within the current directory to the Support path. Notice that if you use the Options dialog box to specify a directory, AutoCAD creates a hard-coded path to that directory. To use the relative naming convention previously described, you must specify the Support path with the /s switch on the command line. See “Customize Startup” in the User's Guide. To make sure that the required drawing directory is the current directory when you start AutoCAD, and that all files and subdirectories in that directory are easily accessible, you can create a program icon or a Start menu item that specifies the correct working directory for each job. This functionality works only if you set the AutoCAD system variable REMEMBERFOLDERS to 0. You can use a batch program as an alternative to using icons or menus. With batch programs you can create new job directories automatically. The following batch program verifies that a specified directory exists, sets that directory to be current, and then runs AutoCAD. @echo off C: if exist \AcadJobs\Jobs\%1 goto RUNACAD echo. echo *** Creating \AcadJobs\Jobs\%1 echo *** Press Ctrl+C to cancel. echo. pause mkdir \AcadJobs\Jobs\%1 :RUNACAD cd \AcadJobs\Jobs\%1 start C:\ AutoCAD\acad.exe

Using an ASCII text editor (such as Notepad), save the batch program to a file named acad.bat. Be sure to change the drive and directory names to match those on your system. Place this file in a directory that is on your system search path (for example, C:\winnt). You can run this batch program using the Run command on the Start menu or by double-clicking the file in Explorer. If you saved the file as acad.bat, use the following syntax: acadjobname

12 | Chapter 2 Basic Customization

where jobname is the name of the job directory to make current.

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables CMDECHO Controls whether prompts and input are echoed during the AutoLISP command function

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Customize a Publish to Web Template You can create customized templates to use in the Publish to Web wizard by modifying one of the Publish to Web template (PWT) files provided. Use any HTML editor or text editor. To create a custom template, add or modify any of the following elements: ■

Images



Text



Hyperlinks



Color



Title



Video, animation, and so on

Customize a Publish to Web Template | 13

There are four default Publish to Web templates that you can customize: ■

Array of Thumbnails. Creates a web page containing an array of thumbnail images.



Array Plus Summary. Creates a web page containing an array of thumbnail images and summary information about each image.



List of Drawings. Creates a web page containing a list of drawings and an image frame.



List Plus Summary. Creates a web page containing a list of drawings, an image frame, and summary information about a selected image.

NOTE You must be familiar with HTML syntax to customize the Publish to Web templates. You can make changes or additions to the look and feel of a template, but you cannot change the arrangement of images within it. For example, in the Array of Thumbnails template, the images are presented across the page in rows. You cannot alter the presentation of the images, but you can wrap text and graphics around the table of images. WARNING To ensure that you do not overwrite the default Publish to Web template files, back up those files before you make any changes to them. To create quick access to the Publish to Web templates 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Options.At the Command prompt, enter options. 2 In the Options dialog box, Files tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Template Settings. Then click the plus sign next to Drawing Template File Location. 3 Move the cursor to the path name that is displayed and click inside it, and press F2, and press CTRL+C to copy it. 4 Click OK or Cancel to close the Options dialog box. 5 Click File menu ➤ Open.At the Command prompt, enter open. 6 In the Select File dialog box, right-click an empty area in the vertical panel on the left side, and click Add on the shortcut menu. 7 Enter a name in the Item name box (for example, Templates). 8 Press CTRL+V to paste the path into the Item Path box, and click OK.

14 | Chapter 2 Basic Customization

You can now access the Template folders by clicking the button in the left panel of the Select File dialog box. To customize a Publish to Web template 1 Browse to the Publish to Web template folder, click File menu ➤ Open.Browse to the Publish to Web template folder, at the Command prompt, enter open. See To create quick access to the Publish to Web templates (page 14). 2 Double-click the PTWTemplates folder to open it. The following folders are displayed. Each contains a Publish to Web template and preview images (BMP) that you see when you run the Publish to Web wizard. ■

Template1. Contains the Array of Thumbnails template and a preview image



Template2. Contains the Array Plus Summary template, a preview image, and HTML frames



Template3. Contains the List of Drawings template, a preview image, and HTML frames



Template4. Contains the List Plus Summary template, a preview image, and HTML frames

3 Right-click the folder you want to use, and click Copy. 4 Press ALT+2, right-click the PTWTemplates folder, and click Paste. 5 Reopen the PTWTemplates folder, and right-click the new folder and rename it. 6 Right-click the new folder and click Open to display its contents. 7 Rename the Publish to Web template (PWT) file with an .htm or .html file extension. 8 Open the template file in an HTML editor or a text editor. The template file contains comments that help you determine which areas of the code you can modify to create your new web page. 9 Review the comments and make changes to the parts of the template you want to customize. 10 Save the template with a .pwt file extension. Make sure you save the file to the template folder you created in step 3.

Customize a Publish to Web Template | 15

NOTE Each template folder can contain only one PWT file. If you create a new PWT file, make sure you delete any other PWT files that exist in the same folder. When you run the Publish to Web wizard, the new template is displayed in the list of templates.

Quick Reference Commands PUBLISHTOWEB Creates HTML pages that include images of selected drawings

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Define Custom Commands You can define external commands that run from within AutoCAD. You can also create command aliases for AutoCAD commands in the acad.pgp file, an ASCII text file that stores command definitions.

Define External Commands External commands start other programs or utilities while AutoCAD is running.

16 | Chapter 2 Basic Customization

While AutoCAD is running, you can invoke other programs or utilities, such as the following: ■

Windows system commands and utilities, such as start, type, dir, or copy



Applications such as text editors or word processors



Database managers, spreadsheets, and communications programs



User-supplied programs, such as batch files or VBA macros

When you enter an external command, AutoCAD looks for the command in acad.pgp. The first section of acad.pgp defines external commands. You can add command definitions by editing acad.pgp in an ASCII text editor (such as Notepad). To open the PGP file, click Tools ➤ Customize ➤ Edit Program Parameters (acad.pgp)Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Edit Program Parameters (acad.pgp). NOTE Before you edit acad.pgp, create a backup file so that you can restore it later, if necessary. When you define an external command, you specify a command name to be used at the Command prompt and an executable command string that is passed to the operating system. Each line in the external commands section has five comma-delimited fields, as follows: command,[executable],flags[,[*]prompt[,return_code]]

command The command that is entered at the Command prompt. If the name is an internal AutoCAD command name, it is ignored. The name is not case-sensitive. executable The constant string sent to the operating system when you enter a command name. It can be any command that you can execute at the operating-system prompt. The string can include switches or parameters. The case-sensitivity of this string depends on the application you are running. flags A required bitcoded parameter. Add these integer values in any combination to achieve the result you want. 0 Start the application and wait for it to finish. 1 Don't wait for the application to finish. 2 Run the application in Minimized mode. 4 Run the application “hidden.” 8 Put the argument string in quotes.

Define External Commands | 17

Bit values 2 and 4 are mutually exclusive; if both are specified only the 2 bit is used. Using value 2 or 4 without value 1 should be avoided, because AutoCAD becomes unavailable until the application has completed. Bit value 8 allows commands like del to work properly with file names that have embedded spaces. This eliminates the possibility of passing a space-delimited list of file names to these commands. If you prefer multiple file support, do not use the bit value 8. prompt An optional field. It specifies the prompt to display on the AutoCAD command line or for the dynamic input tooltip. The response to this prompt is appended to the string supplied in the executable field. If the first character of the prompt field is an asterisk (*), the response can contain spaces and the user must press ENTER to terminate it. Otherwise, the response is terminated by either SPACEBAR or ENTER. If no prompt is specified, no input is requested; however, you must add a comma if a return code is to be supplied or if you want the prompt to have a trailing space. return_code An optional bitcoded parameter. You can add these integer values together in any combination to achieve the result you want. For example, if values 1 and 2 are required, you use 3 as the return code. The values are defined as follows (codes 0 and 4 are meaningless in a windowed environment and are therefore not included): 1 Loads a DXB file. AutoCAD loads the DXB file named $cmd.dxb into the

drawing after the command is terminated. After the DXB file is loaded, the $cmd.dxb file is deleted. This action produces the same result as the DXBIN command. 2 Constructs a block definition from a DXB file. AutoCAD creates a block

definition from the DXB file named $cmd.dxb. The response to the prompt field is used as the block name. This name must be a valid block name that does not currently exist in the drawing; therefore, this mode cannot redefine a previously defined block. After AutoCAD loads the DXB file, the $cmd.dxb file is deleted. The default name for the INSERT command is set to the newly defined block. The file can also contain comment lines preceded by a semicolon (;).

Windows System Commands The start and cmd Windows system commands are very useful when defining external commands. If you specify an executable string that does not use the start or cmd command, AutoCAD is unavailable until that window is closed. The start command starts a separate window and runs a specified program or command. If start is used without any parameters, it opens a new command

18 | Chapter 2 Basic Customization

prompt window. The start command has many command line switches that affect the display of the new window. To launch a Windows application, use start without any switches. The start command is also very useful for starting a document that is associated with an application. For example, you can use start to directly open a document created with a word processor or an HTML file. The cmd command opens a Command prompt window that acts as a shell of AutoCAD. This window must be closed before control returns to the AutoCAD Command prompt. Two command line switches, /c and /k, are useful for external commands. The /c switch carries out the specified command and then stops (the window closes). The /k switch carries out the specified command and then continues (the window remains open). When using the /k switch, you must close the command window (with the exit command). In general, use start to start a new window or application that is to be a separate process from AutoCAD. Use cmd to run a batch file or command script that does not create a separate window, or to create a window that must be closed before control is passed back to AutoCAD. For more information about these commands and switches, see your Windows system command documentation.

Custom-Defined Commands The following example defines three new commands: RUN, LISTSET, and DXB2BLK. RUN, cmd /c,0,*Batch file to run: , LISTSET,cmd /k SET,0 DXB2BLK,cmd /c DXBCOPY,0,DXB file: ,2

The RUN command runs a batch file or command script. The cmd command followed by the /c switch opens a command window, runs the batch file, and then closes. The LISTSET command displays the current DOS environment variable settings. Because this example uses cmd /k rather than start, the command window must be closed before returning to AutoCAD. If you want this window to remain active, use start /realtime. For more information about these commands and switches, see your Windows system command documentation. The DXB2BLK command creates a block definition from the specified DXB file. The DXB file converts all objects into lines. One beneficial by-product of this procedure is that it provides a simple method for exploding text objects into lines. DXB2BLK passes the specified DXB file name to the dxbcopy batch file, which copies that file name to the file name $cmd.dxb. AutoCAD then creates a block

Define External Commands | 19

from the specified DXB file. The name provided to the DXB file prompt is used as the new block name. To create the dxbcopy.cmd file, enter the following at the Windows Command Prompt: echo copy %1.dxb $cmd.dxb > dxbcopy.cmd

This creates the dxbcopy.cmd file in the current directory. Move this file to a directory that is in your DOS path, or explicitly specify the file's location in the acad.pgp file. For example, if the dxbcopy.cmd file is in D:\cad, enter the following in the external commands section of your acad.pgp file. DXB2BLK, cmd /c D:\CAD\DXBCOPY,0,DXB file: ,2

To create a DXB file, choose AutoCAD DXB File Format as the current printer, and then plot to a file. For more information about configuring printers, see Set Up Plotters and Printers in the Driver & Peripheral Guide. To open the program parameters file (acad.pgp) ■

Click Tools ➤ Customize ➤ Edit Program Parameters (acad.pgp)Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Edit Program Parameters (acad.pgp).

Quick Reference Commands REINIT Reinitializes the digitizer, digitizer input/output port, and program parameters file

20 | Chapter 2 Basic Customization

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Create Command Aliases A command alias is an abbreviation that you enter at the command prompt instead of entering the entire command name. For example, you can enter c instead of circle to start the CIRCLE command. An alias is not the same as a keyboard shortcut, which is a combination of keystrokes, such as CTRL+S for SAVE. An alias can be defined for any AutoCAD command, device driver command, or external command. The second section of the acad.pgp file defines command aliases. You can change existing aliases or add new ones by editing acad.pgp in an ASCII text editor (such as Notepad). To open the PGP file, click Tools ➤ Customize ➤ Edit Program Parameters (acad.pgp)Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Edit Program Parameters (acad.pgp). The file can also contain comment lines preceded by a semicolon (;). NOTE Before you edit acad.pgp, create a backup so that you can restore it later, if necessary. To define a command alias, add a line to the command alias section of the acad.pgp file using the following syntax: abbreviation,*command

where abbreviation is the command alias that you enter at the Command prompt and command is the command being abbreviated. You must enter an asterisk (*) before the command name to identify the line as a command alias definition.

Create Command Aliases | 21

If you can enter a command transparently, you can also enter its alias transparently. When you enter the command alias, the full command name is displayed at the Command prompt and the command is executed. You can create command aliases that include the special hyphen (-) prefix, such as those listed here, that accesses the version of a command that displays command prompts instead of a dialog box. BH, *-BHATCH BD, *-BOUNDARY

NOTE You cannot use command aliases in command scripts. Using command aliases in customization files is not recommended. If you edit acad.pgp while AutoCAD is running, enter reinit to use the revised file. You can also restart AutoCAD to automatically reload the file.

Quick Reference Commands REINIT Reinitializes the digitizer, digitizer input/output port, and program parameters file

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

22 | Chapter 2 Basic Customization

3

Custom Linetypes

AutoCAD® provides a library of standard linetypes in the

In this chapter

acad.lin and acadiso.lin files. You can use the linetypes as they



Overview of Linetype Definitions

are, modify them, or create your own custom linetypes.



Simple Custom Linetypes



Text in Custom Linetypes



Shapes in Custom Linetypes

23

Overview of Linetype Definitions Linetypes are defined in one or more linetype definition files that have a .lin file extension. The linetype name and definition determine the particular dash-dot sequence, the relative lengths of dashes and blank spaces, and the characteristics of any included text or shapes. You can use any of the standard linetypes that AutoCAD provides, or you can create your own linetypes.

examples of linetypes A LIN file can contain definitions of many simple and complex linetypes. You can add new linetypes to an existing LIN file, or you can create your own LIN file. To create or modify linetype definitions, edit the LIN file using a text editor or word processor or use LINETYPE at the Command prompt. When you create a linetype, you must load the linetype before you can use it. The LIN files included in AutoCAD are acad.lin and acadiso.lin. You can display or print these text files to better understand how to construct linetypes.

Quick Reference Commands LINETYPE Loads, sets, and modifies linetypes

System Variables MEASUREINIT Controls whether a drawing you start from scratch uses imperial or metric default settings

24 | Chapter 3 Custom Linetypes

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Simple Custom Linetypes Each linetype is defined on two lines in a linetype definition file. The first line contains the linetype name and an optional description. The second line is the code that defines the actual linetype pattern. The second line must begin with the letter A (alignment), followed by a list of pattern descriptors that define pen-up lengths (spaces), pen-down lengths (dashes), and dots. You can include comments in an LIN file by beginning the line with a semicolon (;).

Linetype Definition Format The format of the linetype definition is *linetype_name,description A,descriptor1,descriptor2, ...

For example, a linetype called DASHDOT is defined as *DASHDOT,Dash dot __ . __ . __ . __ . __ . __ . __ . __ A,.5,-.25,0,-.25

This indicates a repeating pattern starting with a dash 0.5 drawing units long, a space 0.25 drawing units long, a dot, and another space 0.25 drawing units long. This pattern continues for the length of the line, ending with a dash 0.5 drawing units long. The linetype would be displayed as shown below. __ . __ . __ . __ . __ . __ . __ . __ LIN files must be saved in ASCII format and use an .lin file extension. Additional information about each field in a linetype definition follows.

Linetype Name The linetype name field begins with an asterisk (*) and should provide a unique, descriptive name for the linetype.

Simple Custom Linetypes | 25

Description The description of the linetype should help you visualize the linetype when you edit the LIN file. The description is also displayed in the Linetype Manager and in the Load or Reload Linetypes dialog box. The description is optional and can include ■

A simple representation of the linetype pattern using ASCII text



An expanded description of the linetype



A comment such as "Use this linetype for hidden lines"

If you omit the description, do not insert a comma after the linetype name. A description cannot exceed 47 characters.

Alignment Field (A) The alignment field specifies the action for pattern alignment at the ends of individual lines, circles, and arcs. Currently, AutoCAD supports only A-type alignment, which guarantees that the endpoints of lines and arcs start and stop with a dash. For example, suppose you create a linetype called CENTRAL that displays the repeating dash-dot sequence commonly used as a centerline. AutoCAD adjusts the dash-dot sequence on an individual line so that dashes and line endpoints coincide. The pattern fits the line so that at least half of the first dash begins and ends the line. If necessary, the first and last dashes are lengthened. If a line is too short to hold even one dash-dot sequence, AutoCAD draws a continuous line between the endpoints. For arcs also, the pattern is adjusted so that dashes are drawn at the endpoints. Circles do not have endpoints, but AutoCAD adjusts the dash-dot sequence to provide a reasonable display. You must specify A-type alignment by entering a in the alignment field.

Pattern Descriptors Each pattern descriptor field specifies the length of segments making up the linetype, separated by commas (no spaces are allowed): ■

A positive decimal number denotes a pen-down (dash) segment of that length.



A negative decimal number denotes a pen-up (space) segment of that length.

26 | Chapter 3 Custom Linetypes



A dash length of 0 draws a dot.

You can enter up to 12 dash-length specifications per linetype, provided they fit on one 80-character line in the LIN file. You need to include only one complete repetition of the linetype pattern defined by pattern descriptors. When the linetype is drawn, AutoCAD uses the first pattern descriptor for the starting and ending dashes. Between the starting and ending dashes, the pattern dash specifications are drawn sequentially, beginning with the second dash specification and restarting the pattern with the first dash specification when required. A-type alignment requires that the first dash length be 0 or greater (a pen-down segment). The second dash length should be less than 0 if you need a pen-up segment and more than 0 if you are creating a continuous linetype. You must have at least two dash specifications for A-type alignment. To create a simple linetype 1 At the Command prompt, enter -linetype. 2 Enter c (Create). 3 Enter a name for the linetype and press ENTER. The linetype name can include up to 255 characters. Linetype names can contain letters, digits, and the special characters dollar sign ($), hyphen (-), and underscore (_). Linetype names cannot include blank spaces. 4 In the Create or Append Linetype File dialog box, select an LIN linetype library file from the File Name box and choose Save. If you select an existing file, the new linetype name is added to the linetype names in the file. 5 Enter text that describes the new linetype (optional). 6 At the Enter Pattern prompt, specify the pattern of the line. Follow these guidelines: ■

All linetypes must begin with a dash.



Enter zeros for dots.



Enter negative real numbers for spaces. The value defines the length of the space in drawing units.



Enter positive real numbers for dashes. The value defines the length of the dash in drawing units.

Simple Custom Linetypes | 27



Separate each dot, dash, or space value from the next with a comma.



Use a space between a dot and a dash.

7 Press ENTER to end the command. NOTE When you create a linetype, it is not loaded into your drawing automatically. Use the Load option of LINETYPE.

Quick Reference Commands LINETYPE Loads, sets, and modifies linetypes

System Variables MEASUREINIT Controls whether a drawing you start from scratch uses imperial or metric default settings

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Text in Custom Linetypes Characters from text fonts can be included in linetypes. Characters from text fonts can be included in linetypes. Linetypes with embedded characters can denote utilities, boundaries, contours, and so on. As with simple linetypes, lines are dynamically drawn as you specify the vertices. Characters embedded in lines are always displayed completely; they are never trimmed.

28 | Chapter 3 Custom Linetypes

Embedded text characters are associated with a text style in the drawing. Any text styles associated with a linetype must exist in the drawing before you load the linetype. The format for linetypes that include embedded characters is similar to that for simple linetypes in that it is a list of pattern descriptors separated by commas.

Character Descriptor Format The format for adding text characters in a linetype description is as follows: ["text",textstylename,scale,rotation,xoffset,yoffset]

This format is added as a descriptor to a simple linetype. For example, a linetype called HOT_WATER_SUPPLY is defined as *HOT_WATER_SUPPLY,---- HW ---- HW ---- HW ---- HW ---- HW ---A,.5,-.2,["HW",STANDARD,S=.1,R=0.0,X=-0.1,Y=-.05],-.2

This indicates a repeating pattern starting with a dash 0.5 drawing units long, a space 0.2 drawing units long, the characters HW with some scale and placement parameters, and another space 0.2 drawing units long. The text characters come from the text font assigned to the STANDARD text style at a scale of 0.1, a relative rotation of 0 degrees, an X offset of -0.1, and a Y offset of -0.05. This pattern continues for the length of the line, ending with a dash 0.5 drawing units long. The linetype would be displayed as shown below.

Notice that the total upstroke length is 0.2 + 0.2 = 0.4 and that the text origin is offset -.01 units in the X direction from the end of the first upstroke. An equivalent linetype would be *HOT_WATER_SUPPLY,---- HW ---- HW ---- HW ---- HW ---- HW ---A,.5,-.1,["HW",STANDARD,S=.1,R=0.0,X=0.0,Y=-.05],-.3

Text in Custom Linetypes | 29

The total upstroke is still 0.1 + 0.3 = 0.4, but the text origin is not offset in the X direction. Additional information about each field in the character descriptor follows. The values to be used are signed decimal numbers such as 1, -17, and 0.01. text The characters to be used in the linetype. text style name The name of the text style to be used. If no text style is specified, AutoCAD uses the currently defined style. scale S=value. The scale factor to be used for the text style relative to the scale of the linetype. The height of the text style is multiplied by the scale factor. If the height is 0, the value for S=value alone is used as the height. rotation R=value or A=value. R= specifies relative or tangential rotation with respect to the line. A= specifies absolute rotation of the text with respect to the origin; that is, all text has the same rotation regardless of its position relative to the line. The value can be appended with a d for degrees (degrees is the default value), r for radians, or g for grads. If rotation is omitted, 0 relative rotation is used. Rotation is centered between the baseline and the nominal cap height. xoffset X=value. The shift of the text on the X axis of the linetype, which is along the line. If xoffset is omitted or is 0, the text is elaborated with no offset. Use this field to control the distance between the text and the previous pen-up or pen-down stroke. This value is not scaled by the scale factor defined by S=value, but it is scaled to the linetype. yoffset Y=value. The shift of the text in the Y axis of the linetype, which is at a 90-degree angle to the line. If yoffset is omitted or is 0, the text is elaborated with no offset. Use this field to control the vertical alignment of the text with respect to the line. This value is not scaled by the scale factor defined by S=value, but it is scaled to the linetype. To include text characters in linetypes 1 Create a simple linetype, as described in To create a simple linetype (page 27). 2 Add the text character descriptor within the linetype pattern, using the following format: ["text",textstylename,scale,rotation,xoffset,yoffset] 3 Press ENTER to exit LINETYPE.

30 | Chapter 3 Custom Linetypes

Quick Reference Commands LINETYPE Loads, sets, and modifies linetypes

System Variables MEASUREINIT Controls whether a drawing you start from scratch uses imperial or metric default settings

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Shapes in Custom Linetypes A complex linetype can contain embedded shapes that are saved in shape files. Complex linetypes can denote utilities, boundaries, contours, and so on. As with simple linetypes, complex lines are dynamically drawn as the user specifies vertices. Shapes and text objects embedded in lines are always displayed completely; they are never trimmed. The syntax for complex linetypes is similar to that of simple linetypes in that it is a comma-delimited list of pattern descriptors. Complex linetypes can include shape and text objects as pattern descriptors, as well as dash-dot descriptors. The syntax for shape object descriptors in a linetype description is as follows: [shapename,shxfilename] or [shapename,shxfilename,transform]

where transform is optional and can be any series of the following (each preceded by a comma): R=## Relative rotation

Shapes in Custom Linetypes | 31

A=## Absolute rotation S=## Scale X=## X offset Y=## Y offset

In this syntax, ## is a signed decimal number (1, -17, 0.01, and so on), the rotation is in degrees, and the remaining options are in linetype-scaled drawing units. The preceding transform letters, if they are used, must be followed by an equal sign and a number. The following linetype definition defines a linetype named CON1LINE that is composed of a repeating pattern of a line segment, a space, and the embedded shape CON1 from the ep.shx file. (Note that the ep.shx file must be in the support path for the following example to work properly.) *CON1LINE, --- [CON1] --- [CON1] --- [CON1] A,1.0,-0.25,[CON1,ep.shx],-1.0

Except for the code enclosed in square brackets, everything is consistent with the definition of a simple linetype. As previously described, a total of six fields can be used to define a shape as part of a linetype. The first two are mandatory and position-dependent; the next four are optional and can be ordered arbitrarily. The following two examples demonstrate various entries in the shape definition field. [CAP,ep.shx,S=2,R=10,X=0.5]

The code above draws the CAP shape defined in the ep.shx shape file with a scale of two times the unit scale of the linetype, a tangential rotation of 10 degrees in a counterclockwise direction, and an X offset of 0.5 drawing units before shape elaboration takes place. [DIP8,pd.shx,X=0.5,Y=1,R=0,S=1]

The code above draws the DIP8 shape defined in the pd.shx shape file with an X offset of 0.5 drawing units before shape drawing takes place, and a Y offset of one drawing unit above the linetype, with 0 rotation and a scale equal to the unit scale of the linetype. The following syntax defines a shape as part of a complex linetype. [shapename,shapefilename,scale,rotate,xoffset,yoffset]

The definitions of the fields in the syntax follow. shapename The name of the shape to be drawn. This field must be included. If it is omitted, linetype definition fails. If shapename does not exist in the

32 | Chapter 3 Custom Linetypes

specified shape file, continue drawing the linetype but without the embedded shape. shapefilename The name of a compiled shape definition file (SHX). If it is omitted, linetype definition fails. If shapefilename is unqualified (that is, no path is specified), search the library path for the file. If shapefilename is fully qualified and not found at that location, remove the prefix and search the library path for the file. If it is not found, continue drawing the linetype but without the embedded shape. scale S=value. The scale of the shape is used as a scale factor by which the shape's internally defined scale is multiplied. If the shape's internally defined scale is 0, the S=value alone is used as the scale. rotate R=value or A=value. R= signifies relative or tangential rotation with respect to the line's elaboration. A= signifies absolute rotation of the shape with respect to the origin; all shapes have the same rotation regardless of their relative position to the line. The value can be appended with a d for degrees (if omitted, degree is the default), r for radians, or g for grads. If rotation is omitted, 0 relative rotation is used. xoffset X=value. The shift of the shape in the X axis of the linetype computed from the end of the linetype definition vertex. If xoffset is omitted or is 0, the shape is elaborated with no offset. Include this field if you want a continuous line with shapes. This value is not scaled by the scale factor defined by S=. yoffset Y=value. The shift of the shape in the Y axis of the linetype computed from the end of the linetype definition vertex. If yoffset is omitted or 0, the shape is elaborated with no offset. This value is not scaled by the scale factor defined by S=. See also: ■

Shapes and Shape Fonts (page 349)

Quick Reference Commands LINETYPE Loads, sets, and modifies linetypes

Shapes in Custom Linetypes | 33

SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

System Variables MEASUREINIT Controls whether a drawing you start from scratch uses imperial or metric default settings

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

34 | Chapter 3 Custom Linetypes

4

Custom Hatch Patterns

AutoCAD® provides a library of standard hatch patterns in

In this chapter

the acad.pat and acadiso.pat files. You can use the hatch



Overview of Hatch Pattern Definitions

patterns as they are, modify them, or create your own custom



Hatch Patterns with Dashed Lines



Hatch Patterns with Multiple Lines

hatch patterns.

35

Overview of Hatch Pattern Definitions In addition to using the predefined hatch patterns that are supplied, you can design and create your own custom hatch patterns. In addition to using the predefined hatch patterns that are supplied, you can design and create your own custom hatch patterns. Developing a hatch pattern definition requires knowledge, practice, and patience. Because customizing hatches requires familiarity with hatch patterns, it is not recommended for new users. The hatch patterns supplied by AutoCAD are stored in the acad.pat and acadiso.pat text files. You can add hatch pattern definitions to this file or create your own files. Regardless of where the definition is stored, a custom hatch pattern has the same format. It has a header line with a name, which begins with an asterisk and is no more than 31 characters long, and an optional description: *pattern-name, description

It also has one or more line descriptors of the following form: angle, x-origin,y-origin, delta-x,delta-y,dash-1,dash-2, …

The default hatch pattern ANSI31 shown in the Boundary Hatch and Fill dialog box looks like this:

and is defined as follows: *ANSI31, ANSI Iron, Brick, Stone masonry 45, 0,0, 0,.125

The pattern name on the first line, *ANSI31, is followed by a description: ANSI Iron, Brick, Stone masonry. This simple pattern definition specifies a line drawn at an angle of 45 degrees, that the first line of the family of hatch lines is to pass through the drawing origin (0,0), and that the spacing between hatch lines of the family is to be 0.125 drawing units. Hatch pattern definitions follow these rules: ■

Each line in a pattern definition can contain up to 80 characters. You can include letters, numbers, and the special characters underline (_), hyphen

36 | Chapter 4 Custom Hatch Patterns

(-), and dollar sign ($). However, you must begin a pattern definition with a letter or number, not a special character. ■

AutoCAD ignores both blank lines and text to the right of a semicolon.



Each pattern line is considered to be the first member of a line family, created by applying the delta offsets in both directions to generate an infinite family of parallel lines.



The delta-x value indicates the displacement between members of the family in the direction of the line. It is used only for dashed lines.



The delta-y value indicates the spacing between members of the family; that is, it is measured perpendicular to the lines.



A line is considered to be of infinite length. A dash pattern is superimposed on the line.

The process of hatching consists of expanding each line in the pattern definition to its infinite family of parallel lines. All selected objects are checked for intersections with any of these lines; any intersections cause the hatch lines to be turned on and off as governed by the hatching style. Each family of hatch lines is generated parallel to an initial line with an absolute origin to guarantee proper alignment. If you create a very dense hatch, AutoCAD may reject the hatch and display a message indicating that the hatch scale is too small or its dash length too short. You can change the maximum number of hatch lines by setting the MaxHatch system registry variable using (setenv “MaxHatch” “n”) where n is a number between 100 and 10000000 (ten million). NOTE When changing the value of MaxHatch, you must enter MaxHatch with the capitalization as shown. To create a simple hatch pattern 1 Open the acad.pat or acadiso.pat file in a text editor that saves in ASCII format (for example, Microsoft® Windows® Notepad). 2 Create a header line that includes an asterisk and a pattern name. The name of the hatch pattern is limited to 31 characters. 3 (Optional) To include a description in the header line, follow the pattern name with a comma and description text.

Overview of Hatch Pattern Definitions | 37

4 Create a descriptor line that includes ■

An angle at which the line is drawn



An X,Y origin point



A delta-x of 0



A delta-y of any value

Quick Reference Commands ADCENTER Manages and inserts content such as blocks, xrefs, and hatch patterns BHATCH Fills an enclosed area or selected objects with a hatch pattern or gradient fill FILL Controls the filling of objects such as hatches, two-dimensional solids, and wide polylines HATCH Fills an enclosed area or selected objects with a hatch pattern, solid fill, or gradient fill HATCHEDIT Modifies an existing hatch or fill SOLID Creates solid-filled triangles and quadrilaterals

System Variables FILLMODE Specifies whether hatches and fills, two-dimensional solids, and wide polylines are filled in HPANG Specifies the hatch pattern angle

38 | Chapter 4 Custom Hatch Patterns

HPBOUND Controls the object type created by the BHATCH and BOUNDARY commands HPDOUBLE Specifies hatch pattern doubling for user-defined patterns HPNAME Sets a default hatch pattern name of up to 34 characters without spaces HPSCALE Specifies the hatch pattern scale factor, which must be greater than zero HPSPACE Specifies the hatch pattern line spacing for user-defined simple patterns, which must be greater than zero

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Hatch Patterns with Dashed Lines To define dashed-line patterns, you append dash-length items to the end of the line definition item. To define dashed-line patterns, you append dash-length items to the end of the line definition item. Each dash-length item specifies the length of a segment making up the line. If the length is positive, a pen-down segment is drawn. If the length is negative, the segment is pen-up, and it is not drawn. The pattern starts at the origin point with the first segment and cycles through the segments in circular fashion. A dash length of 0 draws a dot. You can specify up to six dash lengths per pattern line. The hatch pattern ANSI33, shown in the Boundary Hatch and Fill dialog box, looks like this:

Hatch Patterns with Dashed Lines | 39

and is defined as follows: *ANSI33, ANSI Bronze, Brass, Copper 45, .176776695,0, 0,.25, .125,-.0625

For example, to modify a pattern for 45-degree lines to draw dashed lines with a dash length of 0.5 units and a space between dashes of 0.5 units, the line definition would be *DASH45, Dashed lines at 45 degrees 45, 0,0, 0,.5, .5,-.5

This is the same as the 45-degree pattern shown in Overview of Hatch Pattern Definitions (page 36), but with a dash specification added to the end. The pen-down length is 0.5 units, and the pen-up length is 0.5, meeting the stated objectives. If you wanted to draw a 0.5-unit dash, a 0.25-unit space, a dot, and a 0.25-unit space before the next dash, the definition would be *DDOT45,Dash-dot-dash pattern: 45 degrees 45, 0,0, 0,.5, .5,-.25, 0,-.25

The following example shows the effect of delta-x specifications on dashed-line families. First, consider the following definition: *GOSTAK 0, 0,0, 0,.5, .5,-.5

This draws a family of lines separated by 0.5, with each line broken equally into dashes and spaces. Because delta-x is zero, the dashes in each family member line up. An area hatched with this pattern would look like this:

Now change the pattern to *SKEWED 0, 0,0, .5,.5, .5,-.5

It is the same, except that you have set delta-x to 0.5. This offsets each successive family member by 0.5 in the direction of the line (in this case, parallel to the X axis). Because the lines are infinite, the dash pattern slides down the specified amount. The hatched area would look like this:

40 | Chapter 4 Custom Hatch Patterns

To create a hatch pattern with dashed lines 1 Open the acad.pat or acadiso.pat file in a text editor that saves in ASCII format (for example, Notepad). 2 Create a header line that includes an asterisk and a pattern name. The name of the hatch pattern is limited to 31 characters. 3 (Optional) To include a description in the header line, follow the pattern name with a comma and description text. 4 Create a descriptor line that includes ■

An angle at which the line is drawn



An X,Y origin point



A delta-x of any value if you want to offset alternating lines in the line family



A delta-y of any value



A value for a dash length



A value for a dot length



An optional second value for a different dash length



An optional second value for a different dot length

Quick Reference Commands ADCENTER Manages and inserts content such as blocks, xrefs, and hatch patterns BHATCH Fills an enclosed area or selected objects with a hatch pattern or gradient fill

Hatch Patterns with Dashed Lines | 41

FILL Controls the filling of objects such as hatches, two-dimensional solids, and wide polylines HATCH Fills an enclosed area or selected objects with a hatch pattern, solid fill, or gradient fill HATCHEDIT Modifies an existing hatch or fill SOLID Creates solid-filled triangles and quadrilaterals

System Variables FILLMODE Specifies whether hatches and fills, two-dimensional solids, and wide polylines are filled in HPANG Specifies the hatch pattern angle HPBOUND Controls the object type created by the BHATCH and BOUNDARY commands HPDOUBLE Specifies hatch pattern doubling for user-defined patterns HPNAME Sets a default hatch pattern name of up to 34 characters without spaces HPSCALE Specifies the hatch pattern scale factor, which must be greater than zero HPSPACE Specifies the hatch pattern line spacing for user-defined simple patterns, which must be greater than zero

42 | Chapter 4 Custom Hatch Patterns

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Hatch Patterns with Multiple Lines Complex hatch patterns can have an origin that passes through offsets from the origin and can have multiple members in the line family. Not all hatch patterns use origin points of 0,0. Complex hatch patterns can have an origin that passes through offsets from the origin and can have multiple members in the line family. In composing more complex patterns, you need to carefully specify the starting point, offsets, and dash pattern of each line family to form the hatch pattern correctly. The hatch pattern AR-B816 shown in the Boundary Hatch and Fill dialog box looks like this:

and is defined as follows with multiple lines describing the pattern: *AR-B816, 8x16 Block elevation stretcher bond 0, 0,0, 0,8 90, 0,0, 8,8, 8,-8

The following figure illustrates a squared-off, inverted-U pattern (one line up, one over, and one down). The pattern repeats every one unit, and each unit is 0.5 high and wide.

This pattern would be defined as follows:

Hatch Patterns with Multiple Lines | 43

*IUS,Inverted U's 90, 0,0, 0,1, .5,-.5 0, 0,.5, 0,1, .5,-.5 270, .5,.5, 0,1, .5,-.5

The first line (the up bar) is a simple dashed line with 0,0 origin. The second line (the top bar) should begin at the end of the up bar, so its origin is 0,.5. The third line (the down bar) must start at the end of the top bar, which is at .5,.5 for the first instance of the pattern, so its origin is at this point. The third line of the pattern could be the following: 90, .5,0, 0,1, .5,-.5

or 270, .5,1, 0,1, -.5,.5

The dashed pattern starts at the origin points and continues in the vector direction given by the angle specification. Therefore, two dashed-line families that are opposed 180 degrees are not alike. Two solid-line families are alike. The following pattern creates six-pointed stars.

This example can help you refine your skills at pattern definition. (Hint: 0.866 is the sine of 60 degrees.) The following is the AutoCAD definition of this pattern: *STARS,Star of David 0, 0,0, 0,.866, .5,-.5 60, 0,0, 0,.866, .5,-.5 120, .25,.433, 0,.866, .5,-.5

To create a hatch pattern with multiple lines 1 Open the acad.pat or acadiso.pat file in a text editor that saves in ASCII format (for example, Notepad). 2 Create a header line that includes an asterisk and a pattern name. The name of the hatch pattern is limited to 31 characters.

44 | Chapter 4 Custom Hatch Patterns

3 (Optional) To include a description in the header line, follow the pattern name with a comma and description text. 4 Create a descriptor line that includes ■

An angle at which the line is drawn



An X,Y origin point



A delta-x of any value if you want to offset alternating lines in the line family



A delta-y of any value



A value for a dash length



A value for a dot length



An optional second value for a different dash length



An optional second value for a different dot length

5 Create a second line including all the parameters in the previous step. 6 (Optional) Create additional lines to complete the multiple-line hatch pattern.

Quick Reference Commands ADCENTER Manages and inserts content such as blocks, xrefs, and hatch patterns BHATCH Fills an enclosed area or selected objects with a hatch pattern or gradient fill FILL Controls the filling of objects such as hatches, two-dimensional solids, and wide polylines HATCH Fills an enclosed area or selected objects with a hatch pattern, solid fill, or gradient fill

Hatch Patterns with Multiple Lines | 45

HATCHEDIT Modifies an existing hatch or fill SOLID Creates solid-filled triangles and quadrilaterals

System Variables FILLMODE Specifies whether hatches and fills, two-dimensional solids, and wide polylines are filled in HPANG Specifies the hatch pattern angle HPBOUND Controls the object type created by the BHATCH and BOUNDARY commands HPDOUBLE Specifies hatch pattern doubling for user-defined patterns HPNAME Sets a default hatch pattern name of up to 34 characters without spaces HPSCALE Specifies the hatch pattern scale factor, which must be greater than zero HPSPACE Specifies the hatch pattern line spacing for user-defined simple patterns, which must be greater than zero

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

46 | Chapter 4 Custom Hatch Patterns

5

Customize the User Interface

When you work in the program, you use a variety of menus,

In this chapter

toolbars, shortcut keys, and other user interface elements to



Overview of Customize User Interface



Work with Customization Files



Customize Commands



Create Macros



Customize Toolbars



Create Pull-Down and Shortcut Menus



Customize Dashboard Panels



Add Shortcut Keys and Temporary Override Keys



Create a Double Click Action



Customize Mouse Buttons



Customize Legacy Interface Elements



Load an AutoLISP File



Customize Workspaces



Customize User Interface FAQs

help you accomplish your tasks efficiently. You can also streamline your environment by customizing these elements.

47

48 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Overview of Customize User Interface Using AutoCAD's customization tools, you can tailor your drawing environment to suit your needs. Customization capabilities, including the CUI (Customize User Interface) file format and the Customize User Interface editor, help you to easily create and modify customized content. The XML-based CUI file replaces the menu files used in releases prior to AutoCAD 2006. Instead of using a text editor to customize menu files (MNU and MNS files), you customize the user interface from within AutoCAD. You can ■

Add or change toolbars and menus (including shortcut menus, image tile menus, and tablet menus)



Create or change workspaces



Assign commands to various user interface elements



Create or change macros



Define DIESEL strings



Create or change aliases



Add tooltips



Provide descriptive text on the status line

Important Customization Terms You should know several terms for customizing AutoCAD 2008. Legacy Menu File (MNS) An ASCII based file that stores menu customization data for AutoCAD 2005 and earlier. Most of the file needed to be edited outside of AutoCAD using a text editor such as Notepad, but there were a few features that could be customized in AutoCAD using the CUSTOMIZE command. The MNS file has been replaced by the CUI file. A CUI file can be generated from an MNS file using the Transfer tab of the CUI command. Legacy Menu Template (MNU) An ASCII based file that is used as a template to define the contents of the MNS file when the MNU file is loaded into AutoCAD with the MENU or MENULOAD command. The MNU file is used in AutoCAD 2005 and earlier, and is very similar to the MNS file. The MNU

Overview of Customize User Interface | 49

file has been replaced by the CUI file. A CUI file can be generated from a MNU file using the Transfer tab of the CUI command. Customization (CUI) File An XML-based file that stores customization data. You modify a customization file through the Customize User Interface editor. CUI files replace MNU, MNS, and MNC files that were used to define menus in releases prior to AutoCAD 2006. Main Customization File A writable CUI file that defines most of the user interface elements (including the standard menus, toolbars, keyboard accelerators, and so on). The acad.cui file (the default main CUI file) is automatically loaded when you start AutoCAD. Enterprise Customization File A CUI file that is typically controlled by a CAD manager. It is often accessed by many users and is stored in a shared network location. The file is read-only to users to prevent the data in the file from being changed. A CAD manager creates an enterprise CUI file by modifying a main CUI file and then saving the file to a shared network location. Users then specify this file in the Options dialog box, Files tab. Partial Customization File Any CUI file that is not defined as the main or enterprise CUI file. You can load and unload partial CUI files as you need them during a drawing session. Customization Group A name that is assigned to a CUI file to identify customization content in the CUI file. A CUI file loaded into AutoCAD must have a unique customization group name to prevent conflicts between CUI files in the program. In previous releases, called a menu group. Interface Element An object that can be customized, such as a toolbar, pull-down menu, shortcut key, palette, and so on. It is a node in the Customizations In pane that contains user interface items. Interface Item The individual parts of a user interface element, such as a toolbar button, pull-down menu item, shortcut key, temporary override key, and so on. Tree Node A hierarchical structure in the Customize User Interface editor that contains interface elements and items that can be imported, exported, and customized. Workspace A collection of user interface elements, including their contents, properties, display states, and locations. Palette An interface element that can be docked or floating in the drawing area. Palettes include the Command Line window, Tool Palettes Window, Properties palette, and so on.

50 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Element ID A unique identifier of an interface element. In previous releases, called a tag.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts CUIEXPORT Exports customized settings from acad.cui to an enterprise or partial CUI file CUIIMPORT Imports customized settings from an enterprise or partial CUI file to acad.cui CUILOAD Loads a CUI file CUIUNLOAD Unloads a CUI file CUSTOMIZE Customizes tool palettes DASHBOARD Opens the Dashboard window TOOLPALETTES Opens the Tool Palettes window QUICKCUI Displays the Customize User Interface dialog box in a collapsed state

System Variables DBLCLKEDIT Controls the double click editing behavior in the drawing area

Important Customization Terms | 51

ENTERPRISEMENU Displays the file name for the enterprise CUI (if defined), including the path for the file name MENUNAME Stores the customization file name, including the path for the file name TOOLTIPS Controls the display of tooltips on toolbars

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

How Customization Has Changed Although the basic customization techniques remain the same as in previous versions of the product, the environment that you use to customize the product was changed starting with AutoCAD 2006. All of the previous customization options are still available. You are still able to create, edit, and delete interface elements; you can create partial customization files; you can use macros and advanced entries such as DIESEL expressions and AutoLISP routines. However, you no longer perform customization tasks by creating or editing MNU or MNS text files by hand. All customizations are done through the program interface, in the Customize User Interface editor.

Menu Files Versus Customization Files In releases prior to AutoCAD 2006, you customized the user interface by editing an MNU or MNS file in an ASCII text editor such as Notepad. You manually entered and verified customization data in the text file, which could be a tedious and error-prone process. As a result, a simple syntax error (such as mismatched parentheses) in the text file could invalidate the entire menu file, leading you back to the text file to investigate where you made the error.

52 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

With the Customize User Interface editor, you drag a command to a menu or toolbar or right-click to add, delete, or modify a user interface element. The Customize User Interface editor displays element properties and a list of options to choose from. This prevents you from creating syntax errors or spelling mistakes that may have occurred when you manually entered text in an MNU or MNS file. The MNU and MNS files used in the past have been replaced with just one file type, the XML-based CUI file. The XML-based format of the CUI file allows the product to track customizations. When upgrading to a future version of the program, all of your customizations are automatically integrated into the new release. The XML format also supports a backward-compatible customization file. This means that you can view a CUI file from a future version in the previous release while preserving the customization data from the future version. However, you cannot modify the future version's CUI file in the previous release. For more information about migrating customization data, see Migrate and Transfer Customizations (page 72). The following table lists the menu files that previously shipped with the product and shows how those files are mapped to AutoCAD 2008. Menu files mapped to CUI files Menu file Description

In Auto- Description of change CAD 2008

MNU

ASCII text file. In previous releases, defined most user interface elements. The main MNU file, acad.mnu, was automatically loaded when you started the product. Partial MNU files could be loaded or unloaded as you needed them during a drawing session.

CUI

An XML file that defines most user interface elements. The main CUI file, acad.cui, is automatically loaded when you start the product. Partial CUI files can be loaded or unloaded as you need them during a drawing session.

MNS

Source menu file. Was the same as the MNU ASCII text file but did not contain comments or special formatting.

CUI

An XML file that defines most user interface elements. The main CUI file, acad.cui, is automatically

How Customization Has Changed | 53

Menu files mapped to CUI files Menu file Description

In Auto- Description of change CAD 2008 loaded when you start the product. Partial CUI files can be loaded or unloaded as you need them during a drawing session.

MNC

Compiled ASCII text file. Contained command strings and syntax that defined the functionality and appearance of user interface elements.

CUI

An XML file that defines most user interface elements. The main CUI file, acad.cui, is automatically loaded when you start the product. Partial CUI files can be loaded or unloaded as you need them during a drawing session.

MNL

Menu LISP file. Contains AutoLISP expressions that are used by the user interface elements.

MNL

No change.

MNR

Menu resource file. Contains the bitmaps that are used by the user interface elements.

MNR

No change.

Menu Text File Structure Versus CUI Structure In releases prior to AutoCAD 2006, you added, edited, and deleted menu information directly in a text file. In AutoCAD 2006 and later, you use the Customize User Interface editor.

54 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Following is an example of how the Window menu looked in the legacy menu file acad.mnu. Contents of the Window menu in acad.mnu Window menu

Description ***POP10 **WINDOW ID_MnWindow [&Window] ID_DWG_CLOSE [Cl&ose]^C^C_close ID_WINDOW_CLOSEALL [C&lose All]^C^C_closeall [--] ID_WINDOW_CASCADE [&Cascade]^C^C_syswindows;_cascade ID_WINDOW_TILE_HORZ [Tile &Horizontally]^C^C_syswindows;_hor ID_WINDOW_TILE_VERT [&Tile Vertically]^C^C_syswindows;_vert ID_WINDOW_ARRANGE [&Arrange Icons]^C^C_syswindows;_arrange

Compare the menu data above with the same menu data as it is displayed in the Customize User Interface editor, in the tree view.

For a more detailed comparison, following are examples of the Window menu properties, Close command properties, Close All command properties, and the Window shortcut menu that is displayed with the Insert Separator option. Window menu Properties pane

How Customization Has Changed | 55

Window menu, Properties pane for the Close command

Window menu, Properties pane for the Close All command

Window menu tree node, shortcut menu displayed with Insert Separator option

56 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Menu Group Versus Customization Group There is no difference between a menu group (the term used in previous releases) and a customization group. A CUI file loaded into AutoCAD must have a unique customization group name to prevent conflicts between customization files in the program. The main CUI file, acad.cui by default, has a customization group named ACAD. You can load as many customization files into the program, as long as they each have a unique customization group name. Following is an example of how you change the ACAD customization group name in the Customize tab of the Customize User Interface editor. You can change the partial CUI file (named CUSTOM in this example) using the same method.

Dynamic Help Dynamic Help is a feature that is in the online Help system and references some of the customization elements that are found in the CUI file when it is loaded into AutoCAD. What Dynamic Help does, is it looks up the Element ID of a command that has been identified in the online Help system, and where that command is currently being referenced on a pull-down menu when the CUI file is loaded. If the command is on a pull-down menu, the menu access in the online Help system is updated to reflect the location of the command. If one of the standard commands that ships with AutoCAD is moved from one pull-down menu to another, the online Help system will automatically reflect this change the next time it is displayed. Currently, only the pull-down menu access for commands in the online Help system are affected by Dynamic Help.

How Customization Has Changed | 57

NOTE Dynamic Help only works with the online Help documents that come with AutoCAD, and has no affect on third-party documentation. See also: ■

Migrate and Transfer Customizations (page 72)



Create and Load a Partial CUI File (page 76)



Create an Enterprise CUI File (page 80)

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts CUIEXPORT Exports customized settings from acad.cui to an enterprise or partial CUI file CUIIMPORT Imports customized settings from an enterprise or partial CUI file to acad.cui CUILOAD Loads a CUI file CUIUNLOAD Unloads a CUI file QUICKCUI Displays the Customize User Interface dialog box in a collapsed state

58 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Overview of the Customize User Interface Editor The Customize User Interface (CUI) editor is used to modify customization that is in the XML-based CUI file. The Customize User Interface (CUI) editor is used to modify customization that is in the XML-based CUI file. The editor allows you to create and manage commands that are used in the CUI file in a centralized location. Along with commands, you are able to customize many of the different user interface elements. From the CUI editor you can customize ■

Toolbars



Pull-down menus



Dashboard panels



Shortcut menus



Shortcut keys



Temporary override keys



Double click actions



Mouse buttons



Workspaces



Legacy user interface elements (tablets, tablet buttons, screen menus and image tile menus)

Overview of the Customize User Interface Editor | 59

Customization Environment Before you start customizing your own menus, toolbars, and other user interface elements, you should familiarize yourself with the customization environment. To open the Customize User Interface editor, click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.To open the Customize User Interface editor, at the Command prompt, enter cui. Once the Customize User Interface editor is opened, view the contents of the loaded customization files by expanding the elements in the tree structure, and view the properties of the elements by selecting them. Select the Transfer tab to see how to migrate or transfer customizations; select the Customize tab to see how to create or modify user interface elements. Once you are familiar with the environment, you can start to take advantage of the capabilities of the tools. For more information about the improved customization capabilities, see How Customization Has Changed (page 52). Following is an example of the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab. You use this tab to customize interface elements in CUI files.

60 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Customize the user interface to make the drawing environment specific to certain types of tasks. For example, if you want a toolbar that contains the commands you use most often, you can create a new Favorites toolbar in the Customize User Interface editor and then load the new toolbar in AutoCAD.

Customizations In Pane The Customizations In pane is used to navigate the different user interface elements that are in the loaded customization files. In this pane, you create and modify user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, and menus. Along the top of the pane you will find tools that load partial customization files into the main customization file, save changes to the loaded customization files, control how you view the loaded customization files, and control the display of user interface elements in the tree view. The tree view is used to create new user interface elements such as toolbars and menus. Once a new user interface element is created, commands can then be added by dragging them from the Command List pane. Along with being able to create user interface elements and add commands to a user interface element, you can change the order in which commands appear on toolbars and menus by dragging them up and down.

Command List Pane The Command List pane is used to create and locate commands that are contained in the loaded customization files. Use the Create a New Command button to create a new custom command in the CUI file that is listed in the drop-down list at the top of the Customizations In pane. A command must be created before it can be associated with a user interface element in the Customizations In pane.

Overview of the Customize User Interface Editor | 61

To the left of the Create a New Command button is the Find Command or Text button. The Find Command or Text button displays the Find and Replace dialog box, where you can search for or replace text strings in the Command List pane only. The Categories drop-down list at the top of the pane contains a listing of preset categories used to filter the commands displayed in the list box. There are many different categories that you can select from, for example ■

All Commands. Displays all of the commands for each of the loaded customization files.



Custom Commands. Displays the user defined commands that have been added to the loaded customization files. These commands are not part of a customization file that ships with AutoCAD.



Controls Elements. Displays the special controls that can be added to a toolbar or dashboard panel, such as drop-down lists, sliders, and other controls.

Available commands and controls are displayed in the middle section of the Command List pane. The names of the available commands, the image that is assigned to a command, and the name of the customization group that the command is assigned to are displayed. When the cursor hovers over top of a command, the macro assigned to the command is displayed in a tooltip. At the bottom of the Command List pane is a text field that allows you to filter the command list based on a matching string. The text string is matched with any part of a command name, and the commands with the text string matches are displayed in the list box.

62 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Dynamic Display Pane The Dynamic Display pane controls the display of additional panes that respond to the item that is selected in either the Customizations In pane or Command List pane. Based on the item selected, one or more of the following panes will be displayed: ■

Button Image



Information



Panel Preview



Toolbar Preview



Properties



Shortcuts



Workspace Contents

Overview of the Customize User Interface Editor | 63

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts CUIEXPORT Exports customized settings from acad.cui to an enterprise or partial CUI file CUIIMPORT Imports customized settings from an enterprise or partial CUI file to acad.cui CUILOAD Loads a CUI file

64 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

CUIUNLOAD Unloads a CUI file QUICKCUI Displays the Customize User Interface dialog box in a collapsed state

System Variables DBLCLKEDIT Controls the double click editing behavior in the drawing area ENTERPRISEMENU Displays the file name for the enterprise CUI (if defined), including the path for the file name MENUNAME Stores the customization file name, including the path for the file name TOOLTIPS Controls the display of tooltips on toolbars

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Work with Customization Files Customization (CUI) files are used to store commands, user interface elements, and references to partial CUI files and AutoLISP files. CUI files can be designated as main, partial, or enterprise. The CUI file designation determines the order the file is loaded. User interface elements can be transferred between CUI files, which helps to make the migration process easier. With the Customize User Interface editor, you can do the following with customization files: ■

Create a new CUI file from scratch

Work with Customization Files | 65



Save an existing CUI file with a different name



Transfer customization between two CUI files



Reset and restore CUI files



Load a CUI file as a partial CUI file

Basics of Customization Files Customization files are loaded into AutoCAD to define elements that make up the user interface and are edited using the Customize User Interface editor. AutoCAD comes with several different CUI files that can be tailored to your work environment. AutoCAD has two main designations for CUI files, main and enterprise; by default AutoCAD uses a main CUI file. You can customize the files that come with AutoCAD or you can create your own CUI files from scratch using the Transfer tab in the Customize User Interface editor. When customizing the CUI files that come with AutoCAD or creating your own CUI files, the Customize User Interface editor creates a backup copy of the file when you first start making changes to the CUI file. This allows you to restore the file if you delete something that you wanted to keep. If you happen to modify a CUI file that comes with AutoCAD, you can reset it back to its original state. The Customize User Interface allows you to not only create new user interface elements and commands from scratch, but you can also copy existing user interface elements and commands to modify them. To create a customization file from scratch 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Transfer tab, in the right pane, click the Create a New Customization File button.

66 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

3 In the right pane, select Save As from the drop-down list.

4 In the Save As dialog box, specify the location to save the new customization file to and enter a name in the File name text field. 5 Click Save to create the customization file in the specified location. To create a CUI file from an existing CUI file 1 In Windows Explorer, navigate to the following location: C:\Documents and Settings\\Application Data\Autodesk\\\\support\.cui NOTE In some operating systems, the folders that are located under your profile are hidden by default. To display these files, you may need to change your display settings. Click Start menu (Windows) ➤ Control Panel ➤ Folder Options. In the Folder Options dialog box, View tab, click Show Hidden Files and Folders. 2 Copy the selected CUI file to a new file name (such as enterprise.cui) or location (such as the shared network location where users will access the file) so that you preserve the original CUI file (in case you want to modify or use it again later). WARNING This method of creating a new CUI file can result in additional work if you do not want all the commands and user interface elements in the copied CUI file.

To restore a customization backup file 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui.

Basics of Customization Files | 67

2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, right-click over the customization group name. 3 Click Restore .

4 Click OK. To reset a standard customization file 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, right-click over the customization group name. 3 Click Reset .

4 Click OK. To rename a customization group name 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize In pane, select a CUI file from the drop-down list.

68 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

3 In the Customize In pane, click the customization group node at the very top. Right-click the customization group name, and click Rename. Enter a new customization group name. NOTE You can click, wait, and click again over the customization group name to edit its name in-place.

NOTE The customization group name cannot contain spaces. 4 Click OK. To designate a CUI file as the main CUI file 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Options.At the Command prompt, enter options. 2 In the Options dialog box, on the Files tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Customization Files to expand the list.

Basics of Customization Files | 69

3 Click the plus sign next to Main Customization File to expand it. 4 Select the item below Main Customization File and click Browse.

5 In the Select a File dialog box, browse to the location of the customization file and select it. Click Open. The file you selected is now designated as the main CUI file for the program. To copy and paste a user interface element 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, Customizations In pane, expand the main node for the user interface element that you want to copy. 3 Right-click over the user interface element. Click Copy.

4 Right-click over the node that you want to paste the selected user interface element to. Click Paste.

70 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

NOTE The key combination CTRL+C can be used to Copy a user interface element and CTRL+V can be used to Paste a user interface element in the Customizations In pane. 5 Click OK. To duplicate a user interface element 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, Customizations In pane, expand the main node for the user interface element that you want to duplicate. 3 Right-click over the user interface element. Click Duplicate.

Basics of Customization Files | 71

A copy of the selected user interface element is created in-place directly above the selection in the Customizations In pane. NOTE The key combination CTRL+D can be used to duplicate a user interface element in-place. 4 Click OK.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts MENU Loads a customization file

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Migrate and Transfer Customizations You can migrate custom MNU or MNS files from earlier releases using the Customize User Interface editor. The program transfers all of the data in the MNU or MNS file to a CUI file without modifying the original menu file. The new CUI file is an XML-based file that has the same name as your original menu file, but with a .cui extension.

72 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

You can also transfer customization information between files. For example, you can transfer toolbars from a partial CUI file to the main CUI file so that the program can display the toolbar information. NOTE Button images may not appear in the program when you transfer a toolbar or menu from a partial CUI file. If the images are loaded from an image file, those images must reside in a folder that is defined under Support File Search Path or Custom Icon Location of the Files tab in the Options dialog box. If the images come from a third party resource DLL, contact the party who created the resource DLL. NOTE The Migrate Custom Settings dialog box can be used to migrate menu customization from previous releases. To access the Migrate Custom Settings dialog box, click Start menu (Windows) ➤ All Programs (or Programs) ➤ Autodesk ➤ [Autodesk product name] ➤ Migrate Custom Settings. Future releases will migrate button images in the folder defined under Custom Icon Location on the Files tab of the Options dialog box. In addition, you can move customizations from the main CUI file to partial CUI files, or from a partial CUI file to another partial CUI file. If a workspace or toolbar you are transferring contains flyout toolbars with references to another menu, toolbar, or flyout toolbar that is located in the source CUI file, the relevant information for that interface element is also transferred. For example, if you transfer the Draw toolbar, which references the Insert toolbar, the Insert toolbar is also transferred. A CUI file keeps track of any customizations you make. Customization data is tracked and preserved from release to release, so you can load a CUI file in another version without losing data or modifying existing CUI data. Following is an example of the Customize User Interface editor, Transfer tab. You use this tab to migrate customizations.

Migrate and Transfer Customizations | 73

NOTE CUI files cannot be displayed or used in versions prior to AutoCAD 2006. To transfer customizations 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Import Customizations.At the Command prompt, enter cuiimport. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Transfer tab, in the left pane, click the Open Customization File button.

74 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

3 In the Open dialog box, locate the customization file (MNU, MNS, or CUI) from which you want to export customizations, and select it. 4 In the right pane, click the Open Customization File button. 5 In the Open dialog box, locate the customization file (MNU, MNS, or CUI) to which you want to import customizations, and select it. 6 In the left pane, click the plus sign (+) next to an interface element node to expand it. Expand the corresponding node in the right pane. 7 Drag an interface element from the left pane to the appropriate location in the right pane. Menus can be dragged to menus, toolbars to toolbars, and so on.

8 Click OK.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts CUIEXPORT Exports customized settings from acad.cui to an enterprise or partial CUI file CUIIMPORT Imports customized settings from an enterprise or partial CUI file to acad.cui

Migrate and Transfer Customizations | 75

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Create and Load a Partial CUI File Create, load, or unload partial customization files as you need them. Loading and using a partial CUI file allows you to create and modify most interface elements (toolbars, menus, and so on) in a separate CUI file without having to import the customizations to your main CUI file. The order of the partial CUI files in the Partial CUI Files tree determines the order they are loaded in the program. You can rearrange the tree hierarchy to change the load order. Use the Transfer tab of the Customize User Interface editor to create a partial CUI file. See To transfer customizations (page 74) for more information. To load or unload a CUI file, you can use the CUILOAD or CUIUNLOAD command in the program or you can use the Customize tab in the Customize User Interface editor. Commands and elements can be added to a partial CUI file that is loaded under the main CUI file. To add a command to a partial CUI file, the partial CUI file must be selected from the drop-down list at the top of the Customizations In pane. Once the partial CUI file is selected, any new command will be added to the partial CUI file. See To add commands to a partial CUI file (page 79) for more information. NOTE When you load a partial CUI file, its workspace information (menus, toolbars, and palettes) is ignored by the main CUI file. To add workspace content from a partial CUI file to a main CUI file, you must transfer the workspace. For more information, see “Import a Workspace to a Main CUI File” in the Customize Workspaces (page 236) topic. To load a partial CUI file using the CUILOAD command 1 At the command prompt, enter cuiload.

76 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

2 In the Load/Unload Customizations dialog box, in the File Name box, enter a path to the CUI file you want to load, or click Browse to locate the file. 3 Click Load, and then click Close. To load a partial CUI file using the Customize tab 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, select Main CUI File from the drop-down list. To the right of the drop-down list, click the Load Partial Customization File button.

3 In the Open dialog box, locate and click the partial CUI file you want to open, and click Open. NOTE If the partial CUI file you are attempting to load has the same customization group name as the main CUI file, you need to change the customization group name. Open the CUI file in the Customize User Interface dialog box, select the customization group name, and right-click to rename it. 4 To verify that the file has been loaded into the main CUI file, in the Customizations In pane, select the main CUI file from the drop-down list.

5 In the tree view of the main customization file, click the plus sign (+) next to the Partial CUI Files node to expand it.

Create and Load a Partial CUI File | 77

Any partial menus loaded in the main CUI file are displayed. 6 Click OK. To unload a partial CUI file using the CUIUNLOAD command 1 At the command prompt, enter cuiunload. 2 In the Load/Unload Customizations dialog box, in the Loaded Customizations Group box, select a CUI file. 3 Click Unload, and then click Close. To unload a partial CUI file using the Customize tab 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, select Main CUI File from the drop-down list.

3 In the tree view of the main customization file, click the plus sign (+) next to the Partial CUI Files node to expand it. Any partial menus loaded in the main CUI file are displayed. 4 Right-click the partial menu that you want to unload. Click Unload CUI File.

78 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

The file is removed from the list. 5 Click OK. To add commands to a partial CUI file 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, select the partial CUI file from the drop-down list.

3 In the Commands List pane, click Create a New Command.

4 Adjust the properties of the new command in the Properties pane as necessary.

Create and Load a Partial CUI File | 79

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts CUILOAD Loads a CUI file CUIUNLOAD Unloads a CUI file

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Create an Enterprise CUI File An enterprise CUI file typically stores customization information that is shared by many users, but is controlled by a CAD manager. Enterprise CUI files make maintaining and modifying customization data easier for the individual responsible for controlling company standards. Create an enterprise CUI file by performing the following tasks: ■

Create an enterprise CUI file from an existing CUI file or a new CUI file. Make a copy of the main customization file (acad.cui) or another customization file of your choice that contains all the base user interface elements you need. If you want to start with a new customization file, use the Transfer tab to create a blank customization file.

80 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface



Designate the new file as your main CUI file. Using the Options dialog box, you must load the customization file as your the main customization file so you make edits to all of the different user interface elements. Make sure to note which customization file is currently designated as the main customization file, as you will need to restore it later.



Modify the contents of the enterprise CUI file. Once the customization file is designated as the main customization file, you can change the customization group name and modify the CUI file contents as needed. Changing the customization group name allows you to load more than one CUI file in the program at one time. CUI files with the same customization group name cannot be loaded into the program.



Replace the main CUI file. Using the Options dialog box, replace the previous customization file that was designated as the main customization file.



Save the enterprise CUI file to a shared network location. When you save the new enterprise file to a shared network location, all of your users that have access to the specified location can access the file. NOTE The folder where you place the enterprise CUI file should be in a shared location that your users can access. To learn more about creating a network share, see “How to Create a Network Share” in the Network Administrator's Guide.



Specify the enterprise CUI file location. The program automatically designates an enterprise customization file as read-only when you specify its file location in the Options dialog box. Specifying the enterprise customization file location can be done on individual workstations or in the Deployment wizard. For more information about setting the location in the Deployment wizard, see “Select Search Paths and File Locations” in the Network Administrator's Guide. WARNING Even though the Customize User Interface (CUI) editor loads the enterprise customization file as read-only, this still doesn’t completely protect the file from being modified. The enterprise customization file could be loaded as the main customization file and then modified. To protect the enterprise customization file, the location where it is stored be marked as read-only and write access should be limited to those you want to be able to edit the file.

Create an Enterprise CUI File | 81

To designate a CUI file as an enterprise CUI file 1 On each user's workstation in AutoCAD, click Tools menu ➤ Options.On each user's workstation in AutoCAD, at the Command prompt, enter options. 2 In the Options dialog box, Files tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Customization Files to expand the list.

3 Click the plus sign next to Enterprise Customization File to open it. 4 Select the item below Main Customization Files and click Browse.

5 In the Select a File dialog box, browse to the location of the enterprise customization file. Click Open. The CUI file must be saved in a shared network location that users can access. 6 In the Options dialog box, click OK. NOTE In the Deployment wizard, you designate the enterprise CUI file in the wizard's Specify Settings page. For more information about designating an enterprise CUI file in the Deployment wizard, see “Select Search Paths and File Locations” in the Network Administrator's Guide.

82 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

To modify an enterprise CUI file 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Options.At the Command prompt, enter options. 2 In the Options dialog box, Files tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Customization Files to expand the list. 3 Click the plus sign next to Main Customization File to expand it. Take note of the current main CUI file’s name and location as you will need to restore it later. 4 Select the item below Main Customization Files and click Browse. In the Select a File dialog box, browse to the location of the enterprise customization file. Click Open. 5 Click the plus sign next to Enterprise Customization File to expand it. Take note of the current enterprise CUI file’s name and location as you will need to restore it later. 6 Select the item below Enterprise Customization Files and click Browse. In the Select a File dialog box, browse to the location of the main customization file. Click Open. 7 In the Options dialog box, click OK to save the changes. 8 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 9 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Commands List pane, create new commands and user interface elements as necessary. 10 Once done adding new commands and user interface elements, click OK. Switch the file names of the main and enterprise values around in the Options dialog box. The main and enterprise CUI files should now resemble the original configuration prior to making the changes. TIP You can create two different profiles that are used to switch between your main and enterprise CUI files. One profile will have the CUI files in a normal configuration that is used by your drafters, and the other profile has the main and enterprise CUI files switched around.

Create an Enterprise CUI File | 83

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts CUIEXPORT Exports customized settings from acad.cui to an enterprise or partial CUI file CUILOAD Loads a CUI file CUIUNLOAD Unloads a CUI file MENU Loads a customization file OPTIONS Customizes the program settings

System Variables ENTERPRISEMENU Displays the file name for the enterprise CUI (if defined), including the path for the file name

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Customize Commands You can easily create, edit, and reuse commands. The Customize tab of the Customize User Interface editor displays a master list of commands that are

84 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

loaded in the product. You can add any commands from this list to toolbars, menus, and other user interface elements. When you change properties of a command in the master list or on the tree view, the properties of the command are changed everywhere that command is used. The following table shows the Scale command properties as they appear in the Properties pane. Properties for the Scale command on the Modify menu Properties Description pane item

Example

Name

String displayed as a menu name or as a tooltip when you click a toolbar button. The string must include alphanumeric characters with no punctuation other than a hyphen (-) or an underscore (_).

Sca&le

Description

Status line text. This string is displayed on the status bar when the cursor hovers over a toolbar button or menu item.

Enlarges or reduces objects proportionally in the X, Y, and Z directions: SCALE

Macro

The command macro. It follows the standard macro syntax.

$M=$(if,$(eq,$(substr,$( getvar,cmdnames),1,4), GRIP),_scale,^C^C_scale)

NOTE When you change the name of a macro, the name of its corresponding menu item or toolbar button does not change. You must change a menu item or toolbar button name by selecting it in the tree view.

Element ID

Tag that uniquely identifies a command.

ID_Scale

Small Image

ID string of the small-image resource (16 × 16 bitmap). The string must include alphanumeric characters with no punctuation other than a hyphen (-) or an underscore (_). It can also be a user-defined bitmap. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Select Image File dialog box.

RCDATA_16_SCALE

Customize Commands | 85

Properties for the Scale command on the Modify menu Properties Description pane item

Example

Large Image

RCDATA_16_SCALE

ID string of the large-image resource (32 × 32 bitmap). If the specified bitmap is not 32 × 32, the program scales it to that size. The string must include alphanumeric characters with no punctuation other than a hyphen (-) or an underscore (_). It can also be a user-defined bitmap. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Select Image File dialog box

Create, Edit, and Reuse Commands You can create a new command from scratch, copy an existing command to create a new command, or edit the properties of an existing command. When you create or edit a command, the properties you can define are the command name, description, macro, element ID (for new commands only), and small or large image. When you change any properties of a command in the Command List pane, the command is updated for all interface items that reference that command. To create a command 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, Command List pane, click Create a New Command.

86 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

A new command (named Command1) is displayed in both the Command List pane and the Properties pane. 3 In the Properties pane, do the following: ■

In the Name box, enter a name for the command. The name will be displayed as a tooltip or menu name when you select this command.



In the Description box, enter a description for the command. The description will be displayed on the status bar when the cursor hovers over the menu item or toolbar button.



In the Macro box, enter a macro for the command.



In the Element ID box, enter an element ID for the command.

For information about adding a button image to a command, see Create Images for Commands (page 106).

To remove a command 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, Command List pane, select Custom from the Filter drop-down list. The list is filtered to only show the commands that you have created in the loaded customization files. 3 Select the command to be removed, and right-click over the command. 4 Click Remove.

Create, Edit, and Reuse Commands | 87

NOTE A command only can be removed when it is not being referenced by a user interface element, such as a toolbar or menu. WARNING There is no way to undo the removal of a command or user interface element from inside the Customize User Interface editor, so be careful when removing commands and user interface elements. If you accidentally remove the wrong command or user interface element the best thing to do is click Cancel, but this will also undo any other changes that you might have made. If you already made several changes to the CUI file and don't want to lose the changes that you already made, you can open the backup CUI file that is automatically created after a change is made to a CUI file from the Transfer tab and then proceed to recover the command or user interface element that was accidentally removed.

To edit a command 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, do one of the following: ■

In the Command List pane, click the command you want to edit.



In the tree view pane, locate and then click the command you want to edit.

88 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

3 In the Properties pane, do any of the following to edit the command: ■

In the Name box, enter a new name for the command. In the program, the name is displayed on the menu where you assign this command.



In the Description box, enter a new description for the command. The description is displayed on the status bar when the command is selected in the program.



In the Macro box, enter a new macro for the command.



In the Element ID box, enter a new element ID for the command. (For new commands only. You cannot modify the element ID of an existing command).

For information about adding a button image to a command, see Create Images for Commands (page 106).

Create, Edit, and Reuse Commands | 89

To reuse a command 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, Command List pane, locate the command you want to reuse and drag it to an interface element.

To copy and paste a command 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui.

90 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, Command List pane, locate the command you want to copy. 3 Right-click over the command. Click Copy.

4 Right-click over a UI element like a toolbar or menu. Click Paste.

NOTE The key combination CTRL+C can be used to copy a command and CTRL+V can be used to paste a command in the Command List pane.

To duplicate a command 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui.

Create, Edit, and Reuse Commands | 91

2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, Command List pane, locate the command you want to duplicate. 3 Right-click over the command. Click Duplicate.

A copy of the selected command is created in-place directly above the selection in the Command List pane. NOTE The key combination CTRL+D can be used to duplicate a command in-place.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts

92 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Find Command Names and Search Strings You can search one or more CUI files for commands or search strings (including command or UI element names, descriptions, and macros). You can also replace commands or search strings one at a time or all at once. You can limit or expand your search depending on the search results you want to achieve. ■

Limit the search to commands located in the Command List pane. This search does not include the names of UI elements, the commands that are associated to them, and their properties. For example, if you limit the search for the LINE command in the Command List only, a message similar to the following is displayed when you start your search: “Command found in tree node 'Line' (1/3).”



Expand the search to include all properties in all tree view nodes in the Customizations In pane. This type of search finds all instances or a search string. For example, if you search for the search string “line” and start in the tree view, a message similar to the following is displayed: “Search string found in tree node 'Linear' property 'Name' at position 0 (1/358).”

To find a search string in a CUI file 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, right-click anywhere in the tree view of the Customizations In pane. Click Find.

Find Command Names and Search Strings | 93

3 In the Find and Replace dialog box, Find tab, do the following: ■

In the Find What box, enter the search string.



In the Ignore Case option, clear the check box if you want the search to find every instance of the search string regardless of its case.



In the Restrict Search To option, select the check box if you want to restrict the search to just one CUI file. Then, under this option, select a CUI file from the drop-down list.



Click Find Next to locate all instances of the search string.

A message is displayed that details the location of the search string and the number of results generated from the search.

4 Click Find Next to continue your search. 5 Click Close. 6 In the Customize User Interface editor, click Close.

94 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

To find a search string in the Command List pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, right-click anywhere in the list view of the Command List pane. Click Find. 3 In the Find and Replace dialog box, Find tab, do the following: ■

In the Find What box, enter the search string.



In the Ignore Case option, clear the check box if you want the search to find every instance of the search string regardless of its case.



In the Restrict Search To option, select the check box if you want to restrict the search to just one CUI file. Then, under this option, select a CUI file from the drop-down list.



Click Find Next to locate all instances of the search string.

A message is displayed that details the location of the search string and the number of results generated from the search.

4 Click Find Next to continue your search. 5 Click Close. 6 In the Customize User Interface editor, click Close.

Find Command Names and Search Strings | 95

To find where a command in the Command List pane is used 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Command List pane, right-click the command name you want to find. Click Find.

3 In the Find and Replace dialog box, Find tab, do the following: ■

In the Find What box, enter the command name.



In the Ignore Case option, clear the check box if you want the search to find every instance of the search string regardless of its case.



Click Find Selected Command to locate all instances of the command.

4 In the text that is displayed, view each location of the command or search string, its exact position in the tree node or Properties pane, and the number of instances in which the command or search string occurs. 5 Click Find Selected Command to continue your search. 6 Click Close. 7 In the Customize User Interface editor, click Close.

96 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

To replace a search string 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, Customizations In pane, right-click anywhere in the tree view. Click Replace.

3 In the Find and Replace dialog box, Replace tab, do the following: ■

In the Find What box, enter the search string.



In the Replace With box, specify the text string you want to use to replace the found string.



In the Ignore Case option, clear the check box if you want the search to find every instance of the search string, regardless of its case.



In the Restrict Search To option, select the check box if you want to restrict the search to just one CUI file. Then, under this option, select a CUI file from the drop-down list.



To step through each instance of a found string before replacing it, click Replace. In the text that is displayed, view each location of the search string, its exact position in the tree node or Properties pane, and the number of instances in which the search string occurs. You cannot undo this action.



To replace all instances of the search string, click Replace All. You cannot undo this action.

Find Command Names and Search Strings | 97

4 Click Close. 5 In the Customize User Interface editor, click Close. To replace a command 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, Command List pane, right-click the command name you want to replace. Click Replace.

3 In the Find and Replace dialog box, Replace tab, in the Find What box, the command name you selected in the previous step is displayed. To complete the dialog box, do the following: ■

In the Replace With box, specify the command name you want to use to replace the found command.



In the Ignore Case option, clear the check box if you want the search to find every instance of the command, regardless of its case.



To step through each instance of a command name before replacing it, click Replace. In the text that is displayed, view each location of the command, its exact position in the tree node or Properties pane,

98 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

and the number of instances in which the command occurs. By renaming the command in the command list, you rename the command everywhere that command is used in the CUI file. You cannot undo this action. ■

To replace all instances of the command, click Replace All. You cannot undo this action.

4 Click Close. 5 In the Customize User Interface editor, click Close.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts

Find Command Names and Search Strings | 99

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Control the Display of Command Labels You can control the way that menu labels indicate a command's availability in the program. Display menu commands as grayed out (disabled), mark them with a check mark or border, or use a combination of indicators. Menu commands can also contain DIESEL string expressions that gray out, mark, or interactively change the text of the displayed label. For more information about using DIESEL expressions, see DIESEL Expressions in Macros (page 272).

Gray Out (Disable) Menu Labels To gray out a label in a menu, you begin the command name with a tilde (~). Any commands associated with the item are not issued, and submenus are inaccessible. In the following example, the tilde (~) is placed at the beginning of the Copy Link command label in the Name cell of the Properties pane.

100 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Following is the resulting Copy Link command grayed out in the Edit menu.

Command labels can contain DIESEL string expressions that conditionally disable or enable command labels each time they are displayed. For example, the DIESEL string expression in the Macros cell of the Properties pane disables the MOVE command while any other command is active. $(if,$(getvar,cmdactive),~)MOVE^C^C_move

The AutoLISP menucmd function can also be used to disable and enable items from a macro or application. For examples, see Reference Pull-Down or Shortcut Menus (page 170).

Control the Display of Command Labels | 101

Mark Menu Labels You can mark a menu label by including an exclamation point and a period (!.) in the Name cell of the Properties pane for the command. A menu item is marked in one of two ways: ■

A check mark. Displayed when a menu item does not have an image associated with it.



A border. Displayed when a menu item has an image associated with it; a border is displayed around the image.

Following is an example of the Edit menu with the Copy Link command marked with a check mark and the Paste command's image marked with a border:

Command labels can also contain DIESEL string expressions that conditionally mark command labels each time they are displayed. When the following DIESEL string is added to the Macros cell for the applicable command in the Properties pane, a check mark is placed to the left of the menu label whose related system variable is currently enabled. $(if,$(getvar,orthomode),!.)Ortho^O $(if,$(getvar,snapmode),!.)Snap^B $(if,$(getvar,gridmode),!.)Grid^G

The AutoLISP menucmd function can be used to mark labels from a macro or application. For examples, see Reference Pull-Down or Shortcut Menus (page 170).

102 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Simultaneously Disable and Mark Command Labels You can mark and disable commands at the same time using either of the following formats: ~!. labeltext !.~ labeltext

The tilde (~) is the special character code to disable a command and an exclamation point and period (!.) is the special character code to mark a command. The tilde (~), exclamation point, and period (!.) are placed at the beginning of the Copy Link command label in the Name cell of the Properties pane. Following is the resulting Copy Link marked and grayed out in the Edit menu.

As with the previous examples, a DIESEL expression can be used to simultaneously disable and mark a command label. To gray out (disable) a command's menu label 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the menu that contains the command you want to disable. 3 Click the command you want to gray out.

Control the Display of Command Labels | 103

4 In the Properties pane, in the Name cell, add a tilde (~) at the beginning of the command

NOTE The command must be selected from the Customizations In pane, otherwise you are just modifying the name of the command and not the label that is displayed to the user. 5 Click OK. The changes to the command will be visible after the changes have been applied and the CUI editor is closed.

To mark command's menu label 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the menu that contains the command you want to mark. 3 Click the command you want to mark.

104 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

4 In the Properties pane, in the Name cell, add an exclamation point and a period (!.) at the beginning of the command.

5 Click OK. The changes to the command will be visible after the changes have been applied and the CUI editor is closed.

To simultaneously gray out (disable) and mark a command's menu label 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the menu that contains the command you want to disable and mark. 3 Click the command you want to gray out and mark.

Control the Display of Command Labels | 105

4 In the Properties pane, in the Name cell, add a tilde, an exclamation point, and a period (~!. or !.~) at the beginning of the command. 5 Click OK.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Create Images for Commands Images can be associated with a command, and are displayed on a toolbar button or next to a menu item in a pull-down menu. You can use images that come with the program or create your own. Autodesk provides standard button images for buttons that start commands. You can create custom button images to run custom macros. You can either modify an existing button image or create your own. Button images are saved as BMP files. The BMP files must be saved in the same folder as the CUI file that it references. User-defined bitmaps can be used in place of the small image and large image resource names in button and flyout commands. Small images should be 16 x 16 pixels. Large images should be 32 x 32 pixels. Images that do not match these sizes are scaled to fit.

106 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

To edit or create a button image 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Command List pane or the Customizations In pane, click a command to display the Button Image pane (in the upper-right corner).

3 In the Button Image pane, click a button that is closest in appearance to the button you want to create. Click Edit. TIP If you want to start with a blank image, select any image from the list under the Button Images pane. Click Edit to start the Button Editor. In the Button Editor, click Clear located on the left side. 4 In the Button Editor, use the Pencil, Line, Circle, and Erase buttons to create or edit the button image. To use color, select a color from the color palette, or click More to open the Select Color dialog box. ■

Pencil button. Edits one pixel at a time in the selected color. You can drag the pointing device to edit several pixels at once.



Line button. Creates lines in the selected color. Click and hold to set the first endpoint of the line. Drag to draw the line. Release to complete the line.



Circle button. Creates circles in the selected color. Click and hold to set the center of the circle. Drag to set the radius. Release to complete the circle.



Erase button. Resets the color of one pixel at a time to an off white color.

NOTE You cannot edit flyout buttons.

Create Images for Commands | 107

5 To save the customized button as a BMP file, click Save. Use Save As to save it under a different name. Save the new button image to the following location: C:\Documents and Settings\\Application Data\Autodesk\\\\Support\Icons NOTE You can save buttons in BMP (*.bmp, *.rle, or *.dib) format only. When saving a button image, the Button Editor defaults to the folder defined under Custom Icon Location on the Files tab of the Options dialog box. Button image files placed in the folder can be migrated with the Migrate Custom Settings dialog box in future releases. To assign a standard image to a command 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Command List pane, click any command to display the Button Image pane (in the upper-right corner) and the Properties pane (in the lower-right corner).

3 In the Button Image pane, select one of the three image assignment options; Large, Small, or Both.

108 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

4 Select an image from the image list and the image name is assigned to the Small and/or Large image property of the selected command.

NOTE As you select an image from the image list, the image’s name is displayed between the preview of the image and the Edit button in the Button Image pane. If the image is a custom image stored in a bitmap file, the file name is displayed.

To assign a custom image to a command 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Command List pane, click any command to display the Button Image pane (in the upper-right corner) and the Properties pane (in the lower-right corner).

Create Images for Commands | 109

3 In the Properties pane, select the field next to the Small image property. An Ellipse button will be displayed on the right side of the property. 4 Click the Ellipse button next to the property.

5 In the Select Image File dialog box, browse to the image file that you want to use for the command. 6 Repeat steps 3 through 6 for the Large image property of the command. To import a custom image to the image list 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Command List pane, click any command to display the Button Image pane.

110 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

3 Right-click over the list of images in the Button Image pane and select Import Image.

4 In the Open dialog box, browse to and select the BMP image file that you want to import and click Open. 5 Select the image assignment option Small, Large, or Both from the Button Image pane and then the select the image that you imported from the list of images.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts

System Variables TOOLTIPS Controls the display of tooltips on toolbars

Create Images for Commands | 111

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Create Status Line Help Messages Status line Help messages are the simple, descriptive messages that are displayed on the status line (at the bottom of the drawing area) when the pointing device hovers over a menu option or toolbar button. You can change or add descriptions for menus and buttons by updating the Description property for the related command. See also: To create a status line Help message 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, click the Customize tab. 3 In the Command List pane, click the command to which you want to add a Help message.

The Properties pane is displayed on the right side of the dialog box. 4 In the Properties pane, Description box, enter the descriptive text for the selected command.

112 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

5 Click the Apply button. The next time you use the command, the descriptive text you added is displayed in the status line when you hover your mouse button over a toolbar button or menu item.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts

Create Status Line Help Messages | 113

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Create Macros A macro defines the action that results when an interface element is selected. A macro accomplishes a drawing task that would otherwise take a series of actions by a user. A macro can contain commands, special characters, DIESEL (Direct Interpretively Evaluated String Expression Language) or AutoLISP programming code. NOTE As AutoCAD is revised and enhanced, the sequence of prompts for various commands (and sometimes command names) might change. Therefore, your custom macros might require minor changes when you upgrade to a new release of AutoCAD. You add macros to interface elements by using the Customize User Interface editor. Select an existing command or create a new command in the Command List pane. Enter macros in the Macros section of the Properties pane. There are no length limitations for macros. However, you do need to know how specific characters are used in macros and be aware of other considerations or limitations.

Macro Basics A macro in a user interface element can be as simple as a command (such as circle) and some special characters (such as ^C^C).

114 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

For example, the macro ^C^C_circle \1, draws a circle with a radius of 1 unit. The components that define this macro are explained in the table below. Components in CIRCLE macro

Component

Component type

Result

^C^C

Special control character

Cancels any running commands

_

Special control character

Automatically translates the command that follows into other languages

CIRCLE

Command

Starts the CIRCLE command

\

Special control character

Creates a pause for the user to specify the center point

1

Special control character

Responds to the prompt for the circle's radius (1)

For a list of special control characters that you can use in macros, see Use Special Control Characters in Macros (page 117).

Cancel Running Commands Make sure that you have no AutoCAD commands in progress before you execute a macro. To automatically cancel a command before executing a macro, enter ^C^C at the beginning of the macro (which is the same as pressing ESC twice). Although a single ^C cancels most commands, ^C^C is required to return to the Command prompt from a dimensioning command and ^C^C^C is required based on the current option of the Layer command. ^C^C handles canceling out of most command sequences and therefore is the recommended sequence used to ensure no command is active before the macro is started.

Verify Macro Characters Every character in a macro is significant, even a blank space.

Create Macros | 115

When you place a space at the end of the macro, AutoCAD processes the macro as though you had entered a command (circle, for example) and then pressed the SPACEBAR to complete the command.

Terminate Macros Some macros require special terminators. Some commands (TEXT, for example) require you to press ENTER rather than SPACEBAR to terminate the command. Some commands require more than one space (or ENTER) to complete, but some text editors cannot create a line with trailing blanks. Two special conventions resolve these problems. ■

A semicolon (;) in a macro automatically issues ENTER at the command prompt.



If a line ends with a control character, a backslash (\), a plus sign (+), or a semicolon (;), AutoCAD does not add a blank space after it.

An item that ends with a backslash (\) pauses a macro for user input. Compare the following macros: ucs ucs ;

The first example enters ucs at the command prompt and presses SPACEBAR. The following prompt is displayed. Specify origin of UCS or [Face/NAmed/OBject/Previous/View/World/X/Y/Z/ZAxis] : The second example enters ucs, presses SPACEBAR, and presses ENTER, which accepts the default value (World).

Suppress Echoes and Prompts in Macros Characters in a macro appear in the command window as though you had typed the characters on the keyboard. They are also displayed in the user interface element. This display duplication is called “echoing”. You can suppress the “echoed” displays with the MENUECHO system variable. If echoes and prompts from item input are turned off, a ^P in the item turns them off.

116 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Create Long Macros You can create a macro of any length, without requiring any special characters at the end of a line. The Properties pane in the Customize User Interface editor accepts a macro of any length.

Use Special Control Characters in Macros You can use special characters, including control characters, in macros. In a macro, the caret (^) is equivalent to pressing the CTRL key on the keyboard. You can combine the caret with another character to construct macros that do such things as turn the grid on and off (^G) or cancel a command (^C). The macro for the Address command below uses the backslash (\) to pause for user input and the semicolon (;) for ENTER. text \.4 0 DRAFT Inc;;;Main St.;;;City, State;

The macro starts the TEXT command, pauses for the user to specify a start point, and then enters the address on three lines. In the triple semicolon (;;;), the first semicolon ends the text string, the second repeats TEXT, and the third accepts the default placement below the previous line. Macros use the special characters listed in the following table. Special characters used in macros Character

Description

;

Issues ENTER

^M

Issues ENTER

^I

Issues TAB

[blank space]

Enters a space; a blank space between command sequences in a command is equivalent to pressing the SPACEBAR

\

Pauses for user input (cannot be used with accelerators)

.

Allows you to access a built-in AutoCAD command even if it was undefined using the UNDEFINE command.

Use Special Control Characters in Macros | 117

Special characters used in macros Character

Description

_

Translates AutoCAD commands and options that follow

=*

Displays the current top-level pull-down, shortcut, or image menu

*^C^C

Repeats a command until another command is chosen

$

Introduces a conditional DIESEL macro expression ($M=)

^B

Turns Snap on or off (equivalent to CTRL+B)

^C

Cancels the active command or command option (equivalent to ESC)

^D

Turns Dynamic UCS on or off (equivalent to CTRL+D)

^E

Sets the next isometric plane (equivalent to CTRL+E)

^G

Turns Grid on or off (equivalent to CTRL+G)

^H

Issues BACKSPACE

^O

Turns Ortho on or off

^P

Turns MENUECHO on or off

^Q

Echoes all prompts, status listings, and input to the printer (equivalent to CTRL+Q)

^T

Turns tablet on or off (equivalent to CTRL+T)

^V

Changes the current viewport

^Z

Null character that suppresses the automatic addition of SPACEBAR at the end of a command

118 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts CUILOAD Loads a CUI file CUIUNLOAD Unloads a CUI file

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Pause for User Input in Macros To accept input from the keyboard or pointing device in the middle of a command, place a backslash (\) in the macro at the point where you want input. circle \1

In the circle example, \1 pauses for the user to specify the center point and then reads a radius of 1. Note that there is no space after the backslash. -layer off \;

In this example, the macro starts LAYER at the command prompt (-layer), enters the Off option (off), and then pauses for the user to enter a layer name (\). The macro then turns that layer off and exits the LAYER command (;).

Pause for User Input in Macros | 119

NOTE LAYER normally prompts for another operation and exits only if you press SPACEBAR or ENTER. In the macro, the semicolon (;) is the equivalent of pressing ENTER. A macro typically resumes after one user input, such as a single point location. Therefore, you cannot construct a macro that accepts a variable number of inputs (as in object selection) and then continues. However, an exception is made for SELECT: a backslash (\) suspends the SELECT command until object selection has been completed. Consider the following example: select \change previous ;properties color red ;

In this macro, SELECT creates a selection set of one or more objects (select \). The macro then starts CHANGE (change), references the selection set using the Previous option (previous;), and changes the color of all selected objects to red (properties color red ;). NOTE The backslash character (\) causes a macro to pause for user input. You cannot use a backslash for any other purpose in a macro. When you need to specify a file directory path, use a forward slash (/) as the path delimiter: for example, /direct/file. The following circumstances delay resumption of a macro after a pause: ■

If input of a point location is expected, object snap modes may be used before the point is specified.



If X/Y/Z point filters are used, the command remains suspended until the entire point has been accumulated.



For SELECT only, the macro does not resume until object selection has been completed.



If the user responds with a transparent command, the suspended macro remains suspended until the transparent command is completed and the originally requested input is received.



If the user responds by choosing another command (to supply options or to execute a transparent command), the original macro is suspended, and the newly selected item is processed to completion. Then, the suspended macro is resumed.

NOTE When command input comes from a command, the settings of the PICKADD and PICKAUTO system variables are assumed to be 1 and 0, respectively. This preserves compatibility with previous releases of AutoCAD and makes customization easier because you are not required to check the settings of these variables.

120 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Quick Reference Commands CHANGE Changes the properties of existing objects SELECT Places selected objects in the Previous selection set

System Variables PICKADD Controls whether subsequent selections replace the current selection set or add to it PICKAUTO Controls automatic windowing at the Select Objects prompt

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Provide International Support in Macros To develop menus that can be used with a non-English-language version of AutoCAD, precede each command or option with the underscore character (_). The underscore character allows the standard commands and options to be translated automatically.

Provide International Support in Macros | 121

Quick Reference Commands CHANGE Changes the properties of existing objects SELECT Places selected objects in the Previous selection set

System Variables PICKADD Controls whether subsequent selections replace the current selection set or add to it PICKAUTO Controls automatic windowing at the Select Objects prompt

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Use Built-in Commands in Macros To develop macros that use built-in commands that are part of AutoCAD, precede each command with the period character (.). The period character allows the built-in command to be used even if it has been undefined with the UNDEFINE command making the macro predicable when it is used on other systems that share the same customization file.

122 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Quick Reference Commands REDEFINE Restores AutoCAD internal commands overridden by UNDEFINE UNDEFINE Allows an application-defined command to override an internal command

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Repeat Commands in Macros You can use a leading asterisk (*) to repeat a command in a macro until you choose another command. Once you have selected a command, you might want to use it several times before moving on to another command. In a macro, you can repeat a command until you choose another command. You cannot use this feature to choose options. If a macro begins with *^C^C, the command is repeated until you terminate by pressing ESC on the keyboard or by selecting another command. NOTE Do not use ^C (Cancel) within a macro that begins with the string *^C^C; this cancels the repetition. The macros in the following examples repeat the commands:

Repeat Commands in Macros | 123

*^C^Cmove Single *^C^Ccopy Single *^C^Cerase Single *^C^Cstretch Single Crossing *^C^Crotate Single *^C^Cscale Single

Each macro in the example starts a command and then prompts you to select an object. Any other prompts necessary to complete the command are displayed, and then the command ends and starts again. NOTE Command repetition cannot be used in macros for image tile menus.

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Use Single Object Selection Mode in Macros Single Object Selection mode cancels the normal repetition of the Select Objects prompt in editing commands. After you select one object and respond to any other prompts, the command ends. Consider the macro in the following example: *^C^Cerase single

This macro terminates the current command and starts ERASE in Single Object Selection mode. After you choose this command, you either select a single

124 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

object to be erased or click a blank area in the drawing and specify window selection. Any objects selected in this way are erased, and the command is repeated (due to the leading asterisk) so that you can erase additional objects. Press ESC to exit this mode.

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Use Macros to Swap User Interface Elements You can replace the contents of active menus, mouse buttons, tablet buttons, tablet menus, or screen menus. The swapped content can be that of another user interface element of the same type in the main CUI file, or it can come from a partial CUI file. You cannot swap interface elements that are of different types (menus and mouse buttons, for example). However, within a given type, you can swap any user interface element for any other element. NOTE Swapping can lead to some strange behavior for tablet menus, because they typically have a different number of macros. Use the following syntax in a macro to swap elements: $section=menugroup.menuname

The following describes each section of the macro syntax for swapping elements:

Use Macros to Swap User Interface Elements | 125

Macro syntax for swapping elements $ Loads an interface element section Specifies the element type. Valid names are: A1-A4 for Aux menus 1 through 4 B1-B4 for mouse buttons 1 through 4 P0-P16 for pull-down menus 0 through 16 I for the image tile menu S for the screen menu T1-T4 for tablet menus 1 through 4

infogroup Specifies the information group that menuname is a member of (not necessary if menuname is in the main CUI file). menuname Specifies which section or submenu to insert. It is the main label or alias for the section to load The following commands illustrate submenu referencing: $S=PARTS $T1=EDITCMDS

You can activate the submenu mechanism in the middle of a command without interrupting the command. For example, the following command strings are equivalent: $S=ARCSTUFF ARC ARC $S=ARCSTUFF

Each command starts the ARC command, switches to the ARCSTUFF screen submenu, and awaits the entry of arc parameters. A space must follow the submenu reference to separate it from subsequent commands in the command. A pull-down menu can be present either in the menu bar or on the active shortcut menu but not both.

126 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Use Conditional Expressions in Macros You can add conditional expressions to a macro by using a command that introduces macro expressions written in DIESEL (Direct Interpretively Evaluated String Expression Language). The format is: $M=expression

Introducing the macro with $M= tells AutoCAD to evaluate a string as a DIESEL expression, and that expression is the DIESEL expression. The following example defines a conditional expression in a macro: FILLMODE $M=$(-,1,$(getvar,fillmode))

The macro switches the FILLMODE system variable on and off by subtracting the current value of FILLMODE from 1 and returning the resulting value to the FILLMODE system variable. You can use this method to toggle system variables whose valid values are 1 or 0.

Termination of Macros That Contain Conditional Expressions If you use the DIESEL string language to perform “if-then” tests, conditions might exist where you do not want the normal terminating space or semicolon

Use Conditional Expressions in Macros | 127

(resulting in ENTER). If you add ^Z to the end of the macro, AutoCAD does not automatically add a space (ENTER) to the end of the macro expression. As with other control characters in commands, the ^Z used here is a string composed of ^ (a caret) and Z and is not equivalent to pressing CTRL+Z. In the following examples, ^Z is used as a macro terminator. ^C^C$M=$(if,$(=,$(getvar,tilemode),0),$S=mview _mspace )^Z ^C^C$M=$(if,$(=,$(getvar,tilemode),0),$S=mview _pspace )^Z

If these macros did not end with ^Z, AutoCAD would automatically add a space (ENTER), repeating the last command entered. See also: ■

Use Special Control Characters in Macros (page 117)



DIESEL (page 265)

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables FILLMODE Specifies whether hatches and fills, two-dimensional solids, and wide polylines are filled in

128 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Use AutoLISP in Macros Creating commands that use AutoLISP is a more advanced way to use the AutoCAD customization feature. You can use AutoLISP variables and expressions to create macros that perform complex tasks. To use AutoLISP efficiently in macros, place AutoLISP code in a separate MNL file. AutoCAD loads the MNL file when it loads a CUI file with the same name and in the same location. You can specify additional AutoLISP files to load in the Customize User Interface editor. Creating commands that use AutoLISP is a more advanced way to use the AutoCAD customization feature. Carefully study the following examples and the information in the AutoLISP Reference and the AutoLISP Developer's Guide. To access the additional help resources, click Help menu ➤ Additional Resources ➤ Developer Help.Experimentation and practice will help you use this feature effectively.

Call a Macro To programmatically execute a pull-down menu macro, use the following syntax: (menucmd "Gmenugroup.element_ID=|")

The previous syntax works only if the menu macro is part of a menu that is on the AutoCAD menu bar and is available for use. For more information about this syntax, see the AutoLISP Reference.

Preset Values An application that uses block insertion presets could provide commands like these: [Set WINWID][Set WALLTHK][Insert Window]

Use AutoLISP in Macros | 129

^C^C^P(setq WINWID (getreal "Enter window width: ")) ^P ^C^C^P(setq WALLTHK (getreal "Enter wall thickness: ")) ^P ^C^C_INSERT window XScale !WINWID YScale !WALLTHK

This code inserts the block named “window,” scaling its X axis to the current window width and its Y axis to the current wall thickness. In this example, the actual values come from the user-defined AutoLISP symbols WINWID and WALLTHK. The rotation is up to the user to decide so that the window can be rotated in the wall.

Resize Grips With the following commands, grip size adjustment can be done on the fly: ^P(setvar "gripsize"(1+ (getvar "gripsize")))(redraw)(princ) ^P(setvar "gripsize"(1- (getvar "gripsize")))(redraw)(princ)

To add validity checking to these commands, values less than 0 and greater than 255 cannot be used for the GRIPSIZE system variable.

Prompt for User Input The following item prompts for two points and draws a rectangular polyline with the specified points as its corners. ^P(setq a (getpoint "Enter first corner: "));\+ (setq b (getpoint "Enter opposite corner: "));\+ pline !a (list (car a)(cadr b)) !b (list (car b)(cadr a)) c;^P

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts CUILOAD Loads a CUI file CUIUNLOAD Unloads a CUI file

130 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Customize Toolbars Toolbar customization can be as easy as placing or resizing a toolbar in a drawing area to gain the most drawing efficiency or space. You can also create and modify toolbars and flyout toolbars, adding commands and control elements, and creating and editing toolbar buttons.

Create and Edit Toolbars Some of the simplest toolbar customizations can make your daily drawing tasks more efficient. For example, you can consolidate frequently used buttons onto one toolbar, remove buttons that you never use, or change some simple toolbar properties. You can also specify information to be displayed when the cursor passes over a button. You can add buttons to toolbars, remove buttons you use infrequently, and rearrange buttons and toolbars. You can also create your own toolbars and flyout toolbars, and create or change the button image associated with a toolbar command. When creating a toolbar, you can create a toolbar from scratch, create a copy of an existing toolbar, or create a toolbar from a pull-down menu. NOTE Sub-menu items are not included when the user copies a menu to a toolbar. NOTE When you create a toolbar, you should determine in which workspaces you want to display the toolbar. By default, a new toolbar is displayed in all workspaces.

Customize Toolbars | 131

The following table shows the Standard toolbar properties as they appear in the Properties pane. Properties for the Standard toolbar Properties Description pane item

Example

Name

String used as the caption for the toolbar.

Standard

Description

Text used to describe the element; does not appear in the user interface.

Standard Toolbar

On By Default

Specifies whether the toolbar is displayed or not the first time the CUI file is loaded. The values are Hide or Show.

Show

Orientation

Specifies whether the toolbar is floating or docked (top, bottom, left, or right) the first time the CUI file is loaded.

Top

Default X Location

Specifies the location from the left edge of the screen when the toolbar appears when it is floating, or the location when it is docked. If docked, a value of 0 indicates the left most location in a docked area.

0

Default Y Location

Specifies the location from the top edge of the screen when the toolbar appears when it is floating, or the location when it is docked. If docked, a value of 0 indicates the top most location in a docked area.

0

Rows

Specifies the number of rows the items on the toolbar are displayed in when the toolbar is floating.

1

Aliases

Specifies the aliases for the toolbar. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Aliases dialog box. Each alias in the CUI file should be unique

TB_STANDARD, Standard

132 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Properties for the Standard toolbar Properties Description pane item

Example

and it is used to reference the toolbar programatically. Element ID

Tag that uniquely identifies a toolbar.

ID_TbStandard

NOTE The properties On By Default, Orientation, Default X Location, Default Y Location, and Rows are used only the first time the CUI file is loaded and no default workspace is defined. After a toolbar is loaded the first time, a workspace can be used to control the Appearance properties of a toolbar. See the procedure To change the properties of a toolbar (page 249) for more information. WARNING Do not change the aliases for a toolbar that is being used as a flyout; otherwise the link between the toolbar and flyout will become broken. A flyout is a set of buttons nested under a single button on a toolbar. Flyout buttons have a black triangle in the lower-right corner. To create a flyout, you can start from scratch, drag an existing toolbar onto another toolbar, or drag a pull-down menu onto another toolbar. When a pull-down menu is dragged onto another toolbar, a new toolbar is created and a flyout is created in the position that the pull-down menu was dropped onto the toolbar. The following table shows the Zoom flyout properties as they appear in the Properties pane. Properties for the Zoom flyout on the Standard toolbar Properties Description pane item

Example

Name

String that does not appear in the user interface unless the property Use Own Button is set to Yes.

Zoom

Description

Text used to describe the element, does not appear in the user interface.

Create and Edit Toolbars | 133

Properties for the Zoom flyout on the Standard toolbar Properties Description pane item

Example

Source Toolbar

A read-only value used to specify which toolbar is being referenced to create the flyout.

TB_ZOOM

Use Own Button

Controls whether the last used toolbar button is set as the current button or not. The possible values are Yes or No.

No

Small Image

ID string of the small-image resource (16 × 16 bitmap). The string must include alphanumeric characters with no punctuation other than a hyphen (-) or an underscore (_). It can also be a user-defined bitmap. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Select Image File dialog box.

RCDATA_16_ZOOM

Large Image

ID string of the large-image resource (32 × 32 bitmap). If the specified bitmap is not 32 × 32, the program scales it to that size. The string must include alphanumeric characters with no punctuation other than a hyphen (-) or an underscore (_). It can also be a user-defined bitmap. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Select Image File dialog box

RCDATA_16_ZOOM

When you create a new toolbar or flyout toolbar, the first task you need to do is assign a name to it. A new toolbar has no commands or controls assigned to it. If a toolbar has no commands or controls on it, it is ignored by the program until you add at least one command or control to it. You can drag commands and controls onto the new toolbar from existing toolbars or from the Command List pane. Once a command has been added to the toolbar, you can change the text that is displayed in the tooltip when the cursor is paused over top of the button by adjusting the Name property that is displayed in the Properties pane. While commands and controls can be added to or removed from a toolbar in the Customizations In pane, but they can also be added or removed using the Toolbar Preview pane. The Toolbar Preview pane allows you to add and remove commands or controls visually in real-time instead of just using

134 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

the tree view. You can also be interactively drag command and controls in the preview to reposition them. The program also allows you to customize toolbars that are displayed in the application when the Customize User Interface editor is open. You can drag commands from the Command List pane and drop then directly onto a visible toolbar that is docked or floating in the application. You can also remove, reposition, or copy commands while the CUI editor is open. To create a toolbar 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, right-click Toolbars. Click New Toolbar.

A new toolbar (named Toolbar1) is placed at the bottom of the Toolbars tree. 3 Do one of the following: ■

Enter a new name over the Toolbar1 text.



Right-click Toolbar1. Click Rename. Enter a new toolbar name.



Click Toolbar1, wait, and click again over the toolbar’s name again to edit its name in-place

4 Select the new toolbar in the tree view, and update the Properties pane: ■

In the Description box, enter a description for the toolbar.



In the On By Default box, click Hide or Show. If you choose Show, this toolbar will be displayed in all workspaces.



In the Orientation box, click Floating, Top, Bottom, Left, or Right.

Create and Edit Toolbars | 135



In the Default X Location box, enter a number.



In the Default Y Location box, enter a number.



In the Rows box, enter the number of rows for an undocked toolbar.



In the Aliases box, enter an alias for the toolbar.

5 In the Command List pane, drag the command you want to add to a location just below the name of the toolbar in the Customizations In pane.

6 Click OK. To create a flyout toolbar from scratch 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Toolbars tree node to expand it.

136 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

3 Right-click the toolbar to which you want to add a flyout toolbar. Click New Flyout.

A new flyout toolbar (named Toolbar1) is placed below the toolbar you selected.

4 Right-click Toolbar1. Click Rename. Enter a new toolbar name. NOTE You can click, wait, and click again over a toolbar name to edit its name in-place.

NOTE Just renaming the toolbar won’t change the name of the flyout. You must select and rename the flyout independently if you want them to both have the same name. 5 In the Command List pane, drag the command you want to add to a location just below the toolbar flyout name in the Customizations In pane.

Create and Edit Toolbars | 137

6 Click OK.

To create a toolbar from a pull-down menu 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Toolbars tree node to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to the Menus tree node to expand it. 4 Drag the menu that you want to create a toolbar from and drop it onto the Toolbars node.

138 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

5 Update the workspace as desired to update the display and position for the new toolbar. To create a flyout toolbar from another toolbar 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Toolbars tree node to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to the toolbar to which you want to add a flyout toolbar. 4 Locate the toolbar you want to add as a flyout. Drag that toolbar to a location in the expanded toolbar.

5 Click OK.

Create and Edit Toolbars | 139

To create a flyout toolbar from a pull-down menu 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Toolbars tree node to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to the Menus tree node to expand it. 4 Drag the menu that you want to create a flyout from and drop it onto the node of the toolbar where you want to place the flyout.

If the menu is dropped on a toolbar, a new flyout and toolbar are created.

5 Reposition the new flyout on the toolbar. 6 Update the workspace for the display and position for the new toolbar. To add a command to a toolbar in the Customizations In pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui.

140 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, Command List pane, drag the command you want to add to a location just below the toolbar name in the Customizations In pane. 3 Click the plus sign (+) to the left of the toolbar to display the command you just added.

4 Click OK. To add a command to a toolbar in the Toolbar Preview pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Toolbar node to expand it. 3 Select the toolbar you want to add a command to. 4 In the Command List pane, drag the command you want to add to the selected toolbar and drop it on the toolbar’s preview in the Toolbar Preview pane.

Create and Edit Toolbars | 141

You can control where the command is placed by releasing the mouse button when the black vertical splitter bar is displayed. 5 Click OK. To add a command to a toolbar outside the CUI editor 1 Display the toolbar you want to add a command to by right-clicking over a toolbar button. Click the name of the toolbar. 2 Right-click over any toolbar button. Click Customize. 3 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, Command List pane, drag the command you want to add and drop it onto the toolbar.

You can control the location the command by using the splitter bar as a visual indicator. 4 Click OK. To reposition a button on a toolbar in the Customizations In pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui.

142 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Toolbar node to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to a toolbar to expand it. 4 Drag the name of the button you want to reposition to the new location in the list of tools.

When the splitter bar is displayed, you can place the button between two buttons. When the left arrow appears, you can place the button below another button. 5 Click OK. To reposition a button on a toolbar in the Toolbar Preview pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Toolbar node to expand it. 3 Drag the button in the toolbar’s preview that you want to reposition.

While dragging the button to the new position, use the splitter bar as a visual indicator to specify the location of the button. 4 Click OK.

Create and Edit Toolbars | 143

To reposition a button on a toolbar outside the CUI editor 1 Display the toolbar you want to add a command to by right-clicking over a toolbar button. Click the name of the toolbar. 2 Right-click over any toolbar button. Click Customize. 3 Drag the button on the toolbar that you want to reposition.

While dragging the button to the new position, use the splitter bar as a visual indicator to specify the location of the button. 4 Click OK. To remove a button from a toolbar in the Customizations In pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Toolbar node to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to a toolbar to expand it. 4 Right-click the name of the button you want to remove. Click Remove.

5 Click OK.

144 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

To remove a button from a toolbar in the Toolbar Preview pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Toolbar node to expand it. 3 Drag the button in the toolbar’s preview that you want to remove and drop it outside of the preview.

4 Click OK. To remove a command from a toolbar outside the CUI editor 1 Display the toolbar from which you want to remove a command by right-clicking over a toolbar button. Click the name of the toolbar. 2 Right-click over any toolbar button. Click Customize. The Customize User Interface editor is displayed. 3 Drag the button you want to remove from the toolbar and drop it over the drawing window.

4 Click OK.

Create and Edit Toolbars | 145

5 In the Customize User Click Interface editor, click OK. To change properties of a toolbar 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the toolbar whose properties you want to change. NOTE Making changes to a toolbar’s properties here only affect the initial appearance of the toolbar after the CUI file has been loaded. To control the appearance of a toolbar, it is best to use a workspace. 3 In the Properties pane, make your changes. NOTE Before you attempt to change an alias in a toolbar, you need to understand how aliases function. For more information about aliases, see Create Command Aliases (page 21). 4 Click OK. To change the tooltip of a button 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Toolbar node to expand it. 3 Select the toolbar whose tooltip text you want to change. 4 In the Properties pane, in the Display section, make the desired change to the Name property (not the Command Name property).

146 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

5 Click OK.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts QUICKCUI Displays the Customize User Interface dialog box in a collapsed state

System Variables TOOLTIPS Controls the display of tooltips on toolbars

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Add or Switch Toolbar Controls Toolbar controls are drop-down lists of toolbar-specific options that you can choose from a toolbar. For example, the Layers toolbar contains controls that

Add or Switch Toolbar Controls | 147

allow you to define layer settings. In the Customize User Interface editor, you can add, remove, and relocate controls within toolbars. The following table lists the toolbar controls found in the Customize User Interface editor and their definitions. The control elements in the left column of this table are not always the text that is displayed as a tooltip in the program (for example, Undo Skinny Button is displayed as Undo in the program's tooltip). Refer to this table when you want to change a control in a toolbar. Control elements for toolbars Control element

Description

Dim Style Control

Drop-down list that provides specification of the current dimension style.

Layer Control

Drop-down list that provides control of the current layers in the drawing.

Line Type Control

Drop-down list that provides specification of the current linetype.

Line Weight Control

Drop-down list that provides specification of the current lineweight.

Multileader Style Control

Drop-down list that sets the current multileader style.

Named View Control

Drop-down list that displays the named view.

OPT Color Control

Drop-down list that provides specification of the current color.

Plot Style Control

Drop-down list that provides specification of the current plot style.

Redo Skinny Button Control

Standard toolbar button that repeats the previous action.

Reference Block Name Control

Displays the current xref name in edit mode.

148 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Control elements for toolbars Control element

Description

Table Style Control

Drop-down list that sets the current table style.

Text Style Control

Drop-down list that sets the current text style.

UCS Control

Drop-down list that provides specification of the current UCS.

Undo Skinny Button Control

Standard toolbar button that cancels the previous action.

View Control

Drop-down list that provides specification of the current standard 3D views.

Viewport Scale Control

Drop-down list that provides specification of viewport scaling in layouts.

Workspaces Control

Drop-down list that sets the current workspace.

To add a control to a toolbar in the Customizations In pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the toolbar to which you want to add a control. 3 In the Command List pane, in the Categories list, click Control Elements.

The Command List pane displays control elements only.

Add or Switch Toolbar Controls | 149

4 In the Command list, drag the control to the Customizations In pane to the position where you want to add it in the toolbar.

5 Click OK. To add a control to a toolbar in the Toolbar Preview pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Toolbar node to expand it. 3 Select the toolbar to which you want to add a control. 4 In the Command List pane, in the Categories list, click Control Elements.

The Command List pane displays control elements only. 5 In the Command list, drag the control you want to add to the selected toolbar to the toolbar’s preview in the Toolbar Preview pane.

150 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

You can control where you place the command by releasing the mouse button when the black vertical splitter bar is displayed in the location you want.

6 Click OK. To switch a control in a toolbar 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the toolbar that contains the control element you want to switch. 3 Click the control element.

4 In the Properties pane, in the Control box, click the arrow to display a list of controls.

Add or Switch Toolbar Controls | 151

5 Click a control to replace the original control with the one you selected. 6 Click OK.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts

152 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Create Pull-Down and Shortcut Menus Pull-down menus are displayed as a list under a menu bar. Shortcut menus (also called context menus) are displayed at or near the crosshairs or cursor when you right-click in the drawing window, text window, command window, or in toolbar areas. A pull-down menu can contain up to 999 commands. A shortcut menu can contain up to 499 commands. The command limit includes all menus in a hierarchy. If commands in the menu file exceed these limits (which is unlikely), the program ignores the extra commands. If a pull-down or shortcut menu is longer than the available display space, it is truncated to fit. The following table shows the File menu properties as they appear in the Properties pane. The properties for a pull-down menu and shortcut menu are identical. Properties for the File menu Properties Description pane item

Example

Name

String used as the caption of the menu on the menu bar.

&File

Description

Text used to describe the element; does not appear in the user interface.

Aliases

Specifies the aliases for the menu. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Aliases dialog box. Each alias in the CUI file should be unique and it is used to reference the menu programatically.

POP1, FILE

Create Pull-Down and Shortcut Menus | 153

Properties for the File menu Properties Description pane item

Example

Element ID

ID_MnFile

Tag that uniquely identifies a menu.

Pull-Down Menu Aliases Pull-down menus should have one alias in the range of POP1 through POP499. Menus with an alias of POP1 through POP16 are loaded by default when a menu loads. All other menus must be added to a workspace to be displayed. NOTE When you create a pull-down or shortcut menu, you must also add a command to the menu. Otherwise, the menu will not be saved to the file.

Create a Pull-Down Menu You can create a pull-down menu, add a submenu, and add commands on the Customize tab of the Customize User Interface editor. The process is very similar to working with toolbars and flyouts with only minor differences. You can add and modify commands on menus. As you modify the positioning of standard commands on menus, the on Online Help system is automatically updated to reflect this change through the Dynamic Help feature. For more information on how Dynamic Help affects customization, see How Customization Has Changed (page 52). NOTE When you create a menu, you should determine in which workspaces you want to display the menu. By default, a new menu is displayed in all workspaces. To create a pull-down menu 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, right-click Menus. Click New Menu.

154 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

A new menu (named Menu1) is placed at the bottom of the Menus tree. 3 Do one of the following: ■

Enter a new name over the Menu1 text.



Right-click Menu1. Click Rename. Enter a new menu name.



Click Menu1, wait, and click again over the menu’s name again to edit its name in-place.

4 Select the new menu in the tree view, and update the Properties pane as follows: ■

In the Description box, enter a description for the menu.



In the Aliases box, an alias is automatically assigned to the new menu, based on the number of menus already loaded. For example, if the alias assignment is POP12, eleven menus are already loaded. View or edit the alias.



(Optional) If the name change is based upon a DIESEL expression, the DIESEL expression should be included in the Name box.

5 In the Command List pane, drag the command to a location just below the menu in the Customizations In pane.

Create a Pull-Down Menu | 155

NOTE You can change the name of a command after it has been added to a menu. This allows you to define how the user can access the menu item using keyboard navigation with the ALT key. To do this, select the menu item under the Menus node and then change the Name property in the Properties pane. 6 Click OK. To add a command to pull-down menu 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the menu to which you want to add a command. 3 In the Command List pane, drag the command you want to add to a location just below the menu in the Customizations In pane.

156 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

NOTE You can change the name of a command after it has been added to a menu. This allows you to define how the user can access the menu item using keyboard navigation with the ALT key. To do this, select the menu item under the Menus node and then change the Name property in the Properties pane. 4 Click OK. For information about creating a command, see Create, Edit, and Reuse Commands (page 86). To change the caption of a menu item 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Menus node to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to the pull-down menu that has the command whose text you want to change. 4 Select the command whose text you want to change. 5 In the Properties pane, in the Display section, make the desired change to the Name property (not the Command Name property).

6 Click OK.

Create a Pull-Down Menu | 157

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Create a Shortcut Menu Shortcut menus are displayed at your cursor location when you right-click a pointing device. The shortcut menu and the options it provides depend on the pointer location and other conditions, such as whether an object is selected or a command is in progress. You can also use scripts to display shortcut menus. Context-sensitive shortcut menus display menu options when you right-click that are relative to the current command or the selected object.

Shortcut Menu Aliases Shortcut menus are referenced by their aliases and are used in specific situations. In the Customize User Interface editor, the alias names must follow the proper naming conventions. For example, the shortcut menu named “Default Menu” displays the following information in the Aliases section of the Properties pane: POP501, CMDEFAULT

158 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

The Object Snap shortcut menu must have an alias of POP0. Aliases for context-sensitive shortcut menus must be numbered between POP500 and POP999. The following aliases are reserved for use by the program: Program aliases for shortcut menus Alias

Description

GRIPS

Defines the Hot Grip shortcut menu. (Right-click the drawing area while a grip on an object is selected.)

CMDEFAULT

Defines the Default mode shortcut menu. (Right-click the drawing area while no command is active and no objects are selected.)

CMEDIT

Defines the Edit mode shortcut menu. (Right-click the drawing area while one or more objects are selected, no grips are selected, and no command is active.)

CMCOMMAND

Defines the Command mode menu. (Right-click the drawing area while a command is active.) In addition to the content of the CMCOMMAND menu, the command’s options (keywords within the square brackets) are inserted into this menu.

SNAP

Defines the Object Snap menu. (SHIFT+right-click the drawing area.)

The CMEDIT and CMCOMMAND shortcut menus can be made context-sensitive. In addition to the content of the CMEDIT menu, the appropriate object menu (if it exists) is inserted into this menu when one or more of a specific object type are selected. Object menus use either of the following naming conventions: OBJECT_objectname OBJECTS_objectname

If a single object is selected, the OBJECT_objectname menu is used, and if more than one of the same object is selected, the OBJECTS_objectname menu is used. If no OBJECT_objectname is available, the program uses the OBJECTS_objectname menu (if it exists).

Create a Shortcut Menu | 159

The object name is the drawing interchange format (DXF™) name of the object in all cases except for the inserted object. The following table shows the object names that are specific to blocks, dynamic blocks, and xrefs. Object names specific to inserted objects Object Name

Description

BLOCKREF

Block reference without attributes

ATTBLOCKREF

Block reference with attributes

DYNBLOCKREF

Dynamic block reference without attributes

ATTDYNBLOCKREF

Dynamic block reference with attributes

XREF

External reference (xref)

For example, to support an object-specific shortcut command for one or more selected block references, you would add the following properties on the Customize tab, Properties pane of the Customize User Interface editor: Properties for the Block Reference Objects shortcut menu Properties Description pane item

Example

Name

String that is only used in the CUI editor and is not displayed in the user interface.

Block Objects Menu

Description

Text used to describe the element; does not appear in the user interface.

Shortcut menu for block objects

Aliases

Specifies the aliases for the shortcut menu. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Aliases dialog box. Each alias in the CUI file should be unique and it is used to reference the shortcut menu programatically.

POP512,OBJECTS_BLOCKREF

Element ID

Tag that uniquely identifies a shortcut menu.

PM_0021

160 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Like the CMEDIT menu, the CMCOMMAND menu can contain context-sensitive information. Any menu named COMMAND_commandname is appended to the CMCOMMAND menu. The text of commandname can be any valid AutoCAD command, including custom-defined or third-party commands. In many cases, you can enter a hyphen before a command to suppress the display of a dialog box and display prompts for the command instead. To create a context-sensitive menu for a command that displays prompts instead of a dialog box (such as -INSERT), you need to name the menu COMMAND_-INSERT. To create a shortcut menu 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, right-click Shortcut Menus. Click New Shortcut Menu.

The new shortcut menu (named “ShortcutMenu1”) is placed at the bottom of the Menus tree. 3 Do one of the following: ■

Enter a new name over the ShortcutMenu1 text.



Right-click ShortcutMenu1. Click Rename. Enter a new shortcut menu name.



Click ShortcutMenu1, wait, and click again over the shortcut menu’s name again to edit its name in-place.

4 In the Properties pane, do the following: ■

In the Description box, enter a description for the shortcut menu.



In the Aliases box, click the Ellipsis button. Press ENTER so you are on a new line in the Aliases dialog box. Enter additional aliases for the menu, and after each one entered press ENTER. An alias is

Create a Shortcut Menu | 161

automatically assigned, and defaults to the next available POP number, based on the number of shortcut menus already loaded in the program.

5 In the Command List pane, drag the command you want to add to the location just below the shortcut menu in the Customizations In pane.

6 Continue adding commands until the new shortcut menu is complete. 7 Click OK. To create a command shortcut menu 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, right-click Shortcut Menus. Click New Shortcut Menu.

162 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

The new shortcut menu (named “ShortcutMenu1”) is placed at the bottom of the Menus tree. 3 Do one of the following: ■

Enter a new name over the ShortcutMenu1 text.



Right-click ShortcutMenu1. Click Rename. Enter a new shortcut menu name.



Click ShortcutMenu1, wait, and click again over the shortcut menu’s name again to edit its name in-place.

4 In the Properties pane, do the following: ■

In the Description box, enter a description for the shortcut menu.



In the Aliases box, click the Ellipsis button. Press ENTER so you are on a new line in the Aliases dialog box. Enter additional aliases for the menu, and after each one entered press ENTER. An alias is automatically assigned, and defaults to the next available POP number, based on the number of shortcut menus already loaded in the program. In order for the commands on the shortcut menu to appear when a command is active, make sure to use the alias COMMAND_commandname. For example, if you want the commands on the shortcut menu to appear when using the LINE command use the alias COMMAND_LINE. The commands from the shortcut menu will appear at the bottom of the shortcut menu with the alias CMCOMMAND when it is displayed.

5 In the Command List pane, drag the command you want to add to the location just below the shortcut menu in the Customizations In pane.

Create a Shortcut Menu | 163

6 Continue adding commands until the new shortcut menu is complete. 7 Click OK.

To create an object shortcut menu 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, right-click Shortcut Menus. Click New Shortcut Menu.

The new shortcut menu (named “ShortcutMenu1”) is placed at the bottom of the Menus tree. 3 Do one of the following: ■

Enter a new name over the ShortcutMenu1 text.

164 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface



Right-click ShortcutMenu1. Click Rename. Enter a new shortcut menu name.



Click ShortcutMenu1, wait, and click again over the shortcut menu’s name again to edit its name in-place.

4 In the Properties pane, do the following: ■

In the Description box, enter a description for the shortcut menu.



In the Aliases box, click the Ellipsis button. Press ENTER so you are on a new line in the Aliases dialog box. Enter additional aliases for the menu, and after each one entered press ENTER. An alias is automatically assigned, and defaults to the next available POP number, based on the number of shortcut menus already loaded in the program. In order for the commands on the shortcut menu to appear when an object or objects of the same type are selected, make sure to use the alias OBJECT_objecttype or OBJECTS_objecttype. For example, if you want the commands on the shortcut menu to appear when a LINE object is selected in the drawing use the alias OBJECT_LINE. The commands from the shortcut menu will appear near the top of the shortcut menu with the alias CMEDIT when it is displayed.

NOTE If you create a shortcut menu with the alias OBJECTS_objecttype, the commands assigned to the shortcut menu will be displayed when one or more objects are selected before right-clicking over the drawing area.

5 In the Command List pane, drag the command you want to add to the location just below the shortcut menu in the Customizations In pane.

Create a Shortcut Menu | 165

6 Continue adding commands until the new shortcut menu is complete. 7 Click OK.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts

System Variables SHORTCUTMENU Controls whether Default, Edit, and Command mode shortcut menus are available in the drawing area

166 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Create Submenus You create submenus much the same way that you create a menu. The following table describes the non-alphanumeric characters that can be used in the Customize User Interface editor. Non-alphanumeric characters not listed are reserved for future use as special menu characters. Special characters for submenus Character

Description

Example

$(

Enables the pull-down or shortcut command label to evaluate a DIESEL string macro if $( are the first characters.

~

Makes a command unavailable.

!.

Marks a command with a check mark.

&

Placed directly before a character, specifies the character as the menu access key in a pull-down or shortcut menu label.

S&le displays Sample (with the letter a underlined).

\t

Pushes all label text entered after these characters to the right side of the menu.

Help\tF1 displays Help on the left side of the pull-down menu and F1 on the right side.

Create Submenus | 167

To create a submenu 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to Menus. Select the menu to which you want to add a submenu.

3 Right-click the menu. Click New Sub-menu. The new submenu (named Menu1) is placed at the bottom of the Menu you selected to add the submenu to. 4 Do one of the following: ■

Enter a new name over the Menu1 text.



Right-click Menu1. Click Rename. Enter a new submenu name.



Click Menu1, wait, and click again over the menu’s name again to edit its name in-place.

5 In the Properties pane, do the following: ■

In the Description box, enter a description for the submenu.

6 In the Command List pane, drag the command you want to add to a location just below the name of the submenu in the Customizations In pane.

168 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

7 Continue adding commands until the new submenu is complete. 8 Click OK.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts

Create Submenus | 169

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Reference Pull-Down or Shortcut Menus Using a method similar to that used to activate submenus, you can activate or deactivate another pull-down or shortcut menu. This is called referencing a menu. The two methods for referencing a pull-down or shortcut menu are relative and absolute. Relative referencing uses the customization group and element ID. Absolute referencing uses the absolute position of a menu item in the menu hierarchy. Relative referencing is recommended because of its dynamic nature, which allows it to function regardless of the current state of a menu.

Relative Referencing of Pull-Down and Shortcut Commands To reference a pull-down or shortcut menu item based on its customization group and element ID, use the AutoLISP menucmd function. The following syntax references a menu item based on its element ID. (menucmd "Gmenugroup.element_id=value")

The following example uses the relative referencing syntax to disable the menu item ID_Line that is stored in the sample customization group. It works regardless of the menu item's location in the menu. (menucmd "Gsample.ID_Line=~")

If you know what is contained in the main CUI file, you can create a partial CUI file with an additional menu item that references the main file. In this manner, partial CUI files and specific base files can work together.

170 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Absolute Referencing of Pull-Down and Shortcut Menu Items In addition to referencing a menu item, you can activate or deactivate a menu item with the $Pn=xxx syntax. This is the format: $Pn.i=xxx

The $ loads a menu section; Pn specifies the active menu section (0 through 16 are valid values); i specifies the menu item number; and xxx (if present), specifies a string of grayed out or marked characters. Using the $Pn=xxx syntax, the following example adds a check mark to item 1 in the POP7 section. $P7.1=!.

The following example uses the AutoLISP menucmd function to reference a pull-down or shortcut menu item. Because customization files are dynamic (through the loading of partial CUI files), the following syntax won't work in all cases. (menucmd "P1.2=~")

This syntax relies on the location of the menu item and does not work if a new item is inserted before POP1 by the CUILOAD command. Menu item numbering is consecutive regardless of the hierarchy of the menu. To make it easy for an item to address itself regardless of its location in the menu hierarchy, use these forms: $P@.@=xxx References the current or most recently chosen command. [email protected]=xxx References item n in the current or most recently chosen menu.

AutoLISP Access to Label Status The AutoLISP menucmd function accepts $Pn=xxx command strings but without the leading $. For these functions, the xxx portion of the command string can have special values. Pn.i=? Returns the current disabled and marked status for the specified item as a string (for example, ~ for a disabled item, !. for an item with a check mark, and "" for an item that is neither grayed out nor marked). Pn.i=#? Returns the same type of string as described for Pn.i=?, but with the Pn.i= prefix. This is useful in conjunction with the @ forms, because the actual

menu and item number are returned.

Reference Pull-Down or Shortcut Menus | 171

For example, if the fifth item in the POP6 section is disabled, the following menucmd code returns the following string values. (menucmd "P6.5=?") (menucmd "P6.5=#?")

returns returns

"~" "P6.5=~"

See “Use of AutoLISP in Macros” in the AutoLISP Developer's Guide.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Swap and Insert Pull-Down Menus Using the Customize User Interface editor, you can use workspaces to control the swapping of pull-down menus. However, you can also swap a pull-down menu programatically (for example, when a user loads an application that requires an additional menu). Menu swapping activates one menu directly from another menu.

Swap Pull-Down Menus Because the program has cascading pull-down menus, there is little need to swap menus. Also, swapping menus can detract from the consistency of the user interface. However, using $ commands, you can swap pull-down menus and submenus. An alternative to menu swapping involves relative (or global)

172 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

referencing. Using this method, you can insert the new menu in front of a known menu and then remove the known menu. For menu-swapping purposes, the pull-down menu areas are named P1 through P16. You can change the title that appears in the menu bar by replacing that line of the menu with a $Pn= command. You can use the special command $Pn=* from within any command to force the menu currently assigned to area POPn to pull down for greater flexibility in movement of the pointing device. The following macro example replaces a menu at position P3 with the menu named BudsMenu in the customization group named MYMENU. $P3=MyMenu.BudsMenu

The same thing can be done with the AutoLISP menucmd function as follows: (menucmd "P3=MyMenu.BudsMenu")

You can use the $Pn=* special command from within any macro to force the menu currently assigned to area POPn to be displayed. NOTE The swapping of pull-down menus does not conform to the Microsoft® user interface guidelines and is not guaranteed to be available in future releases of the program.

Insert and Remove Pull-Down Menus Menu swapping is activating one menu directly from another menu. Menu swapping is supported for the following interface elements: ■

Buttons



Pull-down menus



Mouse buttons



Image tile menus



Tablet menus

The syntax for the swapping of partial menus is as follows: $section=menugroup.menuname

section B1-4, A1-4, P0-16, T1-4 menugroup

Swap and Insert Pull-Down Menus | 173

Customization group name in the desired CUI file menuname Main label or alias You can use the AutoLISP menucmd function to insert or remove a pull-down menu. The syntax is similar to that used to swap pull-down menus except that the left side of the assignment is the pull-down menu before which the new menu will be inserted. The right side of the assignment is a plus sign (+) followed by the name of the menu group, a period, and the menu's alias, as shown in the following syntax: (menucmd "Gmenugroup1.menuname1=+menugroup2.menuname2")

You can also insert a menu with the Pn= syntax. The following macro inserts a menu after the P5 menu. (You can also use the menucmd function with this format.) (menucmd "P5=+mymenu.new3")

If you use this method to insert a menu, remember that you cannot rely on its being inserted at the P6 menu location as you might expect. There are two reasons that this may not be the case. ■

If the current menu bar has only three menus, inserting a menu after menu P5 results in the new menu's location being P4.



If the user inserts or removes a customization file with the CUILOAD command or when another application inserts or removes customization files, menu numbering can get out of sync.

This is the syntax for removing a menu: (menucmd "Gmenugroup.menuname=-")

The following example removes the menu NEW3 that is a member of the MyMenu group. (menucmd "Gmymenu.new3=-")

As you might expect, the preceding format is preferable to the Pn= format because it removes only the specified menu. The following example removes the menu at the P4 location (whatever it is). $P4=-

NOTE Use the Pn syntax as part of the syntax for a menucmd statement only. Use the $Pn syntax for macro-specific statements.

174 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Control Toolbars Across Partial CUI Files To control toolbars across partial CUI files, use the following syntax at the Enter toolbar name or [All}: prompt of the -TOOLBAR command. menugroup.subsection-name

This syntax accesses the toolbar identified by menugroup.menuname and allows you to use the full spectrum of -TOOLBAR command options on that toolbar. If the menu group is left out of any of these commands and functions, the program defaults to the main CUI file. You should be aware of the following: ■

Image tile menus cannot be swapped from external customization files.



You can swap customization elements of the same type only; that is, one shortcut menu for another, one toolbar for another, and so on. Trying to swap between types may result in unpredictable behavior.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts CUILOAD Loads a CUI file CUIUNLOAD Unloads a CUI file TOOLBAR Displays, hides, and customizes toolbars WORKSPACE Creates, modifies, and saves workspaces and makes a workspace current

Swap and Insert Pull-Down Menus | 175

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Customize Dashboard Panels Dashboard panel customization allows you to create and modify panels by adding or removing buttons and controls that are displayed on the Dashboard window. By using panels instead of toolbars, you can organize the commands that you commonly use and access them from the Dashboard window. This maximizes the amount of drawing area that you can work with.

Create and Edit Dashboard Panels Dashboard customization helps you to organize commands that you use frequently on panels that are similar to toolbars. Panels allow you to quickly access commands, and help you to reduce the number of user interface elements that you might have displayed in AutoCAD. Dashboard panels are divided into two different sections, an upper and lower. The item is used to control how the rows of a dashboard panel are displayed in the two sections. The rows in the upper section are displayed by default when the dashboard panel is displayed on the Dashboard palette; those in the lower section are displayed only after the double down arrow is clicked to expand the dashboard panel. You can create and modify dashboard panels to tailor the user interface to the way you work. Rows are used in a dashboard panel to control the placement of the tools that should be displayed. You can add rows to a section of a dashboard panel, remove rows that are no longer needed, and rearrange rows between the upper and lower sections of a dashboard panel. Rows can be created by dragging toolbars above or below the panel separator.

176 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

You can add buttons to a row, remove buttons you use infrequently, and rearrange buttons. Along with buttons, you can also create flyouts and add controls. The following table describes the 2D Draw dashboard panel properties as they appear in the Properties pane. Properties for the 2D Draw panel Properties Description pane item

Example

Name

Title for the panel; displayed in the Control Panels sub-menu when you right-click of the Dashboard palette.

2D Draw

Description

Text used to describe the element; does not appear in the user interface.

Aliases

Specifies the aliases for the panel. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Aliases dialog box. Each alias in the CUI file should be unique and it is used to reference the panel programatically.

2D_Draw

Element ID

Tag that uniquely identifies a panel.

PNL_0001

Small Image

ID string of the small-image resource (16 × 16 bitmap). The string must include alphanumeric characters with no punctuation other than a hyphen (-) or an underscore (_). It can also be a user-defined bitmap. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Select Image File dialog box.

RCDATA_16_DASH_2D_MAKE_MODIFY

Large Image

ID string of the large-image resource (32 × 32 bitmap). If the specified bitmap is not 32 × 32, the program scales it to that size. The string must include alphanumeric characters with no punctuation other than a hyphen (-) or an underscore (_). It can also be a user-defined bitmap. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Select Image File dialog box.

RCDATA_16_DASH_2D_MAKE_MODIFY

Create and Edit Dashboard Panels | 177

A row, similar to a toolbar, controls the order and position of tools on a dashboard panel. Rows run horizontally on a dashboard panel. If all the tools in a row cannot be displayed at once on the Dashboard palette, a small black triangle is displayed on the right side of the row so you can access the additional commands in the row via a flyout. The following table describes the properties for Row 1 of the 2D Draw dashboard panel as they appear in the Properties pane. Properties for Row 1 of the 2D Draw panel Properties Description pane item

Example

Name

Logical name for the section of a panel; does not appear in the user interface.

Draw

Description

Text used to describe the element; does not appear in the user interface.

Draw Toolbar

Row s

Number of rows that are in a panel section. A panel section is defined by the rows that are above or below the node of a panel.

2

Aliases

Specifies the aliases for the panel section. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Aliases dialog box. Each alias in the CUI file should be unique and it is used to reference the panel section programatically.

TPL_0001

Element ID

Tag that uniquely identifies a panel section.

TPL_0001

Dashboard panels, like toolbars, can contain flyouts that hold a number of buttons and separators to help organize similar tools. A dashboard panel flyout is created in a slightly different way from that of a flyout on a toolbar. Instead of the flyout referencing a toolbar; it is created like a sub-menu on a pull-down menu, but it has the same properties as a toolbar flyout.

178 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

The following table describes the properties for the Block flyout of Row 1 on the 2D Draw dashboard panel as they appear in the Properties pane. Properties for Block flyout on Row 1 of the 2D Draw panel Properties Description pane item

Example

Name

Logical name for the flyout; does not appear in the user interface.

Block

Description

Text used to describe the element; does not appear in the user interface.

Use Own Icon

Controls whether the last used button is set as the current button or not. The possible values are Yes or No.

No

Small Image

ID string of the small-image resource (16 × 16 bitmap). The string must include alphanumeric characters with no punctuation other than a hyphen (-) or an underscore (_). It can also be a user-defined bitmap. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Select Image File dialog box.

RCDATA_16_BLOCK

Large Image

ID string of the large-image resource (32 × 32 bitmap). If the specified bitmap is not 32 × 32, the program scales it to that size. The string must include alphanumeric characters with no punctuation other than a hyphen (-) or an underscore (_). It can also be a user-defined bitmap. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Select Image File dialog box.

RCDATA_16_BLOCK

When you create a new dashboard panel, row, or dashboard flyout, the first task you need to do is assign a name to it. When you create a new dashboard panel a single row is created, the is added, and no commands or controls are assigned. You can drag commands and controls onto a row of the new dashboard panel from existing dashboard panels or from the Command List pane. Once a command has been added to the dashboard panel, you can change the tooltip text by changing the Name property in the Properties pane.

Create and Edit Dashboard Panels | 179

Commands and controls can be added to or removed from a row in a dashboard panel in the Customizations In pane. They can also be added or removed using the Panel Preview pane with the Panel Preview pane you can add and remove commands or controls visually in real-time instead of just using the tree view. You can also drag command and controls in the preview to reposition them. To create a dashboard panel 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, right-click Dashboard Panels. Click New Panel. A new panel (named Panel1) is placed at the bottom of the Dashboard Panels tree.

3 Do one of the following: ■

Enter a new name over the Panel1 text.



Right-click Panel1. Click Rename. Enter a new dashboard panel name.



Click Panel1, wait, and click again over the dashboard panel’s name again to edit its name in-place.

4 Select the new dashboard panel in the tree view, and update the Properties pane: ■

In the Description box, enter a description for the dashboard panel.



In the Aliases box, enter an alias for the dashboard panel.

180 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

5 To assign a panel icon to the dashboard panel do one of the following: ■

To assign a standard icon, select one of the three image assignment options; Large, Small, or Both in the Button Image pane. Select an image from the image list and the image name is assigned to the Small and/or Large image property of the dashboard panel.



To assign a custom icon, select the field next to the Small image property in the Properties pane. Click the Ellipse button that is displayed next to the property and using the Select Image File dialog box, browse to the image file that you want to use for the dashboard panel. Repeat the process for the Large icon property.

6 Click OK. To remove a dashboard panel 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it. 3 Select the dashboard panel that you want to remove. 4 Right-click over the selected dashboard panel. Click Delete.

Create and Edit Dashboard Panels | 181

WARNING There is no way to undo the removal of an interface element, so be careful when removing interface elements. If you remove the wrong interface element, the best thing to do is click Cancel to not save changes, but this will also undo any other changes that you might have made. 5 Click OK. To add a row to a dashboard panel 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it. 3 Select the dashboard panel to which you want to add a row. 4 Right-click over the selected dashboard panel. Click New Row.

5 Click OK. To add a row to a dashboard panel based on a toolbar 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to dashboard panel in the Customizations In in which you want to create a new row on from an existing toolbar.

182 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

4 Click the plus sign (+) next to Toolbars in the Customizations In pane to expand it. 5 Drag the toolbar node to the location on the dashboard panel where you want the row to be created.

You can control where you place the row by releasing the mouse button when the black vertical splitter bar is displayed in the location you want. 6 Click OK. To remove a row from a dashboard panel 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to the dashboard panel from which you want to remove a row. 4 Select the row that you want to remove. 5 Right-click over the selected row. Click Delete.

Create and Edit Dashboard Panels | 183

6 Click OK. To reposition a row on a dashboard panel 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to the dashboard panel where you want to reposition a row. 4 Drag the row under the dashboard panel that you want to reposition. Use the splitter bar as a visual indicator to the position a row above or below other rows, or the item.

5 Click OK. To add a command to a dashboard panel in the Customizations In pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to the dashboard panel where you want to add a command. 4 Create a new row for the command, or click the plus sign (+) next to the row where you want to add a command.

184 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

5 Drag a command from the Command List pane to the dashboard panel. Use the splitter bar as a visual indicator to specify the position of the command.

6 Click OK. To add a command to a dashboard panel in the Panel Preview pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it. 3 Select the dashboard panel where you want to add a command. 4 Drag a command from the Command List pane to the dashboard panel’s preview in the Panel Preview pane. Use the splitter bar as a visual indicator to specify the position for the command.

Create and Edit Dashboard Panels | 185

5 Click OK. To create a flyout in a row on a dashboard panel 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to the dashboard panel where you want to add a flyout. 4 Right-click the row to which you want to add a flyout. Click New Flyout. A new flyout (named Flyout1) is created in the first position of the row. You can also right-click over a command or control and add a flyout below the selected item. 5 Right-click Flyout1. Click Rename. Enter a new name. NOTE You can click, wait, and click again over a toolbar name to edit its name in-place.

6 In the Command List pane, drag the command you want to add to a location just below the flyout name in the Customizations In pane.

186 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

7 Click OK. To reposition a command or control for a dashboard panel in the Customizations In pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to the dashboard panel where you want to reposition a command or control. 4 Click the plus sign (+) next to the row where you want to add a command to. 5 Drag the command or control to the row. Use the splitter bar as a visual indicator to specify the position for the command or control.

Create and Edit Dashboard Panels | 187

6 Click OK. To reposition a command or control for a dashboard panel in the Panel Preview pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it. 3 Select the dashboard panel where you want to reposition a command or control. 4 In the Panel Preview pane, drag the command or control to a different position on the dashboard panel’s. Use the splitter bar as a visual indicator to specify the location for the command or control.

5 Click OK. To remove a command or control for a dashboard panel in the Customizations In pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to the dashboard panel where you want to remove a command or control. 4 Click the plus sign (+) next to the row where you want to remove a command or control from. 5 Select the command or control that you want to remove. 6 Right-click over the selected command or control. Click Delete.

188 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

7 Click OK. To remove a command or control for a dashboard panel in the Panel Preview pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to the row where you want to remove a command or control. 4 Drag the command or control outside of the preview to remove it from the dashboard panel.

5 Click OK.

Create and Edit Dashboard Panels | 189

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts DASHBOARD Opens the Dashboard window

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Add or Switch Dashboard Controls Dashboard panel controls are drop-down lists, sliders, text boxes, and other dashboard panel-specific options that you can choose from. For example, the 2D Navigate panel contains controls for changing the current view of the drawing. In the Customize User Interface editor, you can add, remove, and relocate controls within dashboard panels. The following table describes the dashboard panel controls found in the Customize User Interface editor. The control elements in the left column of this table are not always the text that is displayed as a tooltip in the program (for example, Text Height Combo Control is displayed as Text Height in the program's tooltip). In addition to the dashboard panel controls, many of the controls that can be used on toolbars can also be added to a row of a dashboard

190 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

panel. To learn more about the controls that can be used on toolbars and dashboard panels, see Add or Switch Toolbar Controls (page 147). Control elements for dashboard panels Control element

Description

3D Navigation Combo Control

Drop-down list of the standard orthographic and isometric views, and any named views for the current space.

3D Navigation Point Triplet 1 Control

Set of three text boxes that control the point of view (position of the camera) in the current viewport.

3D Navigation Point Triplet 2 Control

Set of three text boxes that control the target point of the camera (center point) for the current viewport.

3D Navigation Step Size Slider Control

Slider and text box combination that controls the step size in drawing units that is used with the 3DWALK and 3DFLY commands. The text box allows you to enter a specific step size without needing to use the slider.

3D Navigation Steps per Second Slider Control

Slider and text box combination that controls the number of steps that occur per second with the 3DWALK and 3DFLY commands. The text box allows you to enter a specific number of steps per second without needing to use the slider.

3D Navigation Zoom Slider Control

Slider that controls the lens length and field of view when perspective projection is active.

Layer Filter Combo Control

Drop-down that provides access to the available layer filters.

Layer Lock Transparency Slider Control

Toggle, slider, and text box combination that controls the transparency level of locked layers. The toggle allows you to turn locked layer transparency on and off. When transparency for locked layers is on, you can specify a transparency value with the slider or by entering the value directly into the text box.

Layer State Combo Control

Drop-down that provides access for managing and accessing the available layer states.

Add or Switch Dashboard Controls | 191

Control elements for dashboard panels Control element

Description

Light Slider 1 Control

Slider and text box combination that controls the calendar date for the sun. The text box is read-only and displays the specified calendar date.

Light Slider 2 Control

Slider and text box combination that controls the time of day for the sun. The text box is read-only and displays the specified time.

Light Slider 3 Control

Slider and text box combination that controls the global brightness multiplier for lights in the drawing. The text box is readonly and displays the specified multiplier value.

Light Slider 4 Control

Slider and text box combination that controls the global contrast for lights in the drawing. The text box is read-only and displays the specified contrast value.

Light Slider 5 Control

Slider and text box combination that controls the global mid tone for lights in the drawing. The text box is read-only and displays the specified mid tone value.

Render Image Quality Control

Slider that controls the maximum sampling used for rendering.

Render Output File Control

Toggle, text box, and browse button combination used to specify the file that the rendering should be output to. The toggle before the text box must be on in order for the text box and button to be available.

Render Output Size Control

Drop-down that provides a listing of standard and custom image sizes that are used when generating a rendered image.

Render Progress Control

Progress bar used to display current rendering progress and cancel the current rendering in progress.

Render Style Control

Drop-down list of available render presets.

192 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Control elements for dashboard panels Control element

Description

Text Height Combo Control

Drop-down list of the most recently used text heights.

Visual Styles Combo Control

Drop-down list of available visual styles.

Visual Styles Edge Color Control

Drop-down that specifies the color for the edges and isolines of 3D objects.

Visual Styles Edge Overhang Slider Control

Toggle and slider combination that is used to control edge overhang and the amount that the lines are extended beyond their intersection.

Visual Styles Intersection Edge Color Control

Toggle and drop-down combination that is used to specify the display and color for the edges of 3D objects where they intersect.

Visual Styles Jitter Edge Slider Control

Toggle and slider combination that is used to control edge jitter and the amount that the lines are jittered.

Visual Styles Obscured Edge Color Control

Toggle and drop-down combination that specifies the display and color for the edges of 3D objects that are obscured.

Visual Styles Silhouette Edge Width Slider Control

Toggle and slider combination that is used to control edge silhouette and the width of the silhouette created.

To add a control to a dashboard panel in the Customizations In pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it.

Add or Switch Dashboard Controls | 193

3 Click the plus sign (+) next to the dashboard panel where you want to add a control. 4 Create a new row for the control if you need to, or click the plus sign (+) next to the row where you want to add a control. 5 In the Command List pane, in the Categories list, click Control Elements. The Command List pane displays control elements only.

6 Drag a control from the Command List pane to add to the dashboard panel. Use the splitter bar as a visual indicator to specify the position of the control.

7 Click OK. To add a control to a dashboard panel in the Panel Preview pane 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it.

194 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

3 Select the dashboard panel where you want to add a command. 4 In the Command List pane, in the Categories list, click Control Elements. The Command List pane displays control elements only.

5 Drag a control from the Command List pane to add to the dashboard panel’s preview in the Panel Preview pane. Use the splitter bar as a visual indicator to specify the position for the command.

6 Click OK. To switch a control on a dashboard panel 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Dashboard Panels in the Customizations In pane to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to the dashboard panel where you want to change a control. 4 Click the plus sign (+) next to the row where you want to change a control. 5 Click the control element.

Add or Switch Dashboard Controls | 195

6 In the Properties pane, in the Control box, click the arrow to display a list of controls.

7 Click a control to replace the original control. 8 Click OK.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts DASHBOARD Opens the Dashboard window

196 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Add Shortcut Keys and Temporary Override Keys You can assign shortcut keys (sometimes called accelerator keys) to commands you use frequently, and temporary override keys to execute a command or change a setting when a key is pressed. Shortcut keys are keys and key combinations that start commands. For example, you can press CTRL+O to open a file and CTRL+S to save a file, which is the same result as choosing Open and Save from the File menu. The following table shows the Save shortcut key properties as they appear in the Properties pane. Properties for the Save shortcut key Properties Description pane item

Example

Name

String that is only used in the CUI editor and is not displayed in the user interface.

Save

Description

Text used to describe the element; does not appear in the user interface.

Saves the current drawing: QSAVE

Macro

The command macro. It follows the standard macro syntax.

^C^C_qsave

Add Shortcut Keys and Temporary Override Keys | 197

Properties for the Save shortcut key Properties Description pane item

Example

Keys

Specifies the keystroke combination that is used to execute the macro. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Shortcut Keys dialog box.

CTRL+S

Element ID

Tag that uniquely identifies a command.

ID_Save

Temporary override keys are keys that temporarily turn on or turn off one of the drawing aids that are set in the Drafting Settings dialog box (for example, Ortho mode, object snaps, or Polar mode). The following table shows the Object Snap Override: Endpoint temporary override key properties as they appear in the Properties pane. Properties for the Object Snap Override : Endpoint Temporary Override Key Properties Description pane item

Example

Name

String that is only used in the CUI editor and is not displayed in the user interface.

Object Snap Override : Endpoint

Description

Text used to describe the element; does not appear in the user interface.

Object Snap Override : Endpoint

Keys

Specifies the keystroke combination that is used to execute the temporary override. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Shortcut Keys dialog box.

SHIFT+E

Macro1 (Key Down)

Specifies the macro that should be executed when the keystroke combination is held down by the user.

^P'_.osmode 1 $(if,$(eq,$(getvar,osnapoverride),0),'_.osnapoverride 1)

198 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Properties for the Object Snap Override : Endpoint Temporary Override Key Properties Description pane item Macro2 (Key Up)

Example

Specifies the macro that should be executed when the keystroke combination is released by the user. If left blank, AutoCAD restores any variables to their previous state.

Shortcut keys can be associated with any command in the command list. You can create new shortcut keys or modify existing shortcut keys. The following table lists the default actions for shortcut keys. Shortcut key assignments Shortcut key

Description

ALT+F11

Displays the Visual Basic Editor

ALT+F8

Displays the Macros dialog box

CTRL+0

Toggles Clean Screen

CTRL+1

Toggles Properties palette

CTRL+2

Toggles DesignCenter

CTRL+3

Toggles the Tool Palettes Window

CTRL+4

Toggles Sheet Set Manager

CTRL+6

Toggles dbConnect Manager

CTRL+7

Toggles Markup Set Manager

CTRL+8

Toggles the QuickCalc calculator palette

Add Shortcut Keys and Temporary Override Keys | 199

Shortcut key assignments Shortcut key

Description

CTRL+9

Toggles the command window

CTRL+A

Selects objects in drawing

CTRL+SHITF+A

Toggles Groups

CTRL+B

Toggles Snap

CTRL+C

Copies objects to Clipboard

CTRL+SHIFT+C

Copies objects to Clipboard with Base Point

CTRL+D

Toggles Dynamic UCS

CTRL+E

Cycles through isometric planes

CTRL+F

Toggles running object snaps

CTRL+G

Toggles Grid

CTRL+H

Toggles PICKSTYLE

CTRL+I

Toggles COORDS

CTRL+J

Repeats last command

CTRL+L

Toggles Ortho mode

CTRL+M

Repeats last command

CTRL+N

Creates a new drawing

200 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Shortcut key assignments Shortcut key

Description

CTRL+O

Opens existing drawing

CTRL+P

Prints current drawing

CTRL+R

Cycles layout viewports

CTRL+S

Saves current drawing

CTRL+SHIFT+S

Brings up the Save As dialog box

CTRL+T

Toggles Tablet mode

CTRL+V

Pastes data from Clipboard

CTRL+SHIFT+V

Pastes data from Clipboard as a Block

CTRL+X

Cuts objects to Clipboard

CTRL+Y

Cancels the preceding Undo action

CTRL+Z

Reverses last action

CTRL+[

Cancels current command

CTRL+\

Cancels current command

CTRL+PAGE UP

Moves to the next layout tab to the left of the current tab

CTRL+PAGE DOWN

Moves to the next layout tab to the right of the current tab

F1

Displays Help

Add Shortcut Keys and Temporary Override Keys | 201

Shortcut key assignments Shortcut key

Description

F2

Toggles Text Window

F3

Toggles OSNAP

F4

Toggles TABMODE

F5

Toggles ISOPLANE

F6

Toggles UCSDETECT

F7

Toggles GRIDMODE

F8

Toggles ORTHOMODE

F9

Toggles SNAPMODE

F10

Toggles Polar Tracking

F11

Toggles Object Snap Tracking

F12

Toggles Dynamic Input

The following table lists the default actions for temporary override keys on an English U.S. keyboard. For more information about default temporary override keys on other keyboards, see Override Object Snap Settings. Temporary override key assignments Temporary override key Description F3

Toggles OSNAP

F6

Toggles UCSDETECT

202 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Temporary override key assignments Temporary override key Description F8

Toggles ORTHOMODE

F9

Toggles SNAPMODE

F10

Toggles Polar Tracking

F11

Toggles Object Snap Tracking

F12

Toggles Dynamic Input

SHIFT

Toggles ORTHOMODE

SHIFT+’

Toggles SNAPMODE

SHIFT+,

Object Snap Override: Center

SHIFT+.

Toggles Polar Tracking

SHIFT+/

Toggles UCSDETECT

SHIFT+;

Enables Object Snap Enforcement

SHIFT+]

Toggles Object Snap Tracking

SHIFT+A

Toggles OSNAP

SHIFT+C

Object Snap Override: Center

SHIFT+D

Disable All Snapping and Tracking

SHIFT+E

Object Snap Override: Endpoint

SHIFT+L

Disable All Snapping and Tracking

Add Shortcut Keys and Temporary Override Keys | 203

Temporary override key assignments Temporary override key Description SHIFT+M

Object Snap Override: Midpoint

SHIFT+P

Object Snap Override: Endpoint

SHIFT+Q

Toggles Object Snap Tracking

SHIFT+S

Enables Object Snap Enforcement

SHIFT+V

Object Snap Override: Midpoint

SHIFT+X

Toggles Polar Tracking

SHIFT+Z

Toggles UCSDETECT

In the Customize User Interface editor, you can view, print, or copy a list of shortcut keys, temporary override keys, or both. The shortcut keys and temporary override keys in the list are those keys used by the CUI files that are loaded in the program. To create a shortcut key 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Keyboard Shortcuts to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to Shortcut Keys to expand it. 4 In the Command List pane, drag the command to the Shortcut Keys node of the Customizations In pane.

204 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

In the Properties pane, the properties for the new shortcut key you created are displayed. 5 In the Key(s) box, click the [...] button to open the Shortcut Keys dialog box.

6 In the Shortcut Keys dialog box, click in the Press New Shortcut Key box to ensure the box has focus.

7 Hold down the modifier key CTRL with a combination of SHIFT and ALT if desired and press a letter, number, function, or virtual key. Valid modifier and key combinations include the following: ■

Function (Fn) keys containing no modifiers



Number Pad (NUMPADn) keys containing no modifiers



CTRL+letter, CTRL+number, CTRL+function, CTRL+virtual key

Add Shortcut Keys and Temporary Override Keys | 205



CTRL+ALT+letter, CTRL+ALT+number, CTRL+ALT+function, CTRL+ALT+virtual key



CTRL+SHIFT+letter, CTRL+SHIFT+number, CTRL+SHIFT+function, CTRL+SHIFT+virtual key



CTRL+SHIFT+ALT+letter, CTRL+SHIFT+ALT+number, CTRL+SHIFT+ALT+function, CTRL+SHIFT+ALT+virtual key NOTE The virtual keys that are supported are Escape, Insert, Delete, Home, End, Page Up, Page Down, Left Arrow, Right Arrow, Up Arrow, and Down Arrow. The virtual key Escape can only be used by itself or with the modifier combination CTRL+SHIFT+ALT.

Under the Press New Shortcut Key box, Currently Assigned To displays any current assignments for the shortcut key. 8 If you do not want to replace the current assignment, use a different shortcut key. Otherwise, click OK to assign the shortcut key and close the Shortcut Keys dialog. 9 In the Customize User Interface editor, click OK. To modify a shortcut key 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Keyboard Shortcuts to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to Shortcut Keys to expand it. 4 Click a shortcut key.

In the Properties pane, the properties for the shortcut key you selected are displayed. 5 In the Key(s) box, click the [...] button to open the Shortcut Keys dialog box.

206 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

6 Hold down the modifier key CTRL with a combination of SHIFT and ALT if desired and press a letter, number, function, or virtual key. Valid modifier and key combinations include the following: ■

Function (Fn) keys containing no modifiers



Number Pad (NUMPADn) keys containing no modifiers



CTRL+letter, CTRL+number, CTRL+function, CTRL+virtual key



CTRL+ALT+letter, CTRL+ALT+number, CTRL+ALT+function, CTRL+ALT+virtual key



CTRL+SHIFT+letter, CTRL+SHIFT+number, CTRL+SHIFT+function, CTRL+SHIFT+virtual key



CTRL+SHIFT+ALT+letter, CTRL+SHIFT+ALT+number, CTRL+SHIFT+ALT+function, CTRL+SHIFT+ALT+virtual key NOTE The virtual keys that are supported are Escape, Insert, Delete, Home, End, Page Up, Page Down, Left Arrow, Right Arrow, Up Arrow, and Down Arrow. The virtual key Escape can only be used by itself or with the modifier combination CTRL+SHIFT+ALT.

Below the Press New Shortcut Key box, Currently Assigned To displays any current assignments for the key. 7 If you do not want to replace the current assignment, use a different shortcut key. Otherwise, click OK to assign the shortcut key and close the Shortcut Keys dialog.

Add Shortcut Keys and Temporary Override Keys | 207

8 In the Customize User Interface editor, click OK. To create a temporary override key 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Keyboard Shortcuts to expand it. 3 In the Customizations In pane, right-click Temporary Override Keys. Click New Temporary Override.

A new temporary override (named TemporaryOverride1) is placed at the bottom of the Temporary Override Keys tree. 4 Do one of the following: ■

Enter a new name over the TemporaryOverride1 text.



Right-click TemporaryOverride1. Click Rename. Enter a new temporary override name.



Click TemporaryOverride1, wait, and click again over the temporary override’s name again to edit its name in-place.

5 Select the new temporary override in the tree view, and update the Properties pane: ■

In the Description box, enter a description for the temporary override key.



In the Key(s) box, click the [...] button to open the Shortcut Keys dialog box. In the Shortcut Keys dialog box, click in the Press New Shortcut Key box to ensure the box has focus, and press a key. Valid modifier keys include function (Fn keys) with no modifiers, SHIFT+letter, or SHIFT+number key.

208 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface



In the Macro 1 (Key Down) box, enter a macro to be executed when the temporary override key is pressed. When no value is assigned, the default macro is ^c^c.



In the Macro 2 (Key Up) box, enter a macro to be executed when the temporary override key is released. When no value is defined, key up restores the application to its previous state (before the temporary override was executed). NOTE For information about creating a macro, see Create Macros (page 114).

To modify a temporary override key 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Keyboard Shortcuts to expand it. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to Temporary Override Keys to expand it. 4 In the Customizations In pane, click the temporary override key you want to modify.

5 Update the Properties pane as necessary: ■

In the Description box, enter a description for the temporary override key.



In the Key(s) box, click the [...] button to open the Shortcut Keys dialog box. In the Shortcut Keys dialog box, click in the Press New Shortcut Key box to ensure the box has focus, and press a key. Under the Press New Shortcut Key box, Currently Assigned To displays any current assignments for the key. If a key you select is not already assigned, click OK.

Add Shortcut Keys and Temporary Override Keys | 209



In the Macro 1 (Key Down) box, enter a macro to be executed when the temporary override key is pressed. When no value is assigned, the default macro is ^c^c.



In the Macro 2 (Key Up) box, enter a macro to be executed when the temporary override key is released. When no value is defined, key up restores the application to its previous state (before the temporary override was executed).

NOTE For information about creating a macro, see Create Macros (page 114).

To print a list of shortcut keys or temporary override keys 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customizations In pane, click the Keyboard Shortcuts node.

3 In the Shortcuts pane, filter the type and status of keyboard shortcuts to print. ■

In the Type drop-down list, select the type of keyboard shortcuts to display in the list. Choices include All Keys, Accelerator Keys, or Temporary Override Keys.



In the Status list, select the status of keyboard shortcuts displayed in the list. Choices include All, Active, Inactive, and Unassigned.

4 In the Shortcuts pane, click Print.

210 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts

System Variables TOOLTIPS Controls the display of tooltips on toolbars TEMPOVERRIDES Turns temporary override keys on and off

Add Shortcut Keys and Temporary Override Keys | 211

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Create a Double Click Action Double click actions are used to make editing commands accessible when the cursor is positioned over an object in a drawing and a double-click is registered from a pointing device. The double click actions are object type sensitive, allowing you to set up a specific command to use for a specific object type. Double click actions execute a command that displays either the Properties palette or a specialized editor that is more powerful, convenient, or frequently used for the object type that is double-clicked in a drawing. The following table shows the definition of the Attribute Block double click action in the CUI editor. Properties for the Attribute Block double click action Properties Description pane item

Example

Name

String used to identify the double click action in the CUI editor.

Attribute Block

Description

Text used to describe the element in the CUI editor.

Object Name

Determines the type of object the double click action is associated to.

ATTBLOCKREF

Element ID

Uniquely identifies a double click action in the CUI editor.

DC_0002

212 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Double Click Action Object Names Double click actions are referenced by the value of the Object Name property that must match a valid drawing interchange format (DXF™) name. There are some exceptions that do not use the DXF name. These exceptions are for blocks, dynamic blocks, and external references, which use special object names. For example, the double click action named “Attribute Dynamic Block” in the acad.cui file uses the object name ATTDYNBLOCKREF. The following table shows the object names that are specific to blocks, dynamic blocks, and external references. Object names specific to inserted objects Object Name

Description

BLOCKREF

Block reference without attributes

ATTBLOCKREF

Block reference with attributes

DYNBLOCKREF

Dynamic block reference without attributes

ATTDYNBLOCKREF

Dynamic block reference with attributes

XREF

External reference (xref)

NOTE If more than one object is selected or if a double click action is not associated with an object type, the default command used is PROPERTIES. The following table shows some of the object names that are set up in the acad.cui file. Expand the Double Click Actions node in the Customize User Interface (CUI) editor for a complete listing of all the actions that are defined. Double click action assignments Object

Command (Macro)

ATTDEF

DDEDIT

ATTBLOCKREF

EATTEDIT

Create a Double Click Action | 213

Double click action assignments Object

Command (Macro)

ATTDYNBLOCKREF

EATTEDIT

BLOCKREF

$M=$(if,$(and,$(>,$(getvar,blockeditlock),0)),^C^C_properties,^C^C_bedit)

DYNBLOCKREF

$M=$(if,$(and,$(>,$(getvar,blockeditlock),0)),^C^C_properties,^C^C_bedit)

HATCH

HATCHEDIT

IMAGE

IMAGEADJUST

LWPOLYLINE

PEDIT

MLINE

MLEDIT

MTEXT

MTEDIT

POLYLINE

PEDIT

SPLINE

SPLINEDIT

TEXT

DDEDIT

XREF

REFEDIT

NOTE Double click actions cannot be created for OLE and Viewport objects. To create a double click action 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui.

214 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, right-click Double Click Actions. Click New Double Click Action.

The new double click action (named DoubleClick1) is placed at the bottom of the Double Click Actions tree. 3 Do one of the following: ■

Enter a new name over the DoubleClick1 text.



Right-click DoubleClick1. Click Rename. Enter a new double click action name.



Click DoubleClick1, wait, and click again over the double click action’s name again to edit its name in-place.

4 In the Properties pane, do the following: ■

In the Description box, enter a description for the double click action.



In the Object Name box, enter a DXF name or one of the special object names used for an inserted object. The value will automatically be converted to uppercase after the box loses focus.

5 In the Command List pane, drag the command you want to add to the location just below the double click action in the Customizations In pane.

Create a Double Click Action | 215

NOTE Only a single command can be associated with a double click action at a time. 6 Click OK. To modify a double click action 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Double Click Actions to expand it. 3 Click a double click action.

In the Properties pane, the properties for the double click action you selected are displayed. 4 In the Object Name box, enter a DXF name or one of the special object names used for an inserted object.

216 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

5 If you want to replace the current command assigned to the double click action, click in the Command List pane and drag a different command to the selected double click action in the Customizations In pane.

6 In the Customize User Interface editor, click OK.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts OPTIONS Customizes the program settings

System Variables DBLCLKEDIT Controls the double click editing behavior in the drawing area PICKFIRST Controls whether you select objects before (noun-verb selection) or after you issue a command

Create a Double Click Action | 217

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Customize Mouse Buttons You can change the standard behavior of pointing devices in the program. Mouse buttons define how a Windows system pointing device functions. You can customize the behavior of a mouse or other pointing device in the Customize User Interface editor. If a pointing device has more than two buttons, you can change the behavior of the second and third buttons. The first button on any pointing device cannot be changed in the Customize User Interface editor. By using the SHIFT and CTRL keys, you can create a number of combinations to suit your needs. Your pointing device can recognize as many commands as it has assignable buttons. The Mouse Buttons section of the tree node is organized by keyboard combination such as Click, SHIFT+Click, CTRL+Click, and CTRL+SHIFT+Click. The tablet buttons are numbered sequentially. Drag a command to assign the command to a mouse button. Create additional buttons by dragging commands to a Click node. The following table shows the Click mouse button properties as they appear in the Properties pane. Properties for the Click mouse button Properties Description pane item

Example

Aliases

AUX1

Specifies the aliases for the mouse button. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Aliases dialog box. Each alias in the CUI file should be unique and it is used to reference the mouse button programatically.

218 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Accept Coordinate Entry in Button Menus When you click one of the buttons on a multibutton pointing device, the program reads not only the button number but also the coordinate of the crosshairs at the time you click. By carefully constructing macros, you can choose to either ignore the coordinate or use it with the command activated by the button. As described in Pause for User Input in Macros (page 119), you can include a backslash (\) in a command to pause for user input. For the Mouse and Digitize Buttons menus, the coordinate of the crosshairs is supplied as user input when the button is clicked. This occurs only for the first backslash in the command; if the item contains no backslashes, the crosshairs coordinate is not used. Consider the following commands: line line \

The first button starts the LINE command and displays the Specify First Point prompt in the normal fashion. The second button also starts the LINE command, but the program uses the current crosshairs location at the Specify First Point prompt and displays the Specify Next Point prompt. To add a mouse button combination 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, click the Customize tab. 3 In the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to Mouse Buttons to expand the list. 4 Right-click a mouse button section. Click New Button.

A new mouse button (named Buttonn) is placed at the bottom of the selected list. 5 In the Command List pane, drag the command you want to add to the mouse button in the Customizations In pane.

Accept Coordinate Entry in Button Menus | 219

6 Click OK.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts

220 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Customize Legacy Interface Elements The term “legacy” refers to those user interface elements that are not commonly used with the current version of the program, but are still supported because some users prefer them to alternative user interface elements that are now provided. Legacy interface elements include: ■

Tablet menus



Tablet buttons



Screen menus



Image tile menus

Create Tablet Menus You can configure up to four areas of your digitizing tablet as menu areas for command input. The nodes in the Customize User Interface editor are labeled Tablet Menu 1 through Tablet Menu 4 and define the macros associated with tablet selections. The tablet menu areas that you define with the Cfg option of the TABLET command are divided into equal-sized menu selection boxes, which are determined by the number of columns and rows you specify in each area. These tablet menu selection boxes correspond directly with the lines that follow the Tablet section labels from left to right and top to bottom (whether or not they contain text).

Customize Legacy Interface Elements | 221

For example, if you configure a menu area for five columns and four rows, the command on the line immediately following the Row label corresponds to the left-most selection box in the top row. The program can recognize up to 32,766 commands in each tablet section, which should be more than enough for any tablet menu. You can add your own macros to the Macros cell in the Properties pane. The command labels in this area correspond to the 225 boxes at the top of your tablet template (rows A through I and columns 1 through 25). You can add a macro using standard command syntax. The following table shows the Click mouse button properties as they appear in the Properties pane. Properties for the Tablet Menu 1 Properties Description pane item

Example

Aliases

Specifies the aliases for the tablet menu. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Aliases dialog box. Each alias in the CUI file should be unique and it is used to reference the tablet menu programatically.

TABLET1, TABLET1STD

Rows

Number of rows that can be customized for the tablet menu.

9

Columns

Number of columns that can be customized for the tablet menu.

25

To define rows and columns in a tablet menu 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to Legacy to expand the list. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to Tablet Menus to expand the list. 4 Click the plus sign (+) next to a tablet menu to expand the list. 5 Click the row that you want to define. 6 In the Command List pane, locate the command you want to add.

222 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

7 Drag the command to a column. 8 Click OK. To clear a tablet menu assignment 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to Legacy to expand the list. 3 Click the plus sign (+) next to Tablet Menus to expand the list. 4 Click the plus sign (+) next to a tablet menu to expand the list. 5 Right-click the row or column that you want to clear. Click Clear Assignment. 6 Click OK.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts TABLET Calibrates, configures, and turns on and off an attached digitizing tablet

Create Tablet Menus | 223

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Customize Tablet Buttons To customize tablet buttons, you follow the same procedures as for customizing mouse buttons. Tablet buttons are the buttons that are found on the pointing device, also known as a puck, used with a digitizer tablet. Pucks come in a variety of shapes, sizes, and button configurations. You can customize all the buttons on a puck except for the first button. Some hardware manufacturers utilize a slightly different button layout from one puck to another. One might start with the first button in the upper-left corner and count across and down from 1 through F, while another might start in the upper-left corner and have a different numbering scheme. NOTE It is important to test your button assignments as they are assigned to ensure the proper button is being mapped. You may need to refer to your owners manual that came with your puck for how the buttons are laid out. To customize tablet buttons, you follow the same procedures as for customizing mouse buttons. For more information about customizing tablet buttons, see Customize Mouse Buttons (page 218).

224 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Create Screen Menus Screen menus provide a legacy interface for displaying menus in a palette. You create and edit screen menus in the Customize User Interface editor. By default, the screen menu is disabled. You turn on the screen menu display in the Options dialog box, Display tab. In addition, the MENUCTL system variable controls whether the screen menu is updated as you enter commands at the command prompt. NOTE Future releases of the product will not support screen menus. In the Customize User Interface editor, each screen menu consists of several menu lines, which define the screen submenus. You assign a submenu to a screen menu by dragging it to the screen menu in the Customize In pane. You assign a command to a menu by dragging it from the Command List pane to the numbered line in the menu. Unassigned lines are left empty in the menu.

Create Screen Menus | 225

Edit Screen Menu Properties You can modify screen menu properties, as shown in the following table. Properties for screen menus Properties pane item

Description

Example

Name

Sets the name of the menu.

SCREEN

Description

Text that describes the element; does not appear in the user interface.

Start line

Sets the start line of the screen menu submenu.

1

Number of lines

Sets the number of lines in a screen submenu.

27

Aliases

Specifies the alias for the screen menu. “Collection” is displayed if multiple definitions are assigned to this alias. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Aliases dialog box.

SCREEN, S

For the AutoCAD screen menu, which is the root menu, the aliases in the Aliases box are Screen (which represents the beginning of the screen menu) and S (which represents the submenu section label). Line assignments for other menus define the order of the options on the menu. For example, the File menu on Line 3 in the tree view of the AutoCAD screen menu is in the third position on the AutoCAD screen menu. The submenu names in the tree view correspond to the name of the first submenu item. For example, the New submenu contains commands such as OPEN, QSAVE, and SAVEAS—in addition to NEW. The Aliases box for these submenus defines which menu contains them and the Start Line box specifies their position on that menu. The New submenu is displayed in position 3 on the File screen menu. Therefore, in the Properties pane, its start line is 3. When you double-click Aliases to display the Aliases dialog box, you can see that its menu assignment is 01_FILE.

226 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

You can designate which menu items are always displayed by controlling the start line settings. For example, since the New submenu is set to start on line 3, the menu items on lines 1 and 2 of the AutoCAD screen menu (the AutoCAD and **** menu options) continue to display when the New submenu is displayed. Similarly, you can set a menu to mask or show menu options on other menus by using blank lines. For example, there are only 22 lines (including blank lines) defined for the New submenu. Therefore, the Assist and Last submenus on lines 25 and 26 of the AutoCAD screen menu continue to be displayed when the New submenu is selected. An option on line 22, however, would be hidden. To display the screen menu 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Options.At the Command prompt, enter options. 2 In the Options dialog box, Display tab, under Window Elements, select Display Screen Menu. 3 Click OK. To set screen menus to reflect the current command 1 At the Command prompt, enter menuctl. 2 Do one of the following: ■

Enter 1 to set screen menus to reflect the current command.



Enter 0 to set screen menus to ignore the current command.

To add commands to the screen menu 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to Legacy to expand the list. 3 In the Legacy list, click the plus sign (+) next to a screen menu to expand the list.

Create Screen Menus | 227

4 In the Command List pane, locate the command you want to add. Drag the command to the screen menu. An arrow is displayed next to the cursor when the command can be dropped. 5 Click OK. To create a submenu on a screen menu 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to Legacy to expand the list. 3 In the Legacy list, right-click Screen Menu. Click New Screen Menu. A new screen menu (named ScreenMenu1) is placed at the bottom of the Screen Menus tree. 4 Do one of the following: ■

Enter a new name over the ScreenMenu1 text.



Right-click ScreenMenu1. Click Rename. Then, enter a new menu name.



Click ScreenMenu1, wait, and click again over the screen menu’s name again to edit its name in-place.

5 Select the new screen menu in the tree view, and update the Properties pane as follows: ■

In the Description box, enter a description for the screen menu.



In the Start Line box, enter the line number for the first option in the menu.



In the Number of Lines box, enter the number of total lines that should be available for the screen menu.



In the Aliases box, enter an alias.

6 In the Command List pane, drag the command to a location just below the screen menu in the Customizations In pane. 7 Click OK.

228 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts OPTIONS Customizes the program settings

System Variables MENUCTL Controls the page switching of the screen menu SCREENBOXES Stores the number of boxes in the screen menu area of the drawing area

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Create Image Tile Menus The purpose of an image tile menu is to provide an image that can be selected instead of text. You can create, edit, or add image tiles and image tile slides. An image tile dialog box displays images in groups of 20, along with a scrolling list box on the left that displays the associated slide file names or related text. If an image tile dialog box contains more than 20 slides, the additional slides are added to a new page. Next and Previous buttons are activated so that you can browse the pages of images. Following is an example of the 3D Objects image tile dialog box with the Dome image tile slide selected.

Create Image Tile Menus | 229

You define an image tile menu in the Customize User Interface editor. The following table shows the 3D Objects image tile menu properties as they appear in the Properties pane. Properties for the 3D Object image tile menu Properties Description pane item

Example

Name

String that is used only in the CUI editor and is not displayed in the user interface.

3D Objects

Description

Text that describes the element and does not appear in the user interface.

Aliases

Specifies the aliases for the image tile menu. Click the ellipses button [...] to open the Aliases dialog box. Each alias in the CUI file should be unique and it is used to reference the image file menu programatically.

image, image_3DObjects

The following table shows the Dome command properties of the 3D Objects image tile menu as they appear in the Properties pane. Properties for the Dome command on the 3D Objects image tile menu Properties Description pane item

Example

Name

Dome

String displayed in the list box on the left side of the image tile menu dialog box. The string must include alphanumeric characters with no punctuation other than a hyphen (-) or an underscore (_).

230 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Properties for the Dome command on the 3D Objects image tile menu Properties Description pane item

Example

Description

Text that describes the element; does not appear in the user interface.

Creates the upper half of a spherical polygon mesh

Macro

The command macro. It follows the standard macro syntax.

^C^C_ai_dome

Element ID

Tag that uniquely identifies a command.

ID_Ai_dome

Slide library

A file that is made up of multiple slides and created using the file slidelib.exe.

acad

Slide label

Name of a slide contained in the slide library file or a slide image that is stored separately.

Dome

You can use any slide generated by AutoCAD as an image. Keep the following suggestions in mind as you prepare slides for an image tile menu. ■

Keep the image simple. When an image tile menu is displayed, you must wait for all images to be drawn before making a selection. If you show numerous complex symbols, use simple, recognizable images rather than full renditions.



Fill the box. When making a slide for an image, be sure to fill the screen with the image before starting MSLIDE. If the image is very wide and short, or long and thin, the image tile menu will look best if you use PAN to center the image on the screen before making the slide. Images are displayed with an aspect ratio of 3:2 (3 units wide by 2 units high). If your drawing area has a different aspect ratio, it can be difficult to produce image slides that are centered in the image tile menu. If you work within a layout viewport that has an aspect ratio of 3:2, you can position the image and be assured that it will look the same when it is displayed in the image tile menu.



Remember the purpose of the images. Do not use images to encode abstract concepts into symbols. Image tiles are useful primarily for selecting a graphic symbol.

Create Image Tile Menus | 231

To create an image tile slide 1 In AutoCAD, draw the geometry that you want to appear in the slide. 2 Click View menu ➤ Zoom ➤ Center.At the Command prompt, enter zoom. 3 At the Command prompt, enter mslide. 4 In the Create Slide File dialog box, specify the file name. 5 Click Save, and add it to a slide library file if desired. You can associate this image slide to a new image tile. To view an image tile slide 1 At the Command prompt, enter vslide. 2 In the Select Slide File dialog box, browse to and select the slide file you want to view. 3 Click Open. The slide file should be displayed in the drawing window. Perform a Regen on the drawing to clear the slide file from the display. To create an image tile slide library 1 Place all your slides in a single folder location that you want to add to a slide library. 2 Click Start menu (Windows) ➤ Run. 3 In the Run dialog box, enter cmd in the text box. 4 Click OK to bring up a DOS window. 5 At the Command prompt, enter CD . As an example: CD “c:\slides” 6 While in the location of the slide files, enter dir *.sld /b > . As an example: dir *.sld /b > “myslides” A text file will be created with the names of the slide files contained in the current folder.

232 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

7 With the text file created of all the slide files in the current folder, enter \slidelib.exe < . As an example: “C:\Program Files\AutoCAD 2008\slidelib.exe”“myslidelib” < “myslides” 8 When you finish, close the DOS window. WARNING After you create the slide library, place the individual slide files in a safe place so they do not accidently get deleted. This is important if you need to rebuild the slide library one day. To create an image tile menu and assign an image tile slide 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to Legacy to expand the list. 3 In the Legacy list, right-click Image Tile Menu. Click New Image Tile Menu. A new image tile menu (named ImageTileMenu1) is placed at the bottom of the Image Tile Menus tree. 4 Do one of the following: ■

Enter a new name over the ImageTileMenu1 text.



Right-click ImageTileMenu1. Click Rename. Then, enter a new image tile name.



Click ImageTileMenu1, wait, and click again over the image tile’s name again to edit its name in-place.

5 In the Command List pane, drag a command to the new image tile menu in the Customizations In pane. 6 In the Properties pane, enter the properties for the new image tile slide as follows: ■

In the Name box, enter the text to display in the list box for the image tile.



In the Description box, enter a description for the image tile.

Create Image Tile Menus | 233



In the Slide library box, enter the name of the image tile slide library that contains the slide for the image tile. The image tile slide library must be in one of the folders that defines the Support File Search Path. If you do not have a slide library, but rather an image tile slide file, you enter its name in the image tile slide library box.



In the Slide label box, enter the name of the image tile slide file contained in the image tile slide library listed in the Slide library box.

7 Click OK.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts MSLIDE Creates a slide file of the current model viewport or the current layout VSLIDE Displays an image slide file in the current viewport

234 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Load an AutoLISP File AutoLISP (LSP or MNL) files contain scripts that add customization actions and behaviors to the interface. You can load AutoLISP files into a CUI file using the Customize tab of the Customize User Interface editor. For more information about using AutoLISP, see AutoLISP and Visual LISP (page 328). TIP MNL files with the same name and location as your main, enterprise, or partial CUI files are loaded automatically. These files cannot be removed. To load an AutoLISP file in the Customize User Interface editor 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, right-click LISP Files. Click Load LISP.

3 In the Load LISP dialog box, located and select the AutoLISP file you want to load. Only files with the extension LSP can be selected.

Load an AutoLISP File | 235

TIP Even though files with the LSP extension can only be loaded using this method, you can still load other types of custom program files. Use AutoCAD commands such as NETLOAD, VBALOAD, or ARX to load other types of custom program files. 4 Click Open.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts APPLOAD Loads and unloads applications and defines which applications to load at startup

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Customize Workspaces You can customize workspaces to create a drawing environment that displays only those toolbars, menus, and palettes that you select. Customization options for workspaces include creating a workspace using the Customize User Interface editor, changing the properties of a workspace, and displaying a toolbar in all workspaces.

236 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Create or Modify a Workspace Using the Customize User Interface Editor The easiest way for users to create or modify a workspace is to set up the toolbars and palettes that best suit a drawing task, and then save that setup as a workspace in the program. That workspace can be accessed any time the user needs to draw within that workspace environment. You can also set up a workspace using the Customize User Interface editor. In this dialog box, you can create or modify workspaces with precise properties and elements (toolbars, menus, and palettes) that you want your users to access for certain tasks. You can specify the CUI file containing this workspace as an enterprise CUI file, so that you can share the workspace with your users. For more information about creating an enterprise CUI file, see Create an Enterprise CUI File (page 80). Following is an example of the Customize User Interface Editor, Workspace Contents pane. You click Customize Workspaces to create or modify the selected workspace.

Following is an example of the Customizations In pane after you click Customize Workspaces in the Workspace Contents pane. Check boxes are displayed next to each element that you can add to a workspace. You click a check box to add the element to the workspace.

Customize Workspaces | 237

Change the Properties of a Workspace In the Customize User Interface editor, you can define workspace properties, such as the workspace name, description, whether it is displayed on the Model or layout tab, and so on. The following table shows the AutoCAD Classic workspace properties as they appear in the Properties pane. Properties for the AutoCAD Classic workspace Properties Description pane item

Example

Name

String displayed in the drop-down box on the Workspaces toolbar, at the command prompt for the WORKSPACE command, under the Workspaces menu item in the Tools menu, and in the CUI Editor.

AutoCAD Classic

Description

Text that describes the workspace; does not appear in the user interface.

Start On

Determines if the Model tab, last active layout tab, or the current active tab in the drawing is displayed when the workspace is restored or set current.

Model

Model/Layout tabs

Determines if the Model/layout tabs are visible or not in the drawing window when the workspace is restored or set current.

On

238 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Properties for the AutoCAD Classic workspace Properties Description pane item

Example

Screen menus

Determines if the Screen menu is visible or not when the workspace is restored or set current.

Off

Scroll bars

Determines if the Scroll bars are visible or not when the workspace is restored or set current.

Off

Change the Properties of a Palette Many windows, known as palettes, can be set to be docked, anchored, or floating. You can define the size, location, or appearance of these windows by changing their properties in the Workspace Contents pane of the Customize User Interface editor. These windows include: ■

Advanced Render Settings



Command Line



Dashboard



dbConnect Manager



DesignCenter



External References



Lights in Model



Materials



Markup Set Manager



Properties



QuickCalc



SheetSet Manager



Sun Properties



Tool Palette



Visual Styles Manager

Customize Workspaces | 239

The following table shows the Tool Palettes properties as they appear in the Properties pane. Properties for the Tool Palettes window Properties Description pane item

Example

Show

Visibility state of the palette. The available options are Yes, No, or Do Not Change. Do Not Change keeps the last used state of the palette when the workspace is restored or set current.

Yes

Orientation

The on screen docking or floating state of the palette. The available options are Floating, Left, Right, or Do Not Change. Do Not Change keeps the last used state of the palette when the workspace is restored or set current. Some palettes like the Command Line also support a dock location of Top and Bottom.

Floating

Allow Docking

Controls if the user can dock the palette by dragging it to one of the designated docking areas. The available options are Yes, No, or Do Not Change. Do Not Change maintains the last used setting for the palette when the workspace is restored or set current.

Yes

Auto Hide

Controls if the palette rolls up when not in use. The available options are On, Off, or Do Not Change. Do Not Change maintains the last used setting for the palette when the workspace is restored or set current.

Off

Use Transparency

Controls if the palette appears transparent. The available options are Yes, No, or Do Not Change. Do Not Change maintains the last used setting for the palette when the workspace is restored or set current.

No

240 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

Properties for the Tool Palettes window Properties Description pane item

Example

Transparency Amount

Controls how opaque the palette is displayed. The valid range is 0 through 100.

0

Default Group

Controls which of the user defined palette groups should be displayed.

All Palettes

Height

Determines how tall the palette is when it is floating.

598

Width

Determines how wide the palette is when it is floating.

172

Change the Properties of a Toolbar Toolbars can be set to be docked or floating. You can define the size, location, or appearance of toolbars by changing their properties in the Workspace Contents pane of the Customize User Interface editor.

Import a Workspace to a Main CUI File Workspaces in partial CUI files are ignored by the main CUI file, even when the partial CUI file is loaded in the main CUI file. You can import a workspace to the main CUI file using the Transfer tab of the Customize User Interface editor.

Setting a Default Workspace Workspaces in a CUI file can be marked as default. This identifies which workspace in the CUI file should be restored when the CUI file is loaded into the program the first time, or after the CUI file has been loaded with the CUILOAD command. To create a workspace using the Customize User Interface editor 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui.

Customize Workspaces | 241

2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, right-click the Workspaces tree node, and select New Workspace.

A new, empty workspace (named Workspace1) is placed at the bottom of the Workspaces tree. 3 Do one of the following: ■

Enter a new name over the Workspace1 text.



Right-click Workspace1. Click Rename. Then, enter a new workspace name.



Click Workspace1, wait, and click again over the workspace’s name again to edit its name in-place.

4 In the Workspace Contents pane, click Customize Workspace.

5 In the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Toolbars tree node, Menus tree node, or Partial CUI files tree node to expand it. NOTE The menu, toolbar, and partial CUI file nodes now display check boxes so that you can easily add elements to the workspace. 6 Click the check box next to each menu, toolbar, or partial CUI file that you want to add to the workspace.

242 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

In the Workspace Contents pane, the selected elements are added to the workspace. 7 In the Workspace Contents pane, click Done.

8 Click OK. To create a workspace using the Workspace toolbar 1 Right-click over a toolbar that is currently displayed in the AutoCAD interface. A shortcut menu is displayed with the available toolbars contained under the customization group that the toolbar belongs to. 2 Click Workspaces to display the toolbar if it is not currently displayed.

Customize Workspaces | 243

A check mark is displayed to the left of any toolbar that is currently displayed. 3 Make the necessary changes to the size, location, and any other properties to toolbars and palettes. 4 On the Workspaces toolbar, select Save Current As.

5 In the Save Workspace dialog box, enter a name in the text box or select an existing one to overwrite from the drop-down list.

6 Click Save to create or modify the workspace. NOTE The Workspaces toolbar will be visible when the workspace is restored. If the Workspaces toolbar is not visible to display the Save Workspace dialog box, click Tools menu ➤ Workspaces ➤ Save Current As.If the Workspaces toolbar is not visible to display the Save Workspace dialog box, at the Command prompt, enter WSSAVE. To change the properties of a workspace 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, click the Customize tab.

244 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

3 On the Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the workspace whose properties you want to change.

4 In the Properties pane, do any of the following: ■

In the Name box, enter a new name for the workspace.



In the Description box, enter a description.



In the Start On box, select an option (Model, Layout, Do Not Change).



In the Model/Layout Tab box, select an option (On, Off, Do Not Change).



In the Screen Menus box, select an option (On, Off, Do Not Change).



In the Scroll Bars box, select an option (On, Off, Do Not Change).

5 Click OK. To display pull-down menus on the menu bar 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Workspaces node to expand it. 3 Select the workspace that you want to modify.

Customize Workspaces | 245

4 In the Workspace Contents pane, click Customize Workspace.

5 In the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Menus tree node, or Partial CUI files tree node to expand it. 6 Click the check box next to each menu, or partial CUI file that you want to add to the workspace.

In the Workspace Contents pane, the selected elements are added to the workspace. 7 In the Workspace Contents pane, click Done.

NOTE Make sure to set the workspace current to ensure the changes are displayed. 8 Click OK.

246 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

To reposition pull-down menus on the menu bar 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Workspaces node to expand it. 3 Select the workspace that you want to modify.

4 In the Workspace Contents pane, click and hold down the pointer button over the pull-down menu that you want to move and drag the pull-down menu into the new location.

A splitter bar will be displayed between the pull-down menus indicating the location the pull-down menu would be moved to when the pointer button is released. 5 Once the splitter bar is in the place where you want to insert the pull-down menu, release the pointer button to reposition the pull-down menu. NOTE Make sure to set the workspace current to ensure the changes are displayed. 6 Click OK.

Customize Workspaces | 247

To display toolbars 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Workspaces node to expand it. 3 Select the workspace that you want to modify.

4 In the Workspace Contents pane, click Customize Workspace.

5 In the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Toolbars tree node, or Partial CUI files tree node to expand it. 6 Click the check box next to each toolbar, or partial CUI file that you want to add to the workspace.

In the Workspace Contents pane, the selected elements are added to the workspace. 7 In the Workspace Contents pane, click Done.

248 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

NOTE Make sure to set the workspace current to ensure the changes are displayed. 8 Click OK. To change the properties of a toolbar 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the workspace that contains the toolbar you want to modify.

3 In the Workspace Contents pane, click the plus sign (+) next to Toolbars to expand the list. 4 Click the toolbar that you want to modify.

Customize Workspaces | 249

5 In the Properties pane, do any of the following: ■

In the Orientation box, select an option (Floating, Top, Bottom, Left, or Right).



(Only if Orientation is set to Floating) In the Default X Location box, enter a number. A value of 0 starts the location of the toolbar at the left edge of the screen, as the number increases the further from the left the toolbar is placed.



(Only if Orientation is set to Floating) In the Default Y Location box, enter a number. A value of 0 starts the location of the toolbar at the top edge of the screen, as the number increases the further from the top the toolbar is placed.



(Only if Orientation is set to Floating) In the Rows box, enter a number. Enter a number to have the buttons on the toolbar wrap around to create the number of rows if possible. 0 is the default value.

6 Click OK. To display dashboard panels 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Workspaces node to expand it. 3 Select the workspace that you want to modify.

4 In the Workspace Contents pane, click Customize Workspace.

250 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

5 In the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Dashboard Panels tree node, or Partial CUI files tree node to expand it. 6 Click the check box next to each dashboard panel, or partial CUI file that you want to add to the workspace.

In the Workspace Contents pane, the selected elements are added to the workspace. 7 In the Workspace Contents pane, click Done.

NOTE Make sure to set the workspace current to ensure the changes are displayed. 8 Click OK.

Customize Workspaces | 251

To reposition a dashboard panel on the Dashboard window 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to the Workspaces node to expand it. 3 Select the workspace that you want to modify. 4 In the Workspace Contents pane, click and hold down the pointer button over the dashboard panel that you want to move. Drag the dashboard panel into the new location. A splitter bar indicates the location the dashboard panel.

5 Once the splitter bar is in the place where you want to insert the dashboard panel, release the mouse button to reposition the dashboard panel. NOTE Make sure to set the workspace as current to ensure the changes are displayed. 6 Click OK. To change the properties of a palette 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the workspace that contains the palette you want to modify.

252 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

3 In the Workspace Contents pane, click the plus sign (+) next to Palettes to expand the list. 4 Click the window that you want to modify.

5 In the Properties pane, do any of the following: ■

In the Show box, select an option (No, Yes, or Do Not Change).



In the Orientation box, select an option (Floating, Top, Bottom, Left, or Right).



In the Allow Docking box, select an option (No, Yes, or Do Not Change). NOTE To specify that a window should be anchored, set Orientation to Left, Right, Top, or Bottom, and set Auto Hide to On.



In the Auto Hide box, select an option (On, Off, or Do Not Change).



In the Use Transparency box, select an option (No, Yes, or Do Not Change).



In the Transparency Amount box, enter a number (if applicable).



(Tool Palettes only) In the Default Group box, select a Tool Palette group.



In the Height box, enter a number. A value of 0 is equivalent to Do Not Change.

Customize Workspaces | 253



In the Width box, enter a number. A value of 0 is equivalent to Do Not Change.

6 Click OK. To duplicate a workspace 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, in the Customizations In pane, click the plus sign (+) next to Workspaces to expand it. 3 Right-click the workspace. Click Duplicate Workspace.

A duplicate of the workspace (named Copy of ) is placed at the bottom of the Workspaces tree). 4 Do one of the following: ■

Enter a new name over the Copy of text.



Right-click Copy of . Click Rename. Enter a new name for the workspace.

254 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface



Click Copy of , wait, and click again over the workspace’s name again to edit its name in-place.

5 Modify the workspace as necessary. 6 Click OK. To set a workspace current 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Workspaces to expand it. 3 Right-click the workspace you want to set current. Click Set Current.

4 Click OK. To set a workspace as default 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Interface.At the Command prompt, enter cui. 2 In the Customize User Interface editor, Customize tab, click the plus sign (+) next to Workspaces to expand it. 3 Right-click the workspace you want to set as default. Click Set Default.

Customize Workspaces | 255

4 Click OK. NOTE In the Network Deployment Wizard, the main and enterprise CUI files can be specified. If the main CUI file has a default workspace set, the default workspace will be set as the current workspace when the file is loaded into AutoCAD the first time. To restore a workspace with a command line switch 1 Right-click the program icon on the Windows desktop. Click Properties.

2 In the AutoCAD Properties dialog box, Shortcut tab, in the Target box, edit the parameters for the switch using the following syntax: “drive:pathname\acad.exe” [“drawing name”] [/switch “name”] For Example, enter “d:\AutoCAD 2008\acad.exe” /w “MyWorkspace”

256 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

3 Click OK. To import a workspace to a main CUI file 1 Click Tools menu ➤ Customize ➤ Import Customizations.At the Command prompt, enter cuiimport. The Transfer tab is displayed, with the main CUI file displayed in the Customizations In pane (left side). 2 On the Transfer tab, in the Customizations In pane (right side), click the Open Customization File button.

3 In the Open dialog box, locate and select the customization file that contains the workspace you want to add.

Customize Workspaces | 257

4 In the right pane, drag the workspace from the CUI file to the Workspaces node in the main CUI file (left pane).

5 Click OK.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts CUIEXPORT Exports customized settings from acad.cui to an enterprise or partial CUI file CUIIMPORT Imports customized settings from an enterprise or partial CUI file to acad.cui CUILOAD Loads a CUI file CUIUNLOAD Unloads a CUI file WORKSPACE Creates, modifies, and saves workspaces and makes a workspace current

258 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

System Variables WSCURRENT Returns the current workspace name in the command line interface and sets a workspace to current

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Customize User Interface FAQs FAQs will help you to find answers to some of the most commonly asked questions about using the Customize User Interface (CUI) editor.

Migrating/Upgrading Question: How do I get my menu customization from a previous release to work in the new release? Answer: In past releases this had to be done through a text editor, such as Notepad. With the CUI editor, you use the Transfer tab to browse and select your MNS/MNU or CUI file that contains your menu customization. Once the previous customization file has been selected, you drag the user interface elements between two CUI files. See To transfer customizations (page 74) for more information.

Commands Question: How do I create a new command and add it to a user interface element, such as a pull-down menu? Answer: Commands are created and managed through the Command List pane located in the lower-left corner of the Customize tab of the CUI editor. See To create a command (page 86) for more information. Once the command has been created, it can be added to or used to create a number of different user interface elements. To add the command to a pull-down menu for example, expand the menu under the Menus node in

Customize User Interface FAQs | 259

the Customizations In pane that you want to add the command to and then drag the command under the menu. See To create a pull-down menu (page 154) for more information.

Pull-down Menus Question: Why doesn’t my pull-down menu display on the menu bar? Answer: Workspaces are used to control the display of pull-down menus on the menu bar. See To display pull-down menus on the menu bar (page 245) for more information. Question: How do I change the order of a pull-down menu? Answer: Workspaces are used to control the positioning of pull-down menus on the menu bar. See To reposition pull-down menus on the menu bar (page 247) for more information.

Toolbars Question: Why do my toolbars not stay in the same place after I close and restart AutoCAD 2008? Answer: This happens because of the way menus are loaded into AutoCAD at startup. This problem only happens when partial and enterprise CUI files are used. To resolve this problem, you can use the new /w command line switch. This causes AutoCAD 2008 to re-initialize the workspace upon startup and place the toolbars in their correct locations. See To restore a workspace with a command line switch (page 256) for more information. Question: Why do my icons on a toolbar display as a cloud with a question mark after I migrate them using the Transfer tab in the CUI editor? Answer: This happens because the images for the custom icons are not located in the AutoCAD support file paths. Locate the images using Windows Explorer and add the images location to the Support File Search Path node under the Files tab of the Options dialog box, or copy them into the folder C:\Documents and Settings\\Application Data\Autodesk\\\\Support\Icons. Question: Why does my toolbar flyout not work? Answer: A flyout might not work for a few different reasons. There might not be any commands currently assigned to the toolbar that it is referencing or a control is part of the toolbar that is being referenced for the toolbar flyout. Launch the CUI editor and verify that there are commands on the toolbar

260 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

that is being referenced and if there are, make sure there are no controls on the toolbar such as the Layer list control. Question: Why do I get an AutoCAD message box when I try to use a toolbar flyout? Answer: The AutoCAD message box is displayed because the toolbar that is being referenced for the toolbar flyout is not found. AutoCAD can’t find the toolbar because it no longer exists, is not currently loaded because the partial CUI file it is in is not loaded, or the alias for the toolbar has been changed. Launch the CUI editor and select the flyout on the toolbar that currently is not working properly. In the Properties pane look at the Source Toolbar property. Use the Find option to look for a toolbar element with an alias that matches the text string in the Source Toolbar property of the flyout that does not work. If one is not located, remove the flyout from the toolbar and drag the toolbar that you want to reference as a flyout on the toolbar. Close the CUI editor. The flyout should now work correctly once again.

Double Click Actions Question: When I double-click an object nothing happens. Why is this happening? Answer: There are a few different reasons why when double-clicking on an object in the drawing nothing happens. The first and most common problem is with the system variable PICKFIRST is set to 0. PICKFIRST must be set to a value of 1 in order for double-click editing to work. The next possible solution is that double-click editing has been disabled. Double-click editing is controlled by the system variable DBLCLKEDIT. If it is set to 0 it is currently turned off. DBLCLKEDIT should be set to 1.

Workspaces Question: Why do my changes not appear after I click Apply? Answer: This happens because the workspace that you made changes to is not the current workspace. To resolve this problem, you need to set the workspace current and then when changes are applied they will appear. See To set a workspace current (page 255) for more information for more information.

Enterprise CUI Files Question: How do I edit an enterprise CUI file if it is read-only in the CUI editor?

Customize User Interface FAQs | 261

Answer: An enterprise CUI file can only be edited when it is loaded as the main CUI file or as a partial CUI file to the main CUI file. It is recommended that you load it as the main CUI file when you need to make edits. If you are creating a workspace that needs to include user interface elements from the CUI file that is normally designated as the main CUI file, load the main CUI file as the enterprise CUI file. Make edits to the enterprise CUI file. See To modify an enterprise CUI file (page 83) for more information.

Quick Reference Commands CUI Manages customized user interface elements such as workspaces, toolbars, menus, shortcut menus and keyboard shortcuts CUIEXPORT Exports customized settings from acad.cui to an enterprise or partial CUI file CUILOAD Loads a CUI file CUIUNLOAD Unloads a CUI file CUIUNLOAD Unloads a CUI file MENU Loads a customization file OPTIONS Customizes the program settings QUICKCUI Displays the Customize User Interface dialog box in a collapsed state WORKSPACE Creates, modifies, and saves workspaces and makes a workspace current

262 | Chapter 5 Customize the User Interface

System Variables ENTERPRISEMENU Displays the file name for the enterprise CUI (if defined), including the path for the file name MENUNAME Stores the customization file name, including the path for the file name WSCURRENT Returns the current workspace name in the command line interface and sets a workspace to current

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Customize User Interface FAQs | 263

264

6

DIESEL

You can use DIESEL (Direct Interpretively Evaluated String

In this chapter

Expression Language) to alter the AutoCAD® status line



Customize the Status Line



DIESEL Expressions in Macros



Catalog of DIESEL Functions



DIESEL Error Messages

through the MODEMACRO system variable. You can also use DIESEL in menu items as a macro language instead of AutoLISP®. DIESEL expressions accept strings and generate string results. Because DIESEL expressions handle strings exclusively, the USERS1-5 system variables are useful for passing information from an AutoLISP routine to a DIESEL expression. DIESEL expressions are evaluated by AutoLISP routines through the use of the AutoLISP menucmd function.

265

Customize the Status Line You can use the MODEMACRO system variable to display information on the status line.

Overview of the MODEMACRO System Variable The status line can provide the user with important information without interrupting the work flow. The MODEMACRO system variable controls the user-defined area on the status line. The calculated value of the MODEMACRO system variable is displayed in a left-aligned panel in the status bar at the bottom of the AutoCAD® window. This variable is set to the null string when you start AutoCAD. Its value is not saved in the drawing, the configuration file, or anywhere else. The number of characters displayed on the status line is limited only by the size of the AutoCAD window (and your monitor). The default panels move to the right as the content of the MODEMACRO panel grows. It is possible to push the default panels completely off the screen (if you want to). You can use the MODEMACRO system variable to display, in the status line, most data known to AutoCAD. With its calculation, decision, and editing facilities you can compose the status line to your precise specifications. MODEMACRO is a user-string variable. It can be set to any string value. The maximum string value is 4095 characters. You can set MODEMACRO with SETVAR or by entering modemacro at the Command prompt. If you modify the MODEMACRO setting, you can experiment with various status line formats; however, the maximum number of characters you can enter in this manner is 255. If you set MODEMACRO to the null string by entering a period (.), AutoCAD displays the standard status line.

Quick Reference Commands SETVAR Lists or changes the values of system variables

266 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

System Variables MODEMACRO Displays a text string on the status line, such as the name of the current drawing, time/date stamp, or special modes

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Set MODEMACRO Values You can use text strings and DIESEL to display messages in the user-defined section of the status line. The value of MODEMACRO determines what is displayed in the mode status line. The simplest (and least useful) MODEMACRO consists of constant text. For example, to display a company name in the status line, you enter the following: Command: modemacro New value for MODEMACRO, or . for none : Greg's Bank and Grill This MODEMACRO value always displays the same text; the status line does not reflect changes to the AutoCAD internal state. It doesn't change until you change MODEMACRO. To make the status line reflect the AutoCAD current state, enter macro expressions using the DIESEL language in the following format: $(somefun, arg1, arg2, ...)

In the macro expression, somefun is the name of the DIESEL function (similar to an AutoLISP function name) and arg1, arg2, and so on, are arguments to the function, interpreted according to the function's definition. Unlike AutoLISP, DIESEL macro expressions have only one data type: strings. Macros that operate on numbers express the numbers as strings and convert back and forth as required. For descriptions of the DIESEL functions, see Catalog of DIESEL Functions (page 276).

Set MODEMACRO Values | 267

Now define a more interesting status line (for example, one that shows the current text style name): Command: modemacro New value for MODEMACRO, or . for none : Style: $(getvar, textstyle) ■

Style: is a text string to be displayed on the status line.



$(getvar,textstyle) is a DIESEL function (getvar) and argument that retrieves the current value of the TEXTSTYLE system variable.

NOTE The examples in this topic may show the MODEMACRO string as more than one line of text. You enter it as one long string at the prompt. You can retrieve any system variable by entering $(getvar, varname). The current setting of the system variable replaces the macro expression on the status line. Then, when you switch text styles, for example, MODEMACRO is reevaluated. If it changes, the new text style name is displayed on the status line. Expressions can be nested, and they can be as complex as you want. The example that follows displays the current snap value and angle (in degrees) in the status line. It uses nested expressions to convert the snap angle from radians to degrees and truncates the value to an integer. Command: modemacro New value for MODEMACRO, or . for none : Snap: $(getvar, snapunit) $(fix,$(*,$(getvar,snapang),$(/,180,3.14159))) You can also display the values in the current linear and angular units modes. Command: modemacro New value for MODEMACRO, or . for none : Snap: $(rtos,$(index,0, $(getvar,snapunit))),$(rtos,$(index,1,$(getvar,snapunit))) $(angtos, $(getvar,snapang)) DIESEL copies its input directly to the output until it comes to the dollar sign character ($) or a quoted string. You can use quoted strings to suppress evaluation of character sequences that would otherwise be interpreted as DIESEL functions. You can include quotation marks in quoted strings by using two adjacent quotation marks. In the following example, the current layer is set to LAYOUT, and MODEMACRO is set to the string. Command: modemacro New value for MODEMACRO, or . for none : "$(getvar,clayer)= """$(getvar,clayer)"""" The status line displays the following:

268 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

$(getvar,clayer)="LAYOUT"

Quick Reference Commands SETVAR Lists or changes the values of system variables

System Variables MODEMACRO Displays a text string on the status line, such as the name of the current drawing, time/date stamp, or special modes

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Set MODEMACRO with AutoLISP Another way to set MODEMACRO values is to use AutoLISP. You can save the code samples shown here as ASCII format text files and load them with the AutoLISP load function. The following AutoLISP command defines a MODEMACRO string that provides similar information to that in the built-in status line. Because AutoLISP cannot continue strings from line to line, you use the AutoLISP strcat function to assemble the complete MODEMACRO string from shorter component strings.

Set MODEMACRO with AutoLISP | 269

(defun

C:ACADMODE ( ) (setvar "modemacro" (strcat "Layer $(substr,$(getvar,clayer),1,8)" "$(if,$(getvar,orthomode), Ortho)" "$(if,$(getvar,snapmode), Snap)" "$(if,$(getvar,tabmode), Tablet)" "$(if,$(=,$(getvar,tilemode),0)," "$(if,$(=,$(getvar,cvport),1), P)" ")" ) )

)

Save this AutoLISP routine in a file called acadmode.lsp. When you load the routine and execute it, it displays information on the status line. This is not the most useful application of this feature; it is provided only as an example. The following sample acad.lsp file uses the S::STARTUP function to set the MODEMACRO variable to a string defined by the AutoLISP file mode1.lsp. ;;; Sample acad.lsp file that uses S::STARTUP to load the ;;; file MODE1.LSP which defines a MODEMACRO string (defun S::STARTUP ( ) (load "mode1") (princ) ) ;;; Additional AutoLISP files can also be defined or ;;; loaded here

When the AutoLISP file (mode1.lsp) is loaded, it uses the MODEMACRO system variable to define a status line that displays L: followed by the first eight characters of the layer name, the drawing name and a portion of the path, and the first letter of each name of the currently active modes. The position of the drawing name remains constant, regardless of the length of the layer name.

270 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

;;; MODE1.LSP ;;; (setvar "modemacro" (strcat "L:$(substr,$(getvar,clayer),1,30)" "$(substr, ,1,$(-,30,$(strlen,$(getvar,clayer)))) " ;; ^^^^^^^^ Note the 8 spaces here ",$(strlen,$(getvar,dwgprefix)),29)," "$(-,$(strlen,$(getvar,dwgprefix)),29),1" ")," "$(strlen,$(getvar,dwgname))" ")" ")" ">" "$(if,$(getvar,orthomode), O, )" "$(if,$(getvar,snapmode), S, )" "$(if,$(getvar,tabmode), T, )" "$(if,$(and," "$(=,$(getvar,tilemode),0),$(=,$(getvar,cvport),1)),P)" ) )

Indenting code improves the readability of AutoLISP files and DIESEL strings.

Quick Reference Commands SETVAR Lists or changes the values of system variables

System Variables MODEMACRO Displays a text string on the status line, such as the name of the current drawing, time/date stamp, or special modes

Set MODEMACRO with AutoLISP | 271

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

DIESEL Expressions in Macros You can use DIESEL string expressions in customization (CUI) files as an additional method of creating macros. These expressions can return string values (text strings) in response to standard AutoCAD commands, AutoLISP and ObjectARX® routines, and other macros. They can also return string values to the menu itself, thereby altering the appearance or content of a menu label. This string provides a way to toggle between paper space and model space if TILEMODE is set to 0. This expression is evaluated transparently. If the special character ^P (which toggles MENUECHO on and off) is omitted, the expression displays only the issued command. A DIESEL expression that you use in a menu item must follow the $section=submenu format where the section name is M and the submenu is the DIESEL expression you want. Frequently, you can implement a macro more easily with AutoLISP. The following examples show two menu items that produce the same result; one uses DIESEL, and the other uses AutoLISP. This menu item uses the DIESEL expression: ^C^C^P$M=$(if,$(=,$(getvar,cvport),1),mspace,pspace)

This menu item uses the AutoLISP expression: ^C^C^P(if (= (getvar "cvport") 1)(command "mspace")+ (command "pspace"))(princ) ^P

Both menu items provide a way to switch between paper space and model space (if TILEMODE is set to 0), but the DIESEL expression is shorter and is evaluated transparently, not requiring the call to the AutoLISP princ function. If the special character ^P (which switches MENUECHO on and off) is omitted in both cases, the DIESEL expression displays only the issued command, whereas the AutoLISP expression displays the entire line of code.

272 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

Because the value returned by a DIESEL expression is a text string, it can be used in response to an AutoLISP getxxx function call. This functionality enables menu items to evaluate current drawing conditions and to return a value to an AutoLISP routine. The next example is based on these assumptions: ■

The AutoLISP routine is loaded into memory.



The CUI excerpt is included in the current customization file.



The symbols to insert are one unit high by one unit wide.



The DIMSCALE variable is set to the drawing's scale factor (that is, a drawing to be plotted at a scale of 1" = 10' would have a scale factor of 120, or a 1/4" = 1' scale drawing would have a scale factor of 48).

If you load and execute the sample AutoLISP routine, AutoCAD inserts the symbol at the size and location you have specified. When plotted, the symbols are the specified size (if the drawing is plotted at the same scale as that specified by DIMSCALE). The following is a sample AutoLISP routine. (defun C:SYMIN ( ) (setq sym (getstring "\nEnter symbol name: ") ; Prompts for a symbol name ) (menucmd "s=symsize") ; Switches the screen menu ; to the symsize submenu (setq siz (getreal "\nSelect symbol size: ") ; Prompts for a symbol size p1 (getpoint "\nInsertion point: ") ; Prompts for insertion point ) (command "insert" ; Issues the INSERT command sym ; using the desired symbol p1 siz siz 0) ; insertion point, and size (menucmd "s=") ; Switches to the previous ; screen menu (princ) ; Exits quietly )

DIESEL Expressions in Macros | 273

NOTE An AutoLISP routine that you use regularly should include error checking to verify the validity of user input. The DIESEL expressions in the following example multiply the current value of DIMSCALE by the specified value, and return an appropriate scale factor. This cannot be done with similar AutoLISP code; a value returned by an AutoLISP expression cannot typically be used as a response to a getxxx function call (such as, the getreal function in the preceding sample). $M=$(*,$(getvar,dimscale),0.375) $M=$(*,$(getvar,dimscale),0.5) $M=$(*,$(getvar,dimscale),0.625)

DIESEL expressions can also return string values to pull-down menu item labels, so that you can make menus unavailable or otherwise alter the way they are displayed. To use a DIESEL expression in a pull-down menu label, make sure that the first character is the $ character. In the next example, the current layer is set to BASE and the following DIESEL expression is used as the label. $(eval,"Current layer: " $(getvar,clayer))

The result is that the appropriate pull-down menu is displayed and updated whenever the current layer changes. Current Layer: BASE You can also use this method to interactively change the text displayed in a pull-down menu. You use an AutoLISP routine that sets the USERS1-5 system variables to the selected text, which can be retrieved by a DIESEL macro in a menu label. NOTE The width of pull-down and shortcut menus is determined when the customization file is being loaded. Menu labels generated or changed by DIESEL expressions after a menu is loaded are truncated to fit within the existing menu width. If you anticipate that a DIESEL-generated menu label will be too wide, you can use the following example to ensure that the menu width will accommodate your labels. This example displays the first 10 characters of the current value of the USERS3 (USERS1-5) system variable. $(eval,"Current value: " $(getvar,users3))+ $(if, $(eq,$(getvar,users3),""), 10 spaces )^C^Cusers3

274 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

You cannot use trailing spaces in a menu label to increase the menu width, because trailing spaces are ignored while the menu is being loaded. Any spaces you use to increase the width of a menu label must be within a DIESEL expression. The next example uses the same DIESEL expression as the label and a portion of the menu item. It provides a practical way to enter the current day and date into a drawing. $(edtime,$(getvar,date),DDD", "D MON YYYY)^C^Ctext + \\\ $M=$(edtime,$(getvar,date),DDD", "D MON YYYY);

Also, you can use a DIESEL macro to mark pull-down menu labels or make them unavailable. The following pull-down menu label displays an unavailable ERASE while a command is active. The text is displayed normally when a command is not active. $(if,$(getvar,cmdactive),~)ERASE

You can use a similar approach to place a mark beside a pull-down menu item or to interactively change the character used for the mark.

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables CLIPBOARD Indicates the status of the Clipboard MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits USERNAME Specifies the user name

DIESEL Expressions in Macros | 275

USERS1-5

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Catalog of DIESEL Functions Status retrieval, computation, and display are performed by DIESEL functions. All functions have a limit of 10 parameters, including the function name itself. If this limit is exceeded, you get a DIESEL error message.

+ (addition) Returns the sum of the numbers val1, val2, …, val9. $(+, val1 [, val2, …, val9])

If the current thickness is set to 5, the following DIESEL string returns 15. $(+, $(getvar,thickness),10)

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

276 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

- (subtraction) Returns the result of subtracting the numbers val2 through val9 from val1. $(-, val1 [, val2 , …, val9])

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

* (multiplication) Returns the result of multiplying the numbers val1, val2, …, val9. $(*, val1 [, val2, …, val9])

- (subtraction) | 277

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

/ (division) Returns the result of dividing the number val1 by val2, …, val9. $(/, val1 [, val2, …, val9])

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

278 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

= (equal to) If the numbers val1 and val2 are equal, the string returns 1; otherwise, it returns 0. $(=, val1, val2)

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

< (less than) If the number val1 is less than val2, the string returns 1; otherwise, it returns 0. $(< , val1, val2)

= (equal to) | 279

The following expression gets the current value of HPANG; if the value is less than the value stored in the system variable USERR1, it returns 1. If the value 10.0 is stored in USERR1 and the current setting of HPANG is 15.5, the following string returns 0. $( (greater than) If the number val1 is greater than val2, the string returns 1; otherwise, it returns 0. $(>, val1, val2)

280 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

!= (not equal to) If the numbers val1 and val2 are not equal, the string returns 1; otherwise, it returns 0. $(!=, val1, val2)

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

!= (not equal to) | 281

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

=, val1, val2)

282 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

and Returns the bitwise logical AND of the integers val1 through val9. $(and, val1 [, val2,…, val9])

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

and | 283

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

angtos Returns the angular value in the format and precision specified. $(angtos, value [, mode, precision])

Edits the given value as an angle in the format specified by the mode and precision as defined for the analogous AutoLISPfunction. (The values for mode are shown in the following table.) If mode and precision are omitted, it uses the current values chosen by the UNITS command. Angular units values Mode value

String format

0

Degrees

1

Degrees/minutes/seconds

2

Grads

3

Radians

4

Surveyor's units

284 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

edtime Returns a formatted date and time based on a given picture. $(edtime, time, picture)

Edits the AutoCAD Julian date given by time (obtained, for example, from $(getvar,date) according to the given picture). The picture consists of format phrases replaced by specific representations of the date and time. Characters not interpretable as format phrases are copied literally into the result of $(edtime). Format phrases are defined as shown in the following table. Assume that the date and time are Saturday, 5 September 1998 4:53:17.506. edtime format phrases Format

Output

Format

Output

D

5

H

4

DD

05

HH

04

edtime | 285

edtime format phrases Format

Output

Format

Output

DDD

Sat

MM

53

DDDD

Saturday

SS

17

M

9

MSEC

506

MO

09

AM/PM

AM

MON

Sep

am/pm

am

MONTH

September

A/P

A

YY

98

a/p

a

YYYY

1998

Enter the entire AM/PM phrase as shown in the preceding table; if AM is used alone, the A will be read literally and the M will return the current month. If any AM/PM phrases appear in the picture, the H and HH phrases edit the time according to the 12-hour civil clock (12:00-12:59 1:00-11:59) instead of the 24-hour clock (00:00-23:59). The following example uses the date and time from the preceding table. Notice that the comma must be enclosed in quotation marks because it is read as an argument separator. $(edtime, $(getvar,date),DDD"," DD MON YYYY - H:MMam/pm)

It returns the following: Sat, 5 Sep 1998 - 4:53am If time is 0, the time and date at the moment that the outermost macro was executed is used. This avoids lengthy and time-consuming multiple calls on $(getvar,date) and guarantees that strings composed with multiple $(edtime) macros all use the same time.

286 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

eq If the strings val1 and val2 are identical, the string returns 1; otherwise, it returns 0. $(eq, val1, val2)

The following expression gets the name of the current layer; if the name matches the string value stored in the USERS1 (USERS1-5) system variable, it returns 1. Assume the string "PART12" is stored in USERS1 and the current layer is the same. $(eq, $(getvar,users1),$(getvar,clayer))Returns 1

eq | 287

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

eval Passes the string str to the DIESEL evaluator and returns the result of evaluating it. $(eval, str)

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

288 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

fix Truncates the real number value to an integer by discarding any fractional part. $(fix, value)

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

getenv Returns the value of the environment variable varname. $(getenv, varname)

If no variable with that name is defined, it returns the null string.

fix | 289

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

getvar Returns the value of the system variable with the given varname. $(getvar, varname)

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

290 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

if Conditionally evaluates expressions. $(if, expr, dotrue [, dofalse])

If expr is nonzero, it evaluates and returns dotrue. Otherwise, it evaluates and returns dofalse. Note that the branch not chosen by expr is not evaluated.

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

index Returns the specified member of a comma-delimited string. $(index, which, string)

if | 291

Assumes that the string argument contains one or more values delimited by the macro argument separator character, the comma. The which argument selects one of these values to be extracted, with the first item numbered 0. This function is most frequently used to extract X, Y, or Z coordinate values from point coordinates returned by $(getvar). Applications can use this function to retrieve values stored as comma-delimited strings from the USERS1-5 system variables.

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

nth Evaluates and returns the argument selected by which. $(nth, which, arg0 [, arg1,…, arg7])

If which is 0, nth returns arg0, and so on. Note the difference between $(nth) and $(index); $(nth)returns one of a series of arguments to the function, while $(index) extracts a value from a comma-delimited string passed as a single argument. Arguments not selected by which are not evaluated.

292 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

or Returns the bitwise logical OR of the integers val1 through val9. $(or, val1 [, val2,…, val9])

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

or | 293

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

rtos Returns the real value in the format and precision specified. $(rtos, value [, mode, precision])

Edits the given value as a real number in the format specified by the mode and precision as defined by the analogous AutoLISP function. If mode and precision are omitted, it uses the current values selected with the UNITS command. Edits the given value as a real number in the format specified by mode and precision. If mode and precision are omitted, it uses the current values selected with the UNITS command.

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

294 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

strlen Returns the length of string in characters. $(strlen, string)

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

substr Returns the substring of string, starting at character start and extending for length characters. $(substr, string, start [, length])

strlen | 295

Characters in the string are numbered from 1. If length is omitted, it returns the entire remaining length of the string.

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

upper Returns the string converted to uppercase according to the rules of the current locale. $(upper, string)

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

296 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

xor Returns the bitwise logical XOR of the integers val1 through val9. $(xor, val1 [, val2,…, val9])

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

xor | 297

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

DIESEL Error Messages Generally, if you make a mistake in a DIESEL expression, what went wrong will be obvious. Depending on the nature of the error, DIESEL embeds an error indication in the output stream. DIESEL error messages Error message

Description

$?

Syntax error (usually a missing right parenthesis or a runaway string)

$(func,??)

Incorrect arguments to func

$(func)??

Unknown function func

$(++)

Output string too long—evaluation truncated

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables MENUECHO Sets menu echo and prompt control bits

298 | Chapter 6 DIESEL

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

DIESEL Error Messages | 299

300

7

Slides and Command Scripts

Slides are snapshots of drawing files that can be used for giving

In this chapter

presentations, for creating image tile menus, and for viewing



Create Slides



Create Command Scripts

another drawing while you work. A script reads and executes commands from a text file. You can run a script when you start AutoCAD®, or you can run a script from within AutoCAD using the SCRIPT command. A script provides an easy way to create continuously running displays for product demonstrations and trade shows.

301

Create Slides Slides are snapshots of drawing files. You can use slides for giving presentations, creating custom image tile menus, and viewing an image of another drawing while you work.

Overview of Slides A slide is a snapshot of a drawing. Although it contains a picture of the drawing at a given instant, it is not a drawing file. You cannot import a slide file into the current drawing, nor can you edit or print a slide. You can only view it. You can use slide files in the following ways: ■

For making presentations within AutoCAD®



For viewing a snapshot of a drawing while working on a different drawing



For creating menus of image tiles within a dialog box

You create a slide by saving the current view in slide format. A slide created in model space shows only the current viewport. A slide created in paper space shows all visible viewports and their contents. Slides show only what was visible. They do not show objects on layers that were turned off or frozen or objects in viewports that were turned off. When you view a slide file, it temporarily replaces objects on the screen. You can draw on top of it, but when you change the view (by redrawing, panning, or zooming), the slide file disappears, and AutoCAD redisplays only what you drew and any preexisting objects. You can display slides one by one or use a script to display slides in sequence. Slides also can be used in custom menus. For example, if you create scripts that insert blocks containing mechanical parts you use frequently, you can design a custom image tile menu that displays a slide of each part. When you click the slide image on the menu, AutoCAD inserts the block into the drawing. A slide library is a file containing one or more slides. Slide library files are used for creating custom image tile menus and for combining several slide files for convenient file management. You cannot edit a slide. You must change the original drawing and remake the slide. If you use a low-resolution graphics monitor when creating a slide

302 | Chapter 7 Slides and Command Scripts

file and later upgrade to a high-resolution monitor, you can still view the slide. AutoCAD adjusts the image accordingly; however, the slide does not take full advantage of the new monitor until you remake the slide file from the original drawing. To make a slide 1 Display the view you want to use for the slide. 2 At the Command prompt, enter mslide. 3 In the Create Slide File dialog box, enter a name and select a location for the slide. AutoCAD offers the current name of the drawing as a default name for the slide and automatically appends the .sld file extension. 4 Click Save. The current drawing remains on the screen, and the slide file is saved in the folder that you specified.

Quick Reference Commands MSLIDE Creates a slide file of the current model viewport or the current layout REDRAW Refreshes the display in the current viewport VSLIDE Displays an image slide file in the current viewport

System Variables FILEDIA Suppresses display of file navigation dialog boxes

Overview of Slides | 303

Utilities SLIDELIB Compiles slide files listed in an ASCII file into a slide library file

Command Modifiers No entries

View Slides You can view slides individually using VSLIDE. To view a series of slides for a presentation, use a script file. Be careful about using editing commands while you view a slide, which looks like an ordinary drawing. Editing commands affect the current drawing underneath the slide but not the slide itself. Some commands may force redrawing, which removes the slide from display. To view a slide 1 At the Command prompt, enter vslide. 2 In the Select Slide File dialog box, select a slide to view and click OK. The slide image is displayed in the drawing area. 3 Click View menu ➤ Redraw.At the Command prompt, enter redrawall. The slide image disappears.

Quick Reference Commands REDRAW Refreshes the display in the current viewport VSLIDE Displays an image slide file in the current viewport

304 | Chapter 7 Slides and Command Scripts

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Create and View Slide Libraries A slide library is a file containing one or more slides. Slide library files are used for creating custom image tile menus and for combining several slide files for convenient file management. You can create slide libraries from slide files using the SLIDELIB utility. After you have set up a slide library, you can view slides by specifying the name of the slide library and the slide. Do not delete the original slides after creating the slide library. The SLIDELIB utility cannot update a slide library once it is created. If you want to add or delete a slide, update the slide list file and remake the library with SLIDELIB. When you remake the slide library, all the slide files that you intend to include must be available. To create a slide library 1 Use a Windows ASCII text editor to create a list of slide files to include in the library. The file would look similar to this example: entrance.sld hall.sld stairs.sld study.sld balcony.sld

2 Name and save the file as a text file with a .txt file extension. 3 Click Start menu (Windows) ➤ All Programs (or Programs) ➤ Accessories ➤ Command Prompt.

Create and View Slide Libraries | 305

4 In the Command Prompt window, at the prompt, enter CD to change folders. As an example: CD “c:\slides” 5 At the prompt, enter the following syntax to create the slide library: slidelib libraryname < list.txt

For example, if you named your text file areas.txt, you could create a library called house.slb by entering slidelib house < areas.txt. The SLIDELIB utility appends the file extension .slb to the slide library file. To view a slide in a slide library 1 At the Command prompt, enter filedia. 2 Enter 0 and press ENTER. 3 At the Command prompt, enter vslide. 4 Enter library(slidename) to specify the slide. For example, enter house (balcony) to open the balcony slide, which is stored in the house slide library file. 5 To remove the slide from the display, click View menu ➤ Redraw.To remove the slide from the display, at the Command prompt, enter redrawall.

Quick Reference Commands MSLIDE Creates a slide file of the current model viewport or the current layout REDRAW Refreshes the display in the current viewport VSLIDE Displays an image slide file in the current viewport

306 | Chapter 7 Slides and Command Scripts

System Variables No entries

Utilities SLIDELIB Compiles slide files listed in an ASCII file into a slide library file

Command Modifiers No entries

Create Command Scripts A script is a text file that contains a series of commands. Common uses for scripts are to customize startup and to run slide shows.

Overview of Command Scripts A script is a text file with one command on each line. You can invoke a script at startup, or you can run a script during a work session by using the SCRIPT command. A script also provides an easy way to create continuously running displays for product demonstrations and trade shows. The BACKGROUNDPLOT system variable must be set to 0 before a script can plot multiple jobs. You create script files outside the program using a text editor (such as Microsoft® Windows® Notepad) or a word processor (such as Microsoft Word) that can save the file in ASCII format. The file extension must be .scr. Each line of the script file contains a command. Each blank space in a script file is significant because SPACEBAR is accepted as a command or data field terminator. You must be very familiar with the sequence of prompts to provide an appropriate sequence of responses in the script file. NOTE Keep in mind that prompts and command names may change in future releases, so you may need to revise your scripts when you upgrade to a later version of this program. For similar reasons, avoid the use of abbreviations; future command additions might create ambiguities.

Create Command Scripts | 307

A script can execute any command at the command prompt except a command that displays a dialog box. In most cases, a command that displays a dialog box has an alternative version of the command that displays command prompts instead of a dialog box. Script files can contain comments. Any line that begins with a semicolon (;) is considered a comment, and it is ignored while the script file is being processed. The last line of the file must be blank. All references to long file names that contain embedded spaces must be enclosed in double quotes. For example, to open the drawing my house.dwg from a script, you must use the following syntax: open "my house"

The following commands are useful in scripts: 'DELAY Provides a timed pause within a script (in milliseconds) 'GRAPHSCR Switches from the text window to the drawing area RESUME Continues an interrupted script RSCRIPT Repeats a script file 'TEXTSCR Switches to the text window When command input comes from a script, it is assumed that the settings of the PICKADD and PICKAUTO system variables are 1 and 0, respectively; therefore, you do not have to check the settings of these variables. A script is treated as a group, a unit of commands, reversible by a single U command. However, each command in the script causes an entry in the undo log, which can slow script processing. If you like, you can use UNDO Control None to turn off the undo feature before running the script, or you can write it at the beginning of the script itself. Remember to turn it back on (UNDO Control All) when the script is finished. The script that is running stops when another script command is invoked. This script turns on the grid, sets the global linetype scale to 3.0, and sets layer 0 as the current layer with red as the color. To create a script that changes settings in a drawing 1 In a text editor, enter grid on. 2 On the next line, enter ltscale 3.0. 3 On the next line, enter layer set 0 color red 0.

308 | Chapter 7 Slides and Command Scripts

4 Add a blank line. 5 Save the file as ASCII text (TXT file), with a file extension of .scr. The script file may contain comments, as follows: ; Turn grid on grid on ; Set scale for linetypes ltscale 3.0 ; Set current layer and its color layer set 0 color red 0 ; Blank line above to end LAYER command

Quick Reference Commands DELAY Provides a timed pause within a script GRAPHSCR Switches from the text window to the drawing area RESUME Continues an interrupted script RSCRIPT Repeats a script file SCRIPT Executes a sequence of commands from a script file TEXTSCR Opens the text window VSLIDE Displays an image slide file in the current viewport

Overview of Command Scripts | 309

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Run Scripts at Startup A script that runs at startup can open a drawing and change its settings. Suppose that every time you begin a new drawing, you turn on the grid, set the global linetype scale to 3.0, and set layer 0 as your current layer, with red as the color. You can do this using a drawing template, but you could do it instead with the following script and store it in a text file called setup.scr. grid on ltscale 3.0 layer set 0 color red 0

The first line turns on the grid. The second line sets the global scale for linetypes. The third line sets the current layer to layer 0 and sets its default color to red. AutoCAD assumes that in a script you want to use the version of LAYER command that displays command prompts rather than the dialog box version. The result is equivalent to entering -layer at the command prompt. The fourth line is blank, ending LAYER. NOTE VBA and AutoLISP® scripts that run at startup should check for whether the AutoCAD process is visible or invisible. If the process is invisible, the script should not execute, because the process may be performing background plotting or publishing operations. To check for whether the AutoCAD process is visible or invisible, you can use the Visible property of the Application object in the AutoCAD Object Model. You could run a script at startup to open a drawing by using the following syntax in the Run dialog box: ACAD drawing_name /b setup

310 | Chapter 7 Slides and Command Scripts

All file names that contain embedded spaces must be enclosed in double quotes, for example, “guest house”. You can also specify the view that is displayed when the drawing opens by using the /v switch and the view name. The /b switch and the script file must be the last parameter listed. Including the file extensions .exe, .dwg, .dwt, and .scr is optional. If AutoCAD cannot find the script file, AutoCAD reports that it cannot open the file. To run the same script at startup but create a new drawing using the MyTemplate.dwt file as the template, enter the following in the Run dialog box: ACAD /t MyTemplate /b setup

This command creates a new drawing and issues a sequence of setup commands from the setup.scr file. When the script has finished running, the Command prompt is displayed. If you want to use the default template for the new drawing, you can omit the /t switch and the template file name. NOTE You can no longer use this method to start a new drawing and give it a name. Name the drawing when you save it. To run a script at startup 1 Click Start menu (Windows) ➤ Run. 2 In the Run dialog box, enter acad drawing_name /b script_name. To start a new file, instead of a drawing file name, enter the /t switch and the name of a template file: /t template_drawing. To open a drawing file to a particular view, follow the drawing name with the /v switch and the name of the view: /v view_name. The name of the script file must be the last parameter listed. The file extensions are optional. 3 Click OK. AutoCAD opens the drawing and executes the commands in the script file. When the script has been completed, the Command prompt is displayed.

Run Scripts at Startup | 311

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Run Slide Shows from Scripts Scripts are useful for creating slide shows. Scripts are useful for creating slide shows. Ordinarily, the speed with which you can display slides is limited by the number of times AutoCAD must access the disk to read the slide file. You can, however, preload the next slide from disk into memory while your audience is viewing the current slide and then quickly display the new slide from memory. To preload a slide, place an asterisk before the file name in VSLIDE. The next VSLIDE command detects that a slide has been preloaded and displays it without asking for a file name. The disk-access time to load the next slide overlaps with the viewing time for the current slide. You can specify additional delays with the DELAY command. Each delay unit is equal to one millisecond. To stop a repeating script press ESC. You can resume the script with RESUME. If the script will run for a long time, it is recommended that you use UNDO Control None to turn off the Undo log file.

312 | Chapter 7 Slides and Command Scripts

To run slide shows from scripts 1 Create the slide library file as described in To create a slide library (page 305). 2 Create a script file using an ASCII text editor, as shown in To create a script that preloads slides (page 313). 3 At the command prompt, enter script. 4 In the Select Script File dialog box, select a script file and click Open. To create a script that preloads slides In this example of a script that displays three slides (files slide1.sld, slide2.sld, and slide3.sld), the time it takes to access the disk drive and load the next slide into memory overlaps with the viewing time for the current slide. 1 On the first line of the script, enter vslide slide1. The first line begins the slide show and loads slide1. 2 On the second line, enter vslide *slide2. The asterisk (*) preceding the slide name on the second line preloads slide2. 3 On the third line, enter delay 2000. The third line specifies a delay of 2000 milliseconds to allow the audience to view slide1. 4 On the fourth line, enter vslide. On the fifth line, enter vslide *slide3. On the sixth line, enter delay 2000. The fourth, fifth, and sixth lines display slide2, preload slide3, and specify a delay for viewing slide2. 5 On the seventh line, enter vslide. On the eighth line, enter delay 3000. The seventh and eighth lines display slide3 and specify a delay for viewing slide3. 6 On the last line, enter rscript to repeat the script. 7 To stop a repeating script press ESC. To continue the script, enter resume. The script may contain comments, as follows:

Run Slide Shows from Scripts | 313

; Begin slide show, VSLIDE SLIDE1 ; Preload SLIDE2 VSLIDE *SLIDE2 ; Let audience view DELAY 2000 ; Display SLIDE2 VSLIDE ; Preload SLIDE3 VSLIDE *SLIDE3 ; Let audience view DELAY 2000 ; Display SLIDE3 VSLIDE ; Let audience view DELAY 3000 ; Cycle RSCRIPT

load SLIDE1

SLIDE1

SLIDE2

SLIDE3

Quick Reference Commands DELAY Provides a timed pause within a script GRAPHSCR Switches from the text window to the drawing area RESUME Continues an interrupted script RSCRIPT Repeats a script file SCRIPT Executes a sequence of commands from a script file TEXTSCR Opens the text window

314 | Chapter 7 Slides and Command Scripts

VSLIDE Displays an image slide file in the current viewport

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Run Slide Shows from Scripts | 315

316

8

Introduction to Programming Interfaces

The programming interfaces introduced here are ActiveX®

In this chapter

Automation, VBA (Visual Basic® for Applications), AutoLISP®,



ActiveX Automation

Visual LISP™ , ObjectARX™ , and .NET. The type of interface



AutoCAD VBA



AutoLISP and Visual LISP

you use depends on your application needs and programming



ObjectARX

experience.



.NET

317

ActiveX Automation ActiveX Automation is a technology developed by Microsoft® and is based on the COM (component object model) architecture. You can use it to customize AutoCAD, share your drawing data with other applications, and automate tasks.

Overview of ActiveX You can create and manipulate AutoCAD objects from any application that serves as an Automation controller. Thus, Automation enables macro programming across applications, a capability that does not exist in AutoLISP. Through Automation, AutoCAD exposes programmable objects, described by the AutoCAD Object Model, that can be created, edited, and manipulated by other applications. Any application that can access the AutoCAD Object Model is an Automation controller, and the most common tool used for manipulating another application using Automation is Visual Basic for Applications (VBA). VBA is found as a component in many Microsoft Office applications. You can use these applications, or other Automation controllers, such as Visual Basic, .NET, and Delphi, to drive AutoCAD. The advantage of implementing an ActiveX interface for AutoCAD is twofold: ■

Programmatic access to AutoCAD drawings is opened up to many more programming environments. Before ActiveX Automation, developers were limited to an AutoLISP or C++ interface.



Sharing data with other Windows applications, such as Microsoft Excel and Microsoft Word, is made dramatically easier.

For detailed information about using VBA to control AutoCAD ActiveX Automation, see the ActiveX and VBA Developer's Guide and ActiveX and VBA Reference in the Help system. To display Developer Help, click Help menu ➤ Additional Resources ➤ Developer Help. For example, you might want to prompt for input, set preferences, make a selection set, or retrieve drawing data. You can decide on the controller to use, depending on the type of manipulation. Using Automation, you can create and manipulate AutoCAD objects from any application that serves as an Automation controller. Thus, Automation enables macro programming across applications, a capability that does not exist in

318 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

AutoLISP. With Automation you can combine the features of many applications into a single application. The displayed objects are called Automation objects. Automation objects make methods, properties, and events available. Methods are functions that perform an action on an object. Properties are functions that set or return information about the state of an object. Events are user-initiated actions or occurrences to which a program responds. Virtually any type of application can access the displayed Automation objects within AutoCAD. These applications can be stand-alone executables, dynamic linked library (DLL) files, and macros within applications such as Microsoft Word or Microsoft Excel. The most common of these is most likely the stand-alone executable. If you are using applications from application developers, follow their instructions for installation and use of their product. See also: ■

ActiveX and VBA Developer's Guide



ActiveX and VBA Reference

Quick Reference Commands NETLOAD Loads a .NET application

Overview of ActiveX | 319

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Define a Command to Start Your Application You can use the acad.pgp file to define a new AutoCAD command that runs an external command to start your application. You can use the acad.pgp file to define a new AutoCAD command that runs an external command to start your application. The following example defines the RUNAPP1 command, which runs the application app1.exe in the c:\vbapps\ directory. (Add this code to the external commands section of your acad.pgp file.) RUNAPP1, start c:\vbapps\app1, 0

If your application requires command line parameters, you can use the following code: RUNAPP2, start c:\vbapps\app2, 0, *Parameters: ,

This example defines the RUNAPP2 command, which prompts you for parameters and then passes them to your application. You can also use the AutoLISP startapp function to start an application that makes use of Automation. Once AutoLISP starts the external application, it has no control over its actions. You can, however, use AutoLISP to locate and run different applications based on certain parameters.

320 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Start an Application from a Menu or Toolbar After defining a new command to start your application, you can make that command available from a menu or toolbar. The macro can be called from an interface element in the customization (CUI) file. If you use only one or two applications, you can add them to one of the standard pull-down menus. If you have a group of applications, you can add your own pull-down menu or toolbar that is specifically dedicated to those applications. For information about creating, editing, and loading customization files, see Customize the User Interface (page 47).

Quick Reference Commands MENULOAD Obsolete

Start an Application from a Menu or Toolbar | 321

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

AutoCAD VBA Microsoft Visual Basic for Applications (VBA) is an object-based programming environment designed to provide rich development capabilities. The main difference between VBA and VB (Visual Basic 6) is that VBA runs in the same process space as AutoCAD, providing an AutoCAD-intelligent and very fast programming environment.

Overview of AutoCAD VBA VBA provides application integration with other VBA-enabled applications. This means that AutoCAD, using other application object libraries, can be an Automation controller for other applications such as Microsoft Word or Excel. The stand-alone development editions of Visual Basic 6, which must be purchased separately, complement AutoCAD VBA with additional components such as an external database engine and report-writing capabilities.

Develop with AutoCAD VBA VBA sends messages to AutoCAD by the AutoCAD ActiveX Automation Interface. AutoCAD VBA permits the Visual Basic environment to run simultaneously with AutoCAD and provides programmatic control of AutoCAD through the ActiveX Automation Interface. This linking of AutoCAD, ActiveX Automation, and VBA provides an extremely powerful interface. It not only controls AutoCAD objects, but it also sends data to or retrieves data from other applications.

322 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

The integration of VBA into AutoCAD provides an easy-to-use visual tool for customizing AutoCAD. For example, you can create an application that extracts attribute information automatically, inserts the results directly into an Excel spreadsheet, and performs any data transformations you need. Three fundamental elements define VBA programming in AutoCAD. The first is AutoCAD itself, which has a rich set of objects that include AutoCAD entities, data, and commands. AutoCAD is an open-architecture application with multiple levels of interface. To use VBA effectively, familiarity with AutoCAD programmability is highly desirable. However, you will find that the VBA object-based approach is quite different from that of AutoLISP. The second element is the AutoCAD ActiveX Automation Interface, which establishes messages (communication) with AutoCAD objects. Programming in VBA requires a fundamental understanding of ActiveX Automation. A description of the AutoCAD ActiveX Automation Interface can be found in the ActiveX and VBA Developer's Guide in the Help system. To display Developer Help, click Help menu ➤ Additional Resources ➤ Developer Help. The third element that defines VBA programming is VBA itself. It has its own set of objects, keywords, constants, and so forth, that provide program flow, control, debugging, and execution. The Microsoft extensive Help system for VBA is included with AutoCAD VBA. The AutoCAD ActiveX/VBA interface provides several advantages over other AutoCAD API environments: ■

Speed. Running in-process with VBA, ActiveX applications are faster than AutoLISP applications.



Ease of use. The programming language and development environment are easy-to-use and come installed with AutoCAD.



Windows interoperability. ActiveX and VBA are designed to be used with other Windows applications and provide an excellent path for communication of information across applications.



Rapid prototyping. The rapid interface development of VBA provides the perfect environment for prototyping applications, even if those applications will be developed eventually in another language.



Programmer base. Programmers already use Visual Basic 6. AutoCAD ActiveX/VBA opens up AutoCAD customization and application development to these programmers as well as those who will learn Visual Basic 6 in the future.

Overview of AutoCAD VBA | 323

Quick Reference Commands VBAIDE Displays the Visual Basic Editor VBALOAD Loads a global VBA project into the current work session VBAMAN Loads, unloads, saves, creates, embeds, and extracts VBA projects VBARUN Runs a VBA macro VBASTMT Executes a VBA statement on the AutoCAD command line VBAUNLOAD Unloads a global VBA project

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Use AutoCAD VBA Applications You load a VBA project with the VBALOAD command. Once loaded, its modules and macros are available in the Macros dialog box. Although Microsoft applications store VBA projects, macros, and programs inside a specific document, AutoCAD uses a separate file with the .dvb extension. In this way, VBA interfaces with AutoCAD in much the same way

324 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

that AutoLISP and ObjectARX do. Because VBA projects are stored in a separate file, a VBA project can open and close different AutoCAD drawings during an AutoCAD session. NOTE AutoCAD VBA projects are not binary compatible with stand-alone Visual Basic 6 projects (VBP files). However, forms, modules, and classes can be exchanged between dissimilar projects using the IMPORT and EXPORT VBA commands in the VBA integrated development environment (IDE). You load a VBA project with the VBALOAD command. Once loaded, its modules and macros are available in the Macros dialog box. To run the VBA module you use the VBARUN command. If no VBA project is loaded, the options are unavailable. Procedures listed in the Macro Name box use the following syntax: module.macro In the Macros dialog box you choose the Macro Scope and select from the listed modules.

Use the Command Prompt to Run a VBA Macro The -VBARUN command can be used to run a macro from the command prompt. This allows you to run VBA macros from the command prompt, scripts, and other AutoCAD programming environments. The only argument for the command is the module name using the module.macro syntax. The syntax looks like this: -vbarun

Because macros with the same name can be duplicated in modules, the module.macro syntax differentiates the macro and allows for unique selection.

Quick Reference Commands VBAIDE Displays the Visual Basic Editor VBALOAD Loads a global VBA project into the current work session

Use AutoCAD VBA Applications | 325

VBAMAN Loads, unloads, saves, creates, embeds, and extracts VBA projects VBARUN Runs a VBA macro VBASTMT Executes a VBA statement on the AutoCAD command line VBAUNLOAD Unloads a global VBA project

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Automatically Load and Execute VBA Projects You can load VBA projects automatically each time you run AutoCAD. As you build up a number of VBA projects, you can load them automatically each time you run AutoCAD. The macros they contain are immediately available. Additionally, the APPLOAD command provides a Startup Suite option that automatically loads the specified applications.

acvba.arx — Automatically Load VBA You cannot load VBA until an AutoCAD VBA command is issued. If you want to load VBA automatically every time you start AutoCAD include the following line in the acad.rx file: acvba.arx

326 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

You can automatically run a macro in the acad.dvb file by naming the macro AcadStartup. Any macro in your acad.dvb file called AcadStartup automatically executes when VBA loads.

acad.dvb — Automatically Load a VBA Project The acad.dvb file is useful if you want to load a specific VBA project that contains macros you want each time you start AutoCAD. Each time you start a new AutoCAD drawing session, AutoCAD searches for the acad.dvb file and loads it. If you want a macro in your acad.dvb file to run each time you start a new drawing or open an existing one, add the following code to your acaddoc.lsp file: (defun S::STARTUP() (command "_-vbarun" "updatetitleblock") )

The project name in the example is updatetitleblock.

Quick Reference Commands APPLOAD Loads and unloads applications and defines which applications to load at startup VBAIDE Displays the Visual Basic Editor VBALOAD Loads a global VBA project into the current work session VBAMAN Loads, unloads, saves, creates, embeds, and extracts VBA projects VBARUN Runs a VBA macro VBASTMT Executes a VBA statement on the AutoCAD command line

Automatically Load and Execute VBA Projects | 327

VBAUNLOAD Unloads a global VBA project

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

AutoLISP and Visual LISP AutoLISP is based on the LISP programming language, which is simple to learn and very powerful. Because AutoCAD has a built-in LISP interpreter, you can enter AutoLISP code at the command prompt or load AutoLISP code from external files. Visual LISP (VLISP) is a software tool designed to expedite AutoLISP program development.

Overview of AutoLISP and Visual LISP AutoLISP has been enhanced with Visual LISP (VLISP), which offers an integrated development environment (IDE) that includes a compiler, debugger, and other development tools to increase productivity. VLISP adds more capabilities and extends the language to interact with objects using ActiveX. VLISP also enables AutoLISP to respond to events through object reactors. Unlike in ObjectARX, or VBA, each document opened in the Multiple Design Environment (MDE) has its own Visual LISP namespace and environment. A namespace is an insulated environment keeping AutoLISP routines that are specific to one document from having symbol or variable name and value conflicts with those in another document. For example, the following line of code sets a different value to the symbol a for different documents. (setq a (getvar "DWGNAME"))

328 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

Visual LISP provides mechanisms for loading symbols and variables from one namespace to another. More information about namespaces can be found in the AutoLISP Developer's Guide in the Help system. To display Developer Help, click Help menu ➤ Additional Resources ➤ Developer Help. AutoLISP applications or routines can interact with AutoCAD in many ways. These routines can prompt the user for input, access built-in AutoCAD commands directly, and modify or create objects in the drawing database. By creating AutoLISP routines you can add discipline-specific commands to AutoCAD. Some of the standard AutoCAD commands are actually AutoLISP applications. Visual LISP provides three file format options for AutoLISP applications: ■

Reading an LSP file (.lsp)—an ASCII text file that contains AutoLISP program code.



Reading an FAS file (.fas)—a binary, compiled version of a single LSP program file.



Reading a VLX file (.vlx)—a compiled set of one or more LSP and/or dialog control language (DCL) files.

NOTE Like-named AutoLISP application files are loaded based on their Modified time stamp; the LSP, FAS, or VLX file with the most recent time stamp is loaded unless you specify the full file name (including the file name extension). Because AutoCAD can read AutoLISP code directly, no compiling is required. While Visual LISP provides an IDE, you may choose to experiment by entering code at the Command prompt, which allows you to see the results immediately. This makes AutoLISP an easy language to experiment with, regardless of your programming experience. Even if you are not interested in writing AutoLISP applications, your AutoCAD package includes many useful routines. Routines are also available as shareware through third-party developers. Knowing how to load and use these routines can enhance your productivity. NOTE When command input comes from the AutoLISP command function, the settings of the PICKADD and PICKAUTO system variables are assumed to be 1 and 0, respectively. This preserves compatibility with previous releases of AutoCAD and makes customization easier (because you don't have to check the settings of these variables). For information about AutoLISP programming, see the AutoLISP Developer's Guide, and for information about AutoLISP and Visual LISP functions, see the

Overview of AutoLISP and Visual LISP | 329

AutoLISP Reference in the Help system. To display Developer Help, click Help menu ➤ Additional Resources ➤ Developer Help. AutoLISP programs can use dialog boxes with their applications. Programmable dialog boxes are described only in the AutoLISP Developer's Guide.

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables PICKADD Controls whether subsequent selections replace the current selection set or add to it PICKAUTO Controls automatic windowing at the Select Objects prompt

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Use AutoLISP Applications AutoLISP applications are stored in ASCII text files that you can edit. Before you can use an AutoLISP application, it must first be loaded. AutoLISP applications are stored in ASCII text files with the .lsp extension. These files generally have a header portion that describes a routine, its use, and any specific instructions. This header might also include comments that document the author and the legal information regarding the use of the routine. Comments are preceded by a semicolon (;). You can view and edit these files with a text editor or word processor that can produce an ASCII text file.

330 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

Before you can use an AutoLISP application, it must first be loaded. You can use the APPLOAD command or the AutoLISP load function to load an application. Loading an AutoLISP application loads the AutoLISP code from the LSP file into your system's memory. Loading an application with the load function involves entering AutoLISP code at the Command prompt. If the load function is successful, it displays the value of the last expression in the file at the command prompt. This is usually the name of the last function defined in the file or instructions on using the newly loaded function. If load fails, it returns an AutoLISP error message. A load failure can be caused by incorrect coding in the file or by entering the wrong file name at the command prompt. The syntax for the load function is (load filename [onfailure])

This syntax shows that the load function has two arguments: filename, which is required, and onfailure, which is optional. When loading an AutoLISP file at the command prompt, you typically supply only the filename argument. The following example loads the AutoLISP file newfile.lsp. Command: (load "newfile") The .lsp extension is not required. This format works for any LSP file in the current library path. To load an AutoLISP file that is not in the library path, you must provide the full path and file name as the filename argument. Command: (load "d:/files/morelisp/newfile") NOTE When specifying a directory path, you must use a slash (/) or two backslashes (\\) as the separator, because a single backslash has a special meaning in AutoLISP. See also: ■

Overview of File Organization (page 7)

Quick Reference Commands APPLOAD Loads and unloads applications and defines which applications to load at startup

Use AutoLISP Applications | 331

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Automatically Load and Run AutoLISP Routines You can load AutoLISP routines each time you run AutoCAD. You can also execute certain commands or functions at specific times during a drawing session.

Overview of AutoLISP Automatic Loading AutoCAD loads the contents of three user-definable files automatically: acad.lsp, acaddoc.lsp, and the MNL file that accompanies your current customization file. By default, the acad.lsp file is loaded only once, when AutoCAD starts, whereas acaddoc.lsp is loaded with each individual document (or drawing). This lets you associate the loading of the acad.lsp file with application startup, and the acaddoc.lsp file with document (or drawing) startup. The default method for loading these startup files can be modified by changing the setting of the ACADLSPASDOC system variable. If one of these files defines a function of the special type S::STARTUP, this routine runs immediately after the drawing is fully initialized. The S::STARTUP function is described in S::STARTUP Function: Postinitialization Execution (page 339). As an alternative, the APPLOAD command provides a Startup Suite option that loads the specified applications without the need to edit any files. The acad.lsp and acaddoc.lsp startup files are not provided with AutoCAD. It is up to the user to create and maintain these files.

332 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

Command Autoloader When you automatically load a command using the load or command functions, the command's definition takes up memory whether or not you actually use the command. The AutoLISP autoload function makes a command available without loading the entire routine into memory. Adding the following code to your acaddoc.lsp file automatically loads the commands CMD1, CMD2, and CMD3 from the cmds.lsp file and the NEWCMD command from the newcmd.lsp file. (autoload "CMDS" '("CMD1" "CMD2" "CMD3")) (autoload "NEWCMD" '("NEWCMD"))

The first time you enter an automatically loaded command at the Command prompt, AutoLISP loads the entire command definition from the associated file. AutoLISP also provides the autoarxload function for ObjectARX applications. See autoload and autoarxload in the AutoLISP Reference in the Help system. To display Developer Help, click Help menu ➤ Additional Resources ➤ Developer Help. NOTE Like-named AutoLISP startup files are loaded based on their Modified time stamp; the LSP file with the most recent time stamp is loaded unless you specify the full file name (including the file name extension). See also: ■

Load an AutoLISP File (page 235)



S::STARTUP Function: Postinitialization Execution (page 339)

Quick Reference Commands APPLOAD Loads and unloads applications and defines which applications to load at startup

Automatically Load and Run AutoLISP Routines | 333

System Variables ACADLSPASDOC Controls whether the acad.lsp file is loaded into every drawing or just the first drawing opened in a session

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

The ACAD.LSP File You can create an acad.lsp file if you regularly use specific AutoLISP routines. When you start AutoCAD, it searches the support file search path for an acad.lsp file. If an acad.lsp file is found, it is loaded into memory. The acad.lsp file is loaded at each drawing session startup when AutoCAD is launched. Because the acad.lsp file is intended to be used for application-specific startup routines, all functions and variables defined in an acad.lsp file are only available in the first drawing. You will probably want to move routines that should be available in all documents from your acad.lsp file into the acaddoc.lsp file. The recommended functionality of acad.lsp and acaddoc.lsp can be overridden with the ACADLSPASDOC system variable. If the ACADLSPASDOC system variable is set to 0 (the default setting), the acad.lsp file is loaded just once: upon application startup. If ACADLSPASDOC is set to 1, the acad.lsp file is reloaded with each new drawing. The acad.lsp file can contain AutoLISP code for one or more routines, or just a series of load function calls. The latter method is preferable, because modification is easier. If you save the following code as an acad.lsp file, the files mysessionapp1.lsp, databasesynch.lsp, and drawingmanager.lsp are loaded every time you start AutoCAD. (load "mysessionapp1") (load "databasesynch") (load "drawingmanager")

334 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

WARNING Do not modify the reserved acad2008.lsp file. Autodesk provides the acad2008.lsp file, which contains AutoLISP defined functions that are required by AutoCAD. This file is loaded into memory immediately before the acad.lsp file is loaded. See also: ■

Overview of File Organization (page 7)



Prevent AutoLISP Errors When Loading Startup Files (page 338)

Quick Reference Commands APPLOAD Loads and unloads applications and defines which applications to load at startup

System Variables ACADLSPASDOC Controls whether the acad.lsp file is loaded into every drawing or just the first drawing opened in a session

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

The ACADDOC.LSP File The acaddoc.lsp file is intended to be associated with each document (or drawing) initialization. This file is useful if you want to load a library of AutoLISP routines to be available every time you start a new drawing (or open an existing drawing).

Automatically Load and Run AutoLISP Routines | 335

Each time a drawing opens, AutoCAD searches the library path for an acaddoc.lsp file. If it finds one, it loads the file into memory. The acaddoc.lsp file is always loaded with each drawing regardless of the settings of ACADLSPASDOC. Most users will have a single acaddoc.lsp file for all document-based AutoLISP routines. AutoCAD searches for an acaddoc.lsp file in the order defined by the library path; therefore, with this feature, you can have a different acaddoc.lsp file in each drawing directory, which would load specific AutoLISP routines for certain types of drawings or jobs. The acaddoc.lsp file can contain AutoLISP code for one or more routines, or just a series of load function calls. The latter method is preferable, because modification is easier. If you save the following code as an acaddoc.lsp file, the files mydocumentapp1.lsp, build.lsp, and counter.lsp are loaded every time a new document is opened. (load "mydocumentapp1") (load "build") (load "counter")

WARNING Do not modify the reserved acad2008doc.lsp file. Autodesk provides the acad2008doc.lsp file, which contains AutoLISP-defined functions that are required by AutoCAD. This file is loaded into memory immediately before the acaddoc.lsp file is loaded. See also: ■

Overview of File Organization (page 7)



Prevent AutoLISP Errors When Loading Startup Files (page 338)

Quick Reference Commands APPLOAD Loads and unloads applications and defines which applications to load at startup

336 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

System Variables ACADLSPASDOC Controls whether the acad.lsp file is loaded into every drawing or just the first drawing opened in a session

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

The MNL File for an AutoLISP Menu When AutoCAD loads a customization file, it searches for an MNL file with a matching file name. If it finds the file, it loads the file into memory. This function ensures that AutoCAD loads the AutoLISP functions that are needed for proper operation of a menu. This function ensures that AutoCAD loads the AutoLISP functions that are needed for proper operation of a menu. For example, the default AutoCAD customization file, acad.cui, relies on the file acad.mnl. This file defines numerous AutoLISP functions used by the menu. The MNL file is loaded after the acaddoc.lsp file. NOTE If a customization file is loaded with the AutoLISP command function—with syntax similar to (command "menu" "newmenu")—the associated MNL file is not loaded until the entire AutoLISP routine has run. In this example, calls to the princ function can be used to display status messages. The first use of princ displays the following at the command prompt: Newmenu utilities… Loaded. The second call to princ exits the AutoLISP function. Without this second call to princ, the message would be displayed twice. As mentioned previously, you can include the onfailure argument with calls to the load function as an extra precaution.

Automatically Load and Run AutoLISP Routines | 337

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Prevent AutoLISP Errors When Loading Startup Files If an AutoLISP error occurs while you are loading a startup file, the remainder of the file is ignored and is not loaded. Files specified in a startup file that do not exist or that are not in the AutoCAD library path generally cause errors. Therefore, you may want to use the onfailure argument with the load function. The following example uses the onfailure argument: (princ (load "mydocapp1" "\nMYDOCAPP1.LSP file not loaded.")) (princ (load "build" "\nBUILD.LSP file not loaded.")) (princ (load "counter" "\nCOUNTER.LSP file not loaded.")) (princ)

If a call to the load function is successful, it returns the value of the last expression in the file (usually the name of the last defined function or a message regarding the use of the function). If the call fails, it returns the value of the onfailure argument. In the preceding example, the value returned by the load function is passed to the princ function, causing that value to be displayed at the command prompt.

338 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

For example, if an error occurs while AutoCAD loads the mydocapp1.lsp file, the princ function displays the following message and AutoCAD continues to load the two remaining files: MYDOCAPP1.LSP file not loaded. If you use the command function in an acad.lsp, acaddoc.lsp, or MNL file, it should be called only from within a defun statement. Use the S::STARTUP function to define commands that need to be issued immediately when you begin a drawing session. See also: ■

S::STARTUP Function: Postinitialization Execution (page 339)

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

S::STARTUP Function: Postinitialization Execution You can define an S::STARTUP function to perform any needed setup operations after the drawing is initialized. The startup LISP files (acad.lsp, acaddoc.lsp, and MNL) are all loaded into memory before the drawing is completely initialized. Typically, this does not pose a problem, unless you want to use the command function, which is not guaranteed to work until after a drawing is initialized.

Automatically Load and Run AutoLISP Routines | 339

If the user-defined function S::STARTUP is included in an acad.lsp, acaddoc.lsp, or MNL file, it is called when you enter a new drawing or open an existing drawing. Thus, you can include a definition of S::STARTUP in the LISP startup file to perform any setup operations. For example, if you want to override the standard HATCH command by adding a message and then switching to the BHATCH command, use an acaddoc.lsp file that contains the following: (defun C:HATCH ( ) (alert "Using the BHATCH command!") (princ "\nEnter OLDHATCH to get to real HATCH command.\n") (command "BHATCH") (princ) ) (defun C:OLDHATCH ( ) (command ".HATCH") (princ) ) (defun-q S::STARTUP ( ) (command "undefine" "hatch") (princ "\nRedefined HATCH to BHATCH!\n") )

Before the drawing is initialized, new definitions for HATCH and OLDHATCH are defined with the defun function. After the drawing is initialized, the S::STARTUP function is called and the standard definition of HATCH is undefined. NOTE To be appended, the S::STARTUP function must have been defined with the defun-q function rather than defun. Because an S::STARTUP function can be defined in many places (an acad.lsp, acaddoc.lsp, or MNL file or any other AutoLISP file loaded from any of these), it's possible to overwrite a previously defined S::STARTUP function. The following example shows one method of ensuring that your startup function works with other functions. (defun-q MYSTARTUP ( )

... your startup function ... ) (setq S::STARTUP (append S::STARTUP MYSTARTUP))

The previous code appends your startup function to that of an existing S::STARTUP function and then redefines the S::STARTUP function to include

340 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

your startup code. This works properly regardless of the prior existence of an S::STARTUP function.

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

ObjectARX ObjectARX technology provides the foundation for design software applications to share intelligent object data. You can run third-party ObjectARX application programs or write your own.

Overview of ObjectARX ObjectARX® (AutoCAD Runtime Extension) is a compiled-language programming environment for developing AutoCAD applications. The ObjectARX programming environment includes a number of dynamic link libraries (DLLs) that run in the same address space as AutoCAD and operate directly with core AutoCAD data structures and code. These libraries take advantage of the AutoCAD open architecture, providing direct access to the AutoCAD database structures, graphics system, and AutoCAD geometry engine to extend AutoCAD classes and capabilities at runtime. Additionally, you can use DLLs to create new commands that operate exactly the same way as native AutoCAD commands.

ObjectARX | 341

You can use ObjectARX libraries in conjunction with other AutoCAD programming interfaces, such as AutoLISP or VBA, enabling cross-API integration. The ObjectARX programming environment is described in the ObjectARX Developer's Guide. The documentation is part of the ObjectARX Software Development Kit, which can be downloaded from the Development Tools section of the Autodesk website. For more information, click Help menu ➤ Additional Resources ➤ Developer Help. Click ObjectARX once the Help systems opens.

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Use ObjectARX Applications To load an ObjectARX application, you use the Load option of the ARX command. After loading, all commands defined by this application are available at the Command prompt. Some ObjectARX applications use large amounts of system memory. If you are finished using an application and want to remove it from memory, use the Unload option of ARX. You can also load an ObjectARX application with the arxload AutoLISP function. The syntax for the arxload function is almost identical to that of the load function used with AutoLISP files. If the arxload function loads the

342 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

ObjectARX program successfully, it returns the program name. The syntax for the arxload function is as follows: (arxload filename [onfailure])

The two arguments for the arxload function are filename and onfailure. As with the load function, the filename argument is required and must be the complete path name description of the ObjectARX program file to load. The onfailure argument is optional and typically not used when you load ObjectARX programs from the command prompt. The following example loads the ObjectARX application myapp.arx. (arxload "myapp")

As with AutoLISP files, AutoCAD searches the library path for the specified file. If you need to load a file that is not in the library path, you must provide the full path name description of the file. NOTE When specifying a directory path, you must use a slash (/) or two backslashes (\\) as the separator, because a single backslash has a special meaning in AutoLISP. Attempting to load an application that has previously been loaded results in an error. Before using arxload you should use the arx function to check the currently loaded applications. To unload an application with AutoLISP, use the arxunload function. The following example unloads the myapp application. (arxunload "myapp")

Using the arxunload function not only removes the application from memory but also removes the command definitions associated with that application. See also: ■

Overview of File Organization (page 7)

Quick Reference Commands ARX Loads, unloads, and provides information about ObjectARX applications

Use ObjectARX Applications | 343

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Automatically Load ObjectARX Applications Some ObjectARX samples contain an acad.rx file, which lists ObjectARX program files that are loaded automatically when you start AutoCAD. You can create or edit this file with a text editor or word processor that produces files in ASCII text format, adding to or deleting from its contents to make the appropriate ObjectARX programs available for use. As an alternative, the APPLOAD command provides a Startup Suite option that loads the specified applications without the need to edit any files. Because AutoCAD searches for the acad.rx file in the order specified by the library path, you can have a different acad.rx file in each drawing directory. This makes specific ObjectARX programs available for certain types of drawings. For example, you might keep 3D drawings in a directory called AcadJobs/3d_dwgs. If that directory is set up as the current directory, you could copy the acad.rx file into that directory and modify it in the following manner: myapp1 otherapp

If you place this new acad.rx file in the AcadJobs/3d_dwgs directory and you start AutoCAD with that as the current directory, these new ObjectARX programs are then loaded and are available from the AutoCAD command prompt. Because the original acad.rx file is still in the directory with the AutoCAD program files, the default acad.rx file will be loaded if you start AutoCAD from another directory that does not contain an acad.rx file. You can load ObjectARX programs from an MNL file using the arxload function. This ensures that an ObjectARX program, required for proper operation of a menu, will be loaded when the menu file is loaded.

344 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

You can also autoload many ObjectARX-defined AutoCAD commands. See Overview of AutoLISP Automatic Loading (page 332) and autoarxload in the AutoLISP Reference in the Help system. To display Developer Help, click Help menu ➤ Additional Resources ➤ Developer Help. See also: ■

Overview of AutoLISP Automatic Loading (page 332)

Quick Reference Commands APPLOAD Loads and unloads applications and defines which applications to load at startup

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

.NET With the Microsoft .NET Framework, you can create applications that interoperate with AutoCAD using programming languages like VB .NET and C#.

Overview of .NET The .NET Framework is a language-neutral programming environment developed by Microsoft. In addition to the run-time environment, the

.NET | 345

Framework provides class libraries that facilitate development of Windowsand Web-based applications that are interoperable and secure. AutoCAD supports .NET application development with ObjectARX managed wrapper classes. See the “AutoCAD Managed Class Reference” and the “ObjectARX Managed Wrapper Classes” sections of the ObjectARX Developer's Guide, both in the ObjectARX SDK, for a complete list of the managed wrapper classes that are available. For more information about the .NET Framework, see the Microsoft documentation. Managed wrapper classes are provided for most of the ObjectARX SDK, enabling you to write applications in any language that is supported by the .NET Framework, including VB .NET and C#. The managed classes implement database functionality and enable you to write applications that read and write drawing format (DWG) files. They also provide access to AutoCAD user interface elements, including the command prompt and feature dialog boxes, the AutoCAD editor, and the publishing and plotting components.

Quick Reference Commands No entries

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Loading Managed Applications in AutoCAD To load a managed application, enter NETLOAD at the AutoCAD Command prompt and browse to the desired DLL file. Managed applications are unloaded only when AutoCAD exits.

346 | Chapter 8 Introduction to Programming Interfaces

Quick Reference Commands NETLOAD Loads a .NET application

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Loading Managed Applications in AutoCAD | 347

348

9

Shapes and Shape Fonts

With AutoCAD®, you can define shapes to use as drawing

In this chapter

symbols and text fonts. This appendix explains how to create



Overview of Shape Files



Create Shape Definition Files

and compile your own shape and font files.

349

Overview of Shape Files Shapes are objects that you use like blocks. First you use the LOAD command to load the compiled shape file containing the shape definition. Then you use the SHAPE command to insert shapes from the file into your drawing. You can specify the scale and rotation to use for each shape as you add it. AutoCAD SHP fonts are a special type of shape file, and are defined in the same way as shape files. Blocks are more versatile and easier to use and apply than shapes. However, shapes are more efficient for AutoCAD to store and draw. User-defined shapes are helpful when you must insert a simple part many times and when speed is important.

Compile Shape/Font Files You enter the description of shapes in a specially formatted text file with a file extension of .shp. To create the file, use a text editor or word processor that enables you to save in ASCII format, and then compile the ASCII file. Compiling a shape definition file (SHP) generates a compiled shape file (SHX). The compiled file has the same name as the shape definition file but with a file type of SHX. If the shape definition file defines a font, you use the STYLE command to define a text style. Then, you use one of the text placement commands (TEXT or MTEXT) to place the characters in the drawing. If the shape definition file defines shapes, you use the LOAD command to load the shape file into the drawing. Then, you use the SHAPE command to place the individual shapes in the drawing (similar in concept to the INSERT command).

Compile PostScript Fonts To use a Type 1 PostScript font in AutoCAD, you must first compile it into an AutoCAD shape file. The COMPILE command accepts both SHP and PFB files as input and generates an SHX file. Compiled versions of PostScript fonts can take a lot of disk space, so compile only those fonts you use frequently. AutoCAD cannot compile and load every Type 1 font. The PostScript font facilities in AutoCAD are intended to process a subset of Adobe fonts. If you receive an error while compiling a PostScript font, the resulting SHX file (if one is generated) may not load into AutoCAD. For more information on the Adobe Type 1 font format, refer to Adobe Type1 Font Format Version 1.1. When you've purchased and installed these fonts, you can begin using them with AutoCAD.

350 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

NOTE Make sure you understand any copyright that accompanies the PostScript fonts you use. The same copyright restrictions generally apply to the SHX form of fonts you've compiled. To compile a shape or font file ■

On the Command prompt, enter compile.

In the Select Shape File dialog box, you can select a shape definition file (SHP) or PostScript font file (PFB). After you select the file name, compiling begins. If AutoCAD finds an error in the shape descriptions, a message is displayed telling you the type of error and the line number. When compiling is complete, the following messages are displayed: Compilation successful. Output file name.shx contains nnn bytes.

Quick Reference Commands COMPILE Compiles shape files and PostScript font files into SHX files LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

Overview of Shape Files | 351

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Create Shape Definition Files AutoCAD font and shape files (SHX) are compiled from shape definition files (SHP). You can create or modify shape definition files with a text editor or word processor that saves files in ASCII format.

Shape Descriptions AutoCAD font and shape files (SHX) are compiled from shape definition files (SHP). You can create or modify shape definition files with a text editor or word processor that saves files in ASCII format. The syntax of the shape description for each shape or character is the same regardless of the final use (shape or font) for that shape description. If a shape definition file is to be used as a font file, the first entry in the file describes the font itself rather than a shape within the file. If this initial entry describes a shape, the file is used as a shape file. Being able to create your own shape definitions is a valuable skill. Keep in mind, however, that this is a very complex subject to learn and requires patience. Each line in a shape definition file can contain up to 128 characters. Longer lines cannot be compiled. Because AutoCAD ignores blank lines and text to the right of a semicolon, you can embed comments in shape definition files. Each shape description has a header line of the following form and is followed by one or more lines containing specification bytes, separated by commas and terminated by a 0.

352 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

*shapenumber,defbytes,shapename specbyte1,specbyte2,specbyte3,...,0

The following list describes the fields of a shape description: shapenumber A number, unique to the file, between 1 and 258 (and up to 32768 for Unicode fonts), and preceded by an asterisk (*). Non-Unicode font files use the shape numbers 256, 257, and 258 for the symbolic identifiers Degree_Sign, Plus_Or_Minus_Sign, and Diameter_Symbol. For Unicode fonts these glyphs appear at the U+00B0, U+00B1, and U+2205 shape numbers and are part of the “Latin Extended-A” subset. Text fonts (files containing shape definitions for each character) require specific numbers corresponding to the value of each character in the ASCII code; other shapes can be assigned any numbers. defbytes The number of data bytes (specbytes) required to describe the shape, including the terminating 0. The limit is 2,000 bytes per shape. shapename The shape name. Shape names must be uppercase to be recognized. Names with lowercase characters are ignored and are usually used to label font shape definitions. specbyte A shape specification byte. Each specification byte is a code that defines either a vector length and direction or one of a number of special codes. A specification byte can be expressed in the shape definition file as either a decimal or hexadecimal value. This section uses both decimal and hexadecimal specification byte values for its examples (as do many of the shape definition files). If the first character of a specification byte is a 0 (zero), the two characters that follow are interpreted as hexadecimal values.

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

Shape Descriptions | 353

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Vector Length and Direction Code A simple shape specification byte contains vector length and direction encoded into one specification byte. A simple shape specification byte contains vector length and direction encoded into one specification byte (one specbyte field). Each vector length and direction code is a string of three characters. The first character must be a 0, which indicates to AutoCAD that the next two characters are interpreted as hexadecimal values. The second character specifies the length of the vector in units. Valid hexadecimal values range from 1 (one unit long) through F (15 units long). The third character specifies the direction of the vector. The following figure illustrates the direction codes.

Vector direction codes All the vectors in the preceding figure were drawn with the same length specification. Diagonal vectors stretch to match the X or Y displacement of

354 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

the closest orthogonal vector. This is similar to the action of the snap grid in AutoCAD. The following example constructs a shape named DBOX with an arbitrarily assigned shape number of 230. *230,6,DBOX 014,010,01C,018,012,0

The preceding sequence of specification bytes defines a box one unit high byone unit wide, with a diagonal line running from the lower left to the upper right. After saving the file as dbox.shp, use the COMPILE command to generate the dbox.shx file. Use the LOAD command to load the shape file containing this definition, and then use the SHAPE command as follows: Command: shape Enter shape name or [?]: dbox Specify insertion point: 1,1 Specify height : 2 Specify rotation angle : 0 The resulting shape is shown in the following illustration.

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

Vector Length and Direction Code | 355

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Special Codes In addition to defining vectors, a specification byte can use special codes to create additional forms and specify certain actions. In addition to defining vectors, a specification byte can use special codes to create additional forms and specify certain actions. To use a special code, the second character of the three-character string (the vector length specification) must be 0, or you can specify only the code number. For example, 008 and 8 are both valid specifications. Specification byte codes Code

Description

000

End of shape definition

001

Activate Draw mode (pen down)

002

Deactivate Draw mode (pen up)

003

Divide vector lengths by next byte

004

Multiply vector lengths by next byte

005

Push current location onto stack

006

Pop current location from stack

356 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

Specification byte codes Code

Description

007

Draw subshape number given by next byte

008

X-Y displacement given by next two bytes

009

Multiple X-Y displacements, terminated (0,0)

00A

Octant arc defined by next two bytes

00B

Fractional arc defined by next five bytes

00C

Arc defined by X-Y displacement and bulge

00D

Multiple bulge-specified arcs

00E

Process next command only if vertical text

Codes 0, 1, and 2: End of Shape and Draw Mode Control Code 0 marks the end of the shape definition. Codes 1 and 2 control Draw mode. Draw is activated at the start of each shape. When Draw mode is turned on (code 1), the vectors cause lines to be drawn. When Draw mode is turned off (code 2), the vectors move to a new location without drawing.

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command

Special Codes | 357

SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Codes 3 and 4: Size Control Codes 3 and 4 control the relative size of each vector. The height specified with the SHAPE command is initially considered the length of a single orthogonal vector (direction 0, 4, 8, or C). Code 3 divides vector lengths by the next byte. Code 4 multiplies vector lengths by the next byte. Codes 3 and 4 are followed by a specification byte containing an integer scale factor (1 through 255). If you want the shape height to specify the size of the entire shape, and you use 10 vector lengths to draw it, you can use 3,10 to scale the height specification. The scale factor is cumulative within a shape; that is, multiplying by 2 and again by 6 results in a scale factor of 12. Usually, you should reverse the effect of your scale factors at the end of the shape, especially for subshapes and text font shapes. AutoCAD does not reset the scale factor for you.

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

358 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Codes 5 and 6: Location Save/Restore Code 5 pushes (saves) and code 6 pops (restores) the current coordinate position while drawing a shape so that you can return to it from a later point in the shape. You must pop everything you push. The position stack is only four locations deep. If the stack overflows because of too many pushes or too many missing pops, the following message is displayed when the shape is drawn. Position stack overflow in shape nnn Similarly, if you try to pop more locations than have been pushed onto the stack, the following message is displayed when the shape is drawn. Position stack underflow in shape nnn

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

Special Codes | 359

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Code 7: Subshape Code 7 draws the subshape number given by the next byte. For a non-Unicode font the specification byte following code 7 is a shape number from 1 to 255. For a Unicode font, code 7 is followed by a Unicode shape number from 1 to 65535. Unicode shape numbers should be counted as two bytes (for specific information about the differences between Unicode and non-Unicode fonts, see Unicode Font Descriptions (page 432)). The shape with that number (in the same shape file) is drawn at this time. Draw mode is not reset for the new shape. When the subshape is complete, drawing the current shape resumes.

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

360 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Codes 8 and 9: X-Y Displacements Normal vector specification bytes draw only in the 16 predefined directions, and the longest length is 15. These restrictions help make shape definitions efficient but are sometimes limiting. With codes 8 and 9 you can draw nonstandard vectors using X-Y displacements. Code 8 specifies the X-Y displacement given by the next two bytes. Code 8 must be followed by two specification bytes in the format: 8,X-displacement,Y-displacement

The X-Y displacements can range from -128 to +127. A leading + is optional, and you can use parentheses to improve readability. The following example results in a vector that draws (or moves) 10 units to the left and three units up. 8,(-10,3)

Following the two displacement specification bytes, the shape returns to Normal Vector mode. You can use code 9 to draw a sequence of nonstandard vectors. Code 9 specifies any number of X-Y displacement pairs. The code sequence is terminated by a (0,0) pair. The following example draws three nonstandard vectors and returns to Normal Vector mode. 9,(3,1),(3,2),(2,-3),(0,0)

You must terminate the sequence of X-Y displacement pairs with a (0,0) pair in order for AutoCAD to recognize any Normal Vectors or special codes that follow.

Special Codes | 361

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Code 00A: Octant Arc Special code 00A (or 10) uses the next two specification bytes to define an arc. This is called an octant arc because it spans one or more 45-degree octants, starting and ending on an octant boundary. Octants are numbered counterclockwise from the 3 o'clock position, as shown in the following illustration.

The arc specification is 10,radius,(-)0SC

362 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

The radius can be any value from 1 through 255. The second specification byte indicates the direction of the arc (counterclockwise if positive, and clockwise if negative), its starting octant (s, a value from 0 through 7), and the number of octants it spans (c, a value from 0 through 7, in which 0 equals eight octants, or a full circle). You can use parentheses to improve readability. For example, consider the following fragment of a shape definition: ...012,10,(1,-032),01E,...

This code draws a one-unit vector up and to the right, a clockwise arc from octant 3 (with a radius of one unit for two octants), and then a one-unit vector down and to the right, as shown in the following illustration.

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

Special Codes | 363

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Code 00B: Fractional Arc Special code 00B (11) draws an arc that doesn't necessarily start and end on an octant boundary. The definition uses five specification bytes. 11,start_offset,end_offset,high_radius,radius,(-)0SC

The start_offset and end_offset represent how far from an octant boundary the arc begins or ends. The high_radius represents the most significant eight bits of the radius; the high radius will be 0 unless the radius is greater than 255 units. Multiply the high_radius value by 256 and add that value to the radius value to generate an arc radius greater than 255. The radius and ending specification byte are the same as for the octant arc specification (code 00A, described previously). You determine the startoffset by calculating the difference in degrees between the starting octant's boundary (a multiple of 45 degrees) and the start of the arc. Then, you multiply this difference by 256 and divide by 45. If the arc starts on an octant boundary, its start offset is 0. The end offset is calculated in a similar fashion, but you use the number of degrees from the last octant boundary crossed to the end of the arc. If the arc ends on an octant boundary, its end offset is 0. For example, a fractional arc from 55 degrees to 95 degrees with a 3 unit radius would be coded as follows: 11,(56,28,0,3,012)

Here is the explanation:

364 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

start_offset end_offset high_radius radius starting octant ending octant

= = = = = =

56 28 0 3 1 2

because ((55 - 45) * 256 / 45) = 56 because ((95 - 90) * 256 / 45) = 28 because (radius < 255) because arc starts in the 45 degree octant because arc ends in the 90 degree octant

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Codes 00C and 00D: Bulge-Specified Arcs Special codes 00C and 00D (12 and 13) provide another mechanism for including arc segments in shape descriptions. They are similar to codes 8 and 9 in that you can use them to specify X-Y displacements. However, codes 00C and 00D draw arcs by applying a bulge factor to the displacement vector. Code 00C draws one arc segment, while code 00D draws multiple arc segments (polyarcs) until it is terminated by a (0,0) displacement. Code 00C must be followed by three bytes describing the arc: 0C,X-displacement,Y-displacement,Bulge

Special Codes | 365

Both the X and Y displacement and the bulge, which specifies the curvature of the arc, can range from -127 to +127. If the line segment specified by the displacement has length D, and the perpendicular distance from the midpoint of that segment has height H, the magnitude of the bulge is ((2* H / D) * 127). The sign is negative if the arc from the current location to the new location is clockwise.

A semicircle has bulge 127 (or -127) and is the greatest arc that can be represented as a single-arc segment using these codes (use two consecutive arc segments for larger arcs). A bulge specification of 0 is valid and represents a straight-line segment. Note, however, that using code 8 for a straight-line segment saves a byte in the shape description. The polyarc code (00D, or 13) is followed by 0 or by more arc segment triples, and is terminated by a (0,0) displacement. Note that no bulge is specified after the final displacement. For example, the letter S might be defined by the following sequence: 13,(0,5,127),(0,5,-127),(0,0)

Zero bulge segments are useful within polyarcs to represent straight segments; they are more efficient than terminating the polyarc, inserting one straight segment, and then starting another polyarc. The number -128 cannot be used in arc segment and polyarc definitions.

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

366 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Code 00E: Flag Vertical Text Command Special code 00E (14) is used only in dual-orientation text font descriptions, where the font is used in both horizontal and vertical orientations. When this special code is encountered in a character definition, the next code is either processed or skipped, depending on orientation. If the orientation is vertical, the next code is processed; if it is horizontal, the next code is skipped. In horizontal text, the start point for each character is the left end of the baseline. In vertical text, the start point is assumed to be the top center of the character. At the end of each character, a pen-up segment is normally drawn to position to the next character's start point. For horizontal text, it is to the right; for vertical text, it is downward. The special 00E (14) code is used primarily to adjust for differences in start points and endpoints, permitting the same character shape definition to be used both horizontally and vertically. For instance, the following definition of an uppercase D could be used in either horizontal or vertical text. *68,22,ucd 2,14,8,(-2, 6),1,030,012,044,016,038,2,010,1,06C,2,050, 14,8,(-4,-3),0

Special Codes | 367

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Text Font Descriptions Text fonts must include a special shape number 0 that conveys information about the font itself. AutoCAD is packaged with numerous text fonts. You can use the STYLE command to apply expansion, compression, or obliquing to any of these fonts,

368 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

thereby tailoring the characters to your needs. You can draw text of any height, at any baseline angle, and with either horizontal or vertical orientation using these fonts. AutoCAD text fonts are files of shape definitions with shape numbers corresponding to the ASCII code for each character. Codes 1 through 31 are for control characters, only one of which is used in AutoCAD text fonts: 10 (LF) The line feed (LF) must drop down one line without drawing. This is used for repeated TEXT commands, to place succeeding lines below the first one. *10,5,lf 2,8,(0,-10),0

You can modify the spacing of lines by adjusting the downward movement specified by the LF shape definition. Text fonts must include a special shape number 0 that conveys information about the font itself. The format has the following syntax: *0,4,font-name above,below,modes,0

The above value specifies the number of vector lengths above the baseline that the uppercase letters extend, and below indicates how far the lowercase letters descend below the baseline. The baseline is similar in concept to the lines on writing paper. These values define the basic character size and are used as scale factors for the height specified in the TEXT command. The modes byte should be 0 for a horizontally oriented font and 2 for a dual-orientation (horizontal or vertical) font. The special 00E (14) command code is honored only when modes is set to 2. The standard fonts supplied with AutoCAD include a few additional characters required for the AutoCAD dimensioning feature. %%d Degree symbol (°) %%p Plus/minus tolerance symbol (±) %%c Circle diameter dimensioning symbol You can use these and the %%nnn control sequences, as described under TEXT in the Command Reference.

Text Font Descriptions | 369

NOTE AutoCAD draws text characters by their ASCII codes (shape numbers) and not by name. To save memory, specify the shape name portion of each text shape definition in lowercase as shown in the following example. (Lowercase names are not saved in memory.) *65,11,uca 024,043,04d,02c,2,047,1,040,2,02e,0

Because the shape name uca contains lowercase letters, AutoCAD doesn't save the name in memory. However, you can use the name for reference when editing the font definition file. In this example, uca stands for uppercase A.

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD STYLE

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Sample Files This topic contains sample files that help extend the font characters provided with AutoCAD.

370 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

Extended Simplex Roman

Sample Files | 371

;; ;; romans.shp - Extended Simplex Roman ;; ;; Copyright 1997 by Autodesk, Inc. ;; ;; Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for ;; any purpose and without fee is hereby granted, provided that the ;; above copyright notice appears in all copies and that the re stricted ;; rights notice below appear in all supporting documentation. ;; ;; Use, duplication, or disclosure by the U.S. Government is sub ject ;; to restrictions set forth in FAR 52.227-19 (Commercial Computer ;; Software - Restricted Rights) and DFAR 252.227-7013(c)(1)(ii) ;; (Rights in Technical Data and Computer Software), as applicable. ;; *UNIFONT,6,ROMANS Copyright 1997 by Autodesk, Inc. 21,7,2,0,0,0 *0000A,9,lf 2,8,(0,-34),14,8,(30,34),0 *00020,9,spc 2,8,(21,0),14,8,(-21,-30),0 *00021,30,kexc 2,14,8,(-5,-21),14,5,8,(5,21),1,0EC,2,05C,1,01A,01E,012,016,2, 8,(5,-2),14,6,14,8,(5,-9),0 *00022,41,kdblqt 2,14,8,(-8,-25),14,5,8,(6,24),1,01A,016,012,01E,02C,02B,01A,2, 8,(8,5),1,01A,016,012,01E,02C,02B,01A,2,8,(4,-19),14,6, 14,8,(8,-9),0 *00023,57,kns 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-21,-50),14,4,2,14,5,8,(11,25),1,8,(-7,-32),2, 8,(13,32),1,8,(-7,-32),2,8,(-6,19),1,0E0,2,8,(-15,-6),1,0E0,2, 8,(4,-6),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(21,-32),14,4,2,0 *00024,67,kds 2,14,8,(-10,-25),14,5,8,(8,25),1,8,(0,-29),2,8,(4,29),1, 8,(0,-29),2,8,(5,22),1,026,8,(-3,1),048,8,(-3,-1),02A,02C,02D, 01E,02F,8,(6,-2),02F,01E,02D,03C,02A,8,(-3,-1),048,8,(-3,1),026, 2,8,(17,-3),14,6,14,8,(10,-13),0 *00025,64,kpc

372 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

2,14,8,(-12,-21),14,5,8,(21,21),1,8,(-18,-21),2,8,(5,21),1,02E, 02C,02B,029,028,026,024,023,021,020,02F,8,(3,-1),030,8,(3,1),021, 2,8,(-4,-14),1,029,02B,02C,02E,020,021,023,024,026,028,2, 8,(7,-7),14,6,14,8,(12,-9),0 *00026,67,kand 2,14,8,(-13,-21),14,5,8,(23,12),1,014,016,018,01A,02B,8,(-2,-5), 8,(-2,-3),02A,029,048,027,016,025,024,023,012,8,(7,4),012,023, 024,025,027,029,02B,02C,8,(1,-3),8,(2,-3),8,(5,-7),02E,02F,020, 012,014,2,8,(3,-2),14,6,14,8,(13,-9),0 *00027,29,kapos 2,14,8,(-5,-25),14,5,8,(6,24),1,01A,016,012,01E,02C,02B,01A,2, 8,(6,-19),14,6,14,8,(5,-9),0 *00028,39,klp 2,14,8,(-7,-25),14,5,8,(11,25),1,02A,8,(-2,-3),04B,8,(-1,-5),04C, 8,(1,-5),04D,8,(2,-3),02E,2,8,(3,7),14,6,14,8,(7,-16),0 *00029,39,krp 2,14,8,(-7,-25),14,5,8,(3,25),1,02E,8,(2,-3),04D,8,(1,-5),04C, 8,(-1,-5),04B,8,(-2,-3),02A,2,8,(11,7),14,6,14,8,(7,-16),0 *0002A,37,kas 2,14,8,(-8,-21),14,5,8,(8,21),1,0CC,2,8,(-5,9),1,8,(10,-6),2,064, 1,8,(-10,-6),2,8,(13,-12),14,6,14,8,(8,-9),0 *0002B,31,kpls 2,14,8,(-13,-18),14,5,8,(13,18),1,8,(0,-18),2,096,1,8,(18,0),2, 8,(4,-9),14,6,14,8,(13,-9),0 *0002C,29,kcma 2,14,8,(-5,-2),14,5,8,(6,1),1,01A,016,012,01E,02C,02B,01A,2, 8,(6,4),14,6,14,8,(5,-13),0 *0002D,25,ksub 2,14,8,(-13,-9),14,5,8,(4,9),1,8,(18,0),2,8,(4,-9),14,6, 14,8,(13,-9),0 *0002E,26,kper 2,14,8,(-5,-2),14,5,8,(5,2),1,01A,01E,012,016,2,8,(5,-2),14,6, 14,8,(5,-9),0 *0002F,25,kdiv 2,14,8,(-11,-25),14,5,8,(20,25),1,8,(-18,-32),2,8,(20,7),14,6, 14,8,(11,-16),0 *00030,62,n0 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(9,21),1,8,(-3,-1),8,(-2,-3),8,(-1,-5), 03C,8,(1,-5),8,(2,-3),8,(3,-1),020,8,(3,1),8,(2,3),8,(1,5),034, 8,(-1,5),8,(-2,3),8,(-3,1),028,2,8,(11,-21),14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *00031,27,n1 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(6,17),1,021,032,8,(0,-21),2,8,(9,0),

Sample Files | 373

14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *00032,37,n2 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(4,16),1,014,023,012,021,040,02F,01E,02D, 02C,02B,8,(-2,-3),0AA,0E0,2,8,(3,0),14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *00033,46,n3 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(5,21),1,0B0,8,(-6,-8),030,02F,01E, 8,(1,-3),02C,8,(-1,-3),02A,8,(-3,-1),038,8,(-3,1),016,025,2, 8,(17,-4),14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *00034,34,n4 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(13,21),1,8,(-10,-14),0F0,2,8,(-5,14),1, 8,(0,-21),2,8,(7,0),14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *00035,52,n5 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(15,21),1,0A8,8,(-1,-9),012,8,(3,1),030, 8,(3,-1),02E,8,(1,-3),02C,8,(-1,-3),02A,8,(-3,-1),038,8,(-3,1), 016,025,2,8,(17,-4),14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *00036,68,n6 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(16,18),1,025,8,(-3,1),028,8,(-3,-1), 8,(-2,-3),8,(-1,-5),05C,8,(1,-4),02E,8,(3,-1),010,8,(3,1),022, 8,(1,3),014,8,(-1,3),026,8,(-3,1),018,8,(-3,-1),02A,8,(-1,-3),2, 8,(16,-7),14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *00037,31,n7 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(17,21),1,8,(-10,-21),2,8,(-4,21),1,0E0, 2,8,(3,-21),14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *00038,66,n8 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(8,21),1,8,(-3,-1),02B,02C,02D,02F, 8,(4,-1),8,(3,-1),02E,02D,03C,02B,01A,8,(-3,-1),048,8,(-3,1),016, 025,034,023,022,8,(3,1),8,(4,1),021,023,024,025,8,(-3,1),048,2, 8,(12,-21),14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *00039,68,n9 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(16,14),1,8,(-1,-3),02A,8,(-3,-1),018, 8,(-3,1),026,8,(-1,3),014,8,(1,3),022,8,(3,1),010,8,(3,-1),02E, 8,(1,-4),05C,8,(-1,-5),8,(-2,-3),8,(-3,-1),028,8,(-3,1),025,2, 8,(16,-3),14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *0003A,33,kcol 2,14,8,(-5,-14),14,5,8,(5,14),1,01A,01E,012,016,2,0CC,1,01A,01E, 012,016,2,8,(5,-2),14,6,14,8,(5,-9),0 *0003B,38,ksmc 2,14,8,(-5,-14),14,5,8,(5,14),1,01A,01E,012,016,2,8,(1,-13),1, 01A,016,012,01E,02C,02B,01A,2,8,(6,4),14,6,14,8,(5,-13),0 *0003C,28,klt 2,14,8,(-12,-18),14,5,8,(20,18),1,8,(-16,-9),8,(16,-9),2,8,(4,0), 14,6,14,8,(12,-9),0

374 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

*0003D,33,keq 2,14,8,(-13,-12),14,5,8,(4,12),1,8,(18,0),2,8,(-18,-6),1, 8,(18,0),2,8,(4,-6),14,6,14,8,(13,-9),0 *0003E,28,kgt 2,14,8,(-12,-18),14,5,8,(4,18),1,8,(16,-9),8,(-16,-9),2,8,(20,0), 14,6,14,8,(12,-9),0 *0003F,42,kqm 2,14,8,(-9,-21),14,5,8,(3,16),1,014,023,012,021,040,02F,01E,02D, 02C,02B,01A,049,03C,2,05C,1,01A,01E,012,016,2,8,(9,-2),14,6, 14,8,(9,-9),0 *00040,93,kea 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-27,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(18,13),1,025,027,038,029, 01A,02B,03C,02D,01E,02F,030,021,023,2,084,1,0AC,01E,020,022, 8,(1,3),024,8,(-1,3),025,026,027,8,(-3,1),038,8,(-3,-1),029,02A, 02B,8,(-1,-3),03C,8,(1,-3),02D,02E,02F,8,(3,-1),030,8,(3,1),021, 012,2,8,(6,-3),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(27,-18),14,4,2,0 *00041,39,uca 2,14,8,(-9,-21),14,5,8,(9,21),1,8,(-8,-21),2,8,(8,21),1, 8,(8,-21),2,8,(-13,7),1,0A0,2,8,(4,-7),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *00042,70,ucb 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-21,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2, 8,(0,21),1,090,8,(3,-1),01E,02D,02C,02B,01A,8,(-3,-1),2,098,1, 090,8,(3,-1),01E,02D,03C,02B,01A,8,(-3,-1),098,2,8,(17,0),14,6, 14,3,2,14,8,(21,-18),14,4,2,0 *00043,55,ucc 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-21,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(18,16),1,025,026,027,048, 029,02A,02B,8,(-1,-3),05C,8,(1,-3),02D,02E,02F,040,021,022,023,2, 8,(3,-5),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(21,-18),14,4,2,0 *00044,61,ucd 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-21,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2, 8,(0,21),1,070,8,(3,-1),02E,02D,8,(1,-3),05C,8,(-1,-3),02B,02A, 8,(-3,-1),078,2,8,(17,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(21,-18),14,4,2,0 *00045,55,uce 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2, 8,(0,21),1,0D0,2,8,(-13,-10),1,080,2,8,(-8,-11),1,0D0,2,8,(2,0), 14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *00046,37,ucf 2,14,8,(-9,-21),14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2,8,(0,21),1,0D0,2, 8,(-13,-10),1,080,2,8,(6,-11),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *00047,60,ucg 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-21,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(18,16),1,025,026,027,048, 029,02A,02B,8,(-1,-3),05C,8,(1,-3),02D,02E,02F,040,021,022,023, 034,2,058,1,050,2,8,(3,-8),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(21,-18),14,4,2,0

Sample Files | 375

*00048,39,uch 2,14,8,(-11,-21),14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2,8,(14,21),1, 8,(0,-21),2,8,(-14,11),1,0E0,2,8,(4,-11),14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *00049,25,uci 2,14,8,(-4,-21),14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2,8,(4,0),14,6, 14,8,(4,-9),0 *0004A,37,ucj 2,14,8,(-8,-21),14,5,8,(12,21),1,8,(0,-16),8,(-1,-3),01A,029,028, 027,016,8,(-1,3),024,2,8,(14,-7),14,6,14,8,(8,-9),0 *0004B,49,uck 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-21,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2, 8,(14,21),1,0EA,2,052,1,8,(9,-12),2,8,(3,0),14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(21,-18),14,4,2,0 *0004C,43,ucl 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-17,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2, 8,(0,0),1,0C0,2,8,(1,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(17,-18),14,4,2,0 *0004D,49,ucm 2,14,8,(-12,-21),14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2,8,(0,21),1, 8,(8,-21),2,8,(8,21),1,8,(-8,-21),2,8,(8,21),1,8,(0,-21),2, 8,(4,0),14,6,14,8,(12,-9),0 *0004E,41,ucn 2,14,8,(-11,-21),14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2,8,(0,21),1, 8,(14,-21),2,8,(0,21),1,8,(0,-21),2,8,(4,0),14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *0004F,50,uco 2,14,8,(-11,-21),14,5,8,(9,21),1,029,02A,02B,8,(-1,-3),05C, 8,(1,-3),02D,02E,02F,040,021,022,023,8,(1,3),054,8,(-1,3),025, 026,027,048,2,8,(13,-21),14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *00050,55,ucp 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-21,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2, 8,(0,21),1,090,8,(3,-1),01E,02D,03C,02B,01A,8,(-3,-1),098,2, 8,(17,-10),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(21,-18),14,4,2,0 *00051,56,ucq 2,14,8,(-11,-21),14,5,8,(9,21),1,029,02A,02B,8,(-1,-3),05C, 8,(1,-3),02D,02E,02F,040,021,022,023,8,(1,3),054,8,(-1,3),025, 026,027,048,2,8,(3,-17),1,06E,2,8,(4,2),14,6,14,8,(11,-11),0 *00052,61,ucr 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-21,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2, 8,(0,21),1,090,8,(3,-1),01E,02D,02C,02B,01A,8,(-3,-1),098,2,070, 1,8,(7,-11),2,8,(3,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(21,-18),14,4,2,0 *00053,51,ucs 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(17,18),1,026,8,(-3,1),048,8,(-3,-1),02A,

376 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

02C,02D,01E,02F,8,(6,-2),02F,01E,02D,03C,02A,8,(-3,-1),048, 8,(-3,1),026,2,8,(17,-3),14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *00054,31,uct 2,14,8,(-8,-21),14,5,8,(8,21),1,8,(0,-21),2,8,(-7,21),1,0E0,2, 8,(1,-21),14,6,14,8,(8,-9),0 *00055,39,ucu 2,14,8,(-11,-21),14,5,8,(4,21),1,0FC,8,(1,-3),02E,8,(3,-1),020, 8,(3,1),022,8,(1,3),0F4,2,8,(4,-21),14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *00056,33,ucv 2,14,8,(-9,-21),14,5,8,(1,21),1,8,(8,-21),2,8,(8,21),1, 8,(-8,-21),2,8,(9,0),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *00057,49,ucw 2,14,8,(-12,-21),14,5,8,(2,21),1,8,(5,-21),2,8,(5,21),1, 8,(-5,-21),2,8,(5,21),1,8,(5,-21),2,8,(5,21),1,8,(-5,-21),2, 8,(7,0),14,6,14,8,(12,-9),0 *00058,33,ucx 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(3,21),1,8,(14,-21),2,8,(0,21),1, 8,(-14,-21),2,8,(17,0),14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *00059,34,ucy 2,14,8,(-9,-21),14,5,8,(1,21),1,8,(8,-10),0BC,2,8,(8,21),1, 8,(-8,-10),2,8,(9,-11),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *0005A,37,ucz 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(17,21),1,8,(-14,-21),2,8,(0,21),1,0E0,2, 8,(-14,-21),1,0E0,2,8,(3,0),14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *0005B,37,klb 2,14,8,(-7,-25),14,5,8,(4,25),1,8,(0,-32),2,8,(0,32),1,070,2, 8,(-7,-32),1,070,2,8,(3,7),14,6,14,8,(7,-16),0 *0005C,25,kbkslsh 2,14,8,(-11,-25),14,5,8,(2,25),1,8,(18,-32),2,8,(2,7),14,6, 14,8,(11,-16),0 *0005D,37,krb 2,14,8,(-7,-25),14,5,8,(9,25),1,8,(0,-32),2,8,(-7,32),1,070,2, 8,(-7,-32),1,070,2,8,(4,7),14,6,14,8,(7,-16),0 *0005E,28,kcaret 2,14,8,(-11,-25),14,5,8,(3,20),1,8,(8,5),8,(8,-5),2,8,(3,-20), 14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *0005F,21,kundrl 2,14,8,(-12,-14),14,5,02E,1,8,(20,0),2,022,14,6,14,8,(12,-11),0 *00060,29,krvap 2,14,8,(-5,-25),14,5,8,(4,24),1,01E,012,016,01A,02C,02D,01E,2, 8,(6,-19),14,6,14,8,(5,-9),0 *00061,55,lca 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(15,14),1,0EC,2,0B4,1,026,

Sample Files | 377

027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2, 8,(4,-3),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *00062,57,lcb 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2,0B4,1, 022,021,030,02F,02E,8,(1,-3),02C,8,(-1,-3),02A,029,038,027,026,2, 8,(15,-3),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *00063,39,lcc 2,14,8,(-9,-14),14,5,8,(15,11),1,026,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3), 02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,8,(3,-3),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *00064,57,lcd 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(15,21),1,8,(0,-21),2,0B4, 1,026,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022, 2,8,(4,-3),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *00065,42,lce 2,14,8,(-9,-14),14,5,8,(3,8),1,0C0,024,025,016,027,038,029,02A, 8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,8,(3,-3),14,6, 14,8,(9,-9),0 *00066,36,lcf 2,14,8,(-6,-21),14,5,8,(10,21),1,028,029,8,(-1,-3),8,(0,-17),2, 8,(-3,14),1,070,2,8,(3,-14),14,6,14,8,(6,-9),0 *00067,66,lcg 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(15,14),1,8,(0,-16), 8,(-1,-3),01A,029,038,027,2,8,(9,17),1,026,027,038,029,02A, 8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,8,(4,-3),14,6,14,3, 2,14,8,(19,-32),14,4,2,0 *00068,48,lch 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2,0A4,1, 032,021,030,02F,8,(1,-3),0AC,2,8,(4,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18), 14,4,2,0 *00069,32,lci 2,14,8,(-4,-21),14,5,8,(3,20),1,01E,012,016,01A,2,8,(1,-7),1,0DC, 2,8,(4,0),14,6,14,8,(4,-9),0 *0006A,39,lcj 2,14,8,(-5,-21),14,5,8,(5,20),1,01E,012,016,01A,2,8,(1,-7),1, 8,(0,-16),8,(-1,-3),029,028,2,8,(9,7),14,6,14,8,(5,-16),0 *0006B,49,lck 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-17,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2, 8,(10,14),1,0AA,2,042,1,8,(7,-8),2,8,(2,0),14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(17,-18),14,4,2,0 *0006C,25,lcl 2,14,8,(-4,-21),14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2,8,(4,0),14,6,

378 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

14,8,(4,-9),0 *0006D,45,lcm 2,14,8,(-15,-14),14,5,8,(4,14),1,0EC,2,0A4,1,032,021,030,02F, 8,(1,-3),0AC,2,0A4,1,032,021,030,02F,8,(1,-3),0AC,2,8,(4,0),14,6, 14,8,(15,-9),0 *0006E,46,lcn 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,14),1,0EC,2,0A4,1,032, 021,030,02F,8,(1,-3),0AC,2,8,(4,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18), 14,4,2,0 *0006F,58,lco 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(8,14),1,029,02A,8,(-1,-3), 02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,8,(1,3),024,8,(-1,3),026,027, 038,2,8,(11,-14),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *00070,59,lcp 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,14),1,8,(0,-21),2, 8,(0,18),1,022,021,030,02F,02E,8,(1,-3),02C,8,(-1,-3),02A,029, 038,027,026,2,8,(15,-3),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-32),14,4,2,0 *00071,59,lcq 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(15,14),1,8,(0,-21),2, 8,(0,18),1,026,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F, 030,021,022,2,8,(4,-3),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-32),14,4,2,0 *00072,44,lcr 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-13,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,14),1,0EC,2,084,1, 8,(1,3),022,021,030,2,8,(1,-14),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(13,-18),14,4,2, 0 *00073,60,lcs 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-17,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(14,11),1,025,8,(-3,1),038, 8,(-3,-1),02B,02D,02F,8,(5,-1),02F,02D,01C,02B,8,(-3,-1),038, 8,(-3,1),025,2,8,(14,-3),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(17,-18),14,4,2,0 *00074,36,lct 2,14,8,(-6,-21),14,5,8,(5,21),1,8,(0,-17),8,(1,-3),02F,020,2, 8,(-8,14),1,070,2,8,(3,-14),14,6,14,8,(6,-9),0 *00075,46,lcu 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,14),1,0AC,8,(1,-3),02F, 030,021,032,2,0A4,1,0EC,2,8,(4,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4, 2,0 *00076,33,lcv 2,14,8,(-8,-14),14,5,8,(2,14),1,8,(6,-14),2,8,(6,14),1, 8,(-6,-14),2,8,(8,0),14,6,14,8,(8,-9),0 *00077,49,lcw 2,14,8,(-11,-14),14,5,8,(3,14),1,8,(4,-14),2,8,(4,14),1, 8,(-4,-14),2,8,(4,14),1,8,(4,-14),2,8,(4,14),1,8,(-4,-14),2, 8,(7,0),14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0

Sample Files | 379

*00078,43,lcx 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-17,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(3,14),1,8,(11,-14),2,0E4, 1,8,(-11,-14),2,8,(14,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(17,-18),14,4,2,0 *00079,37,lcy 2,14,8,(-8,-14),14,5,8,(2,14),1,8,(6,-14),2,8,(6,14),1, 8,(-6,-14),04B,02A,029,018,2,8,(15,7),14,6,14,8,(8,-16),0 *0007A,47,lcz 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-17,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(14,14),1,8,(-11,-14),2, 0E4,1,0B0,2,8,(-11,-14),1,0B0,2,8,(3,0),14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(17,-18),14,4,2,0 *0007B,54,klbr 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-13,-50),14,4,2,14,5,8,(9,25),1,029,01A,02B,02C, 02D,01E,02D,02C,02A,029,02F,02E,02C,02B,01A,02B,02C,02D,01E,02F, 2,8,(5,7),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(13,-32),14,4,2,0 *0007C,25,kvbar 2,14,8,(-4,-25),14,5,8,(4,25),1,8,(0,-32),2,8,(4,7),14,6, 14,8,(4,-16),0 *0007D,54,krbr 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-15,-50),14,4,2,14,5,8,(5,25),1,02F,01E,02D,02C, 02B,01A,02B,02C,02E,02F,029,02A,02C,02D,01E,02D,02C,02B,01A,029, 2,8,(9,7),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(15,-32),14,4,2,0 *0007E,37,ktlde 2,14,8,(-13,-14),14,5,8,(4,6),1,024,8,(1,3),021,020,02F,8,(4,-3), 02F,020,021,023,024,2,8,(4,-12),14,6,14,8,(13,-9),0 *00080,4,keuroRef 7,020AC,0 *000A0,9,spc 2,8,(21,0),14,8,(-21,-30),0 *000A1,28,kiexc 2,14,8,(-5,-21),14,5,050,1,0E4,2,054,1,012,016,01A,01E,2, 8,(8,-19),14,6,14,8,(5,-9),0 *000A2,43,kcent 2,14,8,(-9,-17),14,5,03E,1,8,(12,20),2,06C,1,026,027,038,029,02A, 8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,8,(3,-3),14,6, 14,8,(9,-9),0 *000A3,37,kpound 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(12,18),1,025,027,029,02B,0FC,03A,0E0,2, 8,(-8,10),1,068,014,060,2,8,(9,-11),14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *000A5,44,kyen 2,14,8,(-12,-21),14,5,8,(1,21),1,8,(8,-10),0BC,2,8,(8,21),1, 8,(-8,-10),2,078,1,0E0,2,8,(-14,-3),1,0E0,2,8,(6,-8),14,6, 14,8,(12,-9),0 *000A7,78,kpar

380 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

2,14,8,(-10,-25),14,5,060,1,012,016,01A,01C,02D,01E,02F,020,021, 012,023,014,025,016,8,(-8,4),016,025,014,023,012,021,010, 8,(8,-4),2,094,028,1,01A,01E,012,014,025,016,027,028,029,01A,02B, 01C,02D,01E,8,(8,-4),01E,02D,01C,02B,01A,029,018,8,(-8,4),2, 8,(16,-9),14,6,14,8,(10,-13),0 *000AA,51,lcau 2,14,8,-7,-21,14,5,8,4,14,3,2,1,0A0,2,054,1,02A,029,028,027,016, 8,-1,3,024,8,1,3,012,021,020,02F,02E,2,034,1,0CC,2,4,2,8,4,-15, 14,6,14,8,7,-9,0 *000AB,25,kfrew 2,14,8,(-9,-14),14,5,0A0,1,076,072,2,050,1,07A,07E,2,030,14,6, 14,8,(9,-9),0 *000B0,25,kdeg 2,14,8,(-3,-21),14,5,8,(1,19),1,10,(2,64),2,8,(8,-19),14,6, 14,8,(3,-9),0 *000B1,39,kpls-min 2,14,8,(-13,-21),14,5,8,(13,21),1,8,(0,-18),2,096,1,8,(18,0),2, 8,(-18,-11),1,8,(18,0),2,8,(4,-1),14,6,14,8,(13,-9),0 *000B5,48,kmicro 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-28),14,4,2,14,5,07C,1,022,8,(3,19),0AC, 8,(1,-3),02F,030,021,032,2,0A4,1,0EC,2,8,(4,0),14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(19,-32),14,4,2,0 *000BA,56,lcou 2,14,8,-7,-21,14,5,8,4,14,3,2,1,0A0,2,8,-4,14,1,028,029,01A,8,-1, -3,02C,8,1,-3,01E,02F,020,021,012,8,1,3,024,8,-1,3,016,027,2,4,2, 8,6,-21,14,6,14,8,7,-9,0 *000BB,25,kffrw 2,14,8,(-9,-14),14,5,030,1,072,076,2,050,1,07E,07A,2,0A0,14,6, 14,8,(9,-9),0 *000BC,43,kquart 2,14,8,(-14,-25),14,5,8,(4,21),1,021,022,0EC,2,8,(-2,-14),1, 8,(16,29),2,8,(2,-23),1,0A8,8,(7,9),0EC,2,8,(7,3),14,6, 14,8,(14,-13),0 *000BD,50,khalf 2,14,8,(-14,-25),14,5,8,(4,21),1,021,022,0EC,2,8,(-2,-14),1, 8,(16,29),2,8,(-6,-18),1,014,023,021,020,02F,02D,01C,02B, 8,(-7,-8),080,2,8,(4,3),14,6,14,8,(14,-13),0 *000BF,47,kiqm 2,14,8,(-9,-21),14,5,8,(13,4),1,016,012,01E,01C,02B,01A,029,038, 8,(-3,1),025,024,023,012,021,022,034,2,054,1,012,016,01A,01E,2, 8,(8,-19),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *000C0,43,uc^ 2,14,8,(-9,-25),14,5,8,(9,23),1,047,2,04E,1,8,(-8,-21),2,

Sample Files | 381

8,(8,21),1,8,(8,-21),2,8,(-13,7),1,0A0,2,8,(4,-7),14,6, 14,8,(9,-9),0 *000C1,43,uc^ 2,14,8,(-9,-25),14,5,8,(9,23),1,041,2,04A,1,8,(-8,-21),2, 8,(8,21),1,8,(8,-21),2,8,(-13,7),1,0A0,2,8,(4,-7),14,6, 14,8,(9,-9),0 *000C2,44,uc 2,14,8,(-9,-25),14,5,8,(5,23),1,041,04F,2,049,1,8,(-8,-21),2, 8,(8,21),1,8,(8,-21),2,8,(-13,7),1,0A0,2,8,(4,-7),14,6, 14,8,(9,-9),0 *000C3,55,uc^ 2,14,8,(-9,-25),14,5,8,(4,22),5,1,023,10,(2,-50),01E,10,(2,82), 023,2,6,8,(5,-1),1,8,(-8,-21),2,8,(8,21),1,8,(8,-21),2,8,(-13,7), 1,0A0,2,8,(4,-7),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *000C4,53,uc„ 2,14,8,(-9,-25),14,5,8,(4,24),1,01E,012,016,01A,2,080,1,01E,012, 016,01A,2,03A,1,8,(-8,-21),2,8,(8,21),1,8,(8,-21),2,8,(-13,7),1, 0A0,2,8,(4,-7),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *000C5,45,uc^ 2,14,8,(-9,-25),14,5,8,(7,23),1,10,(2,64),2,02E,1,8,(-8,-21),2, 8,(8,21),1,8,(8,-21),2,8,(-13,7),1,0A0,2,8,(4,-7),14,6, 14,8,(9,-9),0 *000C6,45,uc^ 2,14,8,(-9,-21),14,5,010,1,8,(8,21),8,(0,-21),080,2,8,(-8,7),1, 058,2,8,(5,4),1,050,2,8,(-5,10),1,080,2,8,(2,-21),14,6, 14,8,(9,-9),0 *000C7,65,uc‡ 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-21,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(18,16),1,025,026,027,048, 029,02A,02B,8,(-1,-3),05C,8,(1,-3),02D,02E,02F,040,021,022,023,2, 8,(-9,-11),1,01E,030,012,024,016,028,034,2,0A0,14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(21,-32),14,4,2,0 *000C8,53,uc^ 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-50),14,4,2,14,5,8,(6,25),1,8,(9,-4),2, 8,(2,-2),1,0D8,8,(0,-19),0D0,2,8,(-13,10),1,080,2,8,(7,-10),14,6, 14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000C9,53,uc^ 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-50),14,4,2,14,5,8,(6,21),1,8,(9,4),2, 8,(2,-6),1,0D8,8,(0,-19),0D0,2,8,(-13,10),1,080,2,8,(7,-10),14,6, 14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000CA,53,uc^ 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-50),14,4,2,14,5,8,(6,23),1,041,010,04F,2, 8,(2,-2),1,0D8,8,(0,-21),0D0,2,8,(-13,11),1,080,2,8,(7,-11),14,6, 14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0

382 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

*000CB,61,uc^ 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-50),14,4,2,14,5,8,(6,24),1,01E,012,016,01A,2, 070,1,01E,012,016,01A,2,8,(4,-3),1,0D8,8,(0,-21),0D0,2, 8,(-13,11),1,080,2,8,(7,-11),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000CC,29,uc^ 2,14,8,(-4,-25),14,5,8,(4,23),1,026,2,04D,1,8,(0,-21),2,8,(4,0), 14,6,14,8,(4,-9),0 *000CD,29,uc^ 2,14,8,(-4,-25),14,5,8,(4,23),1,022,2,04B,1,8,(0,-21),2,8,(4,0), 14,6,14,8,(4,-9),0 *000CE,30,uc^ 2,14,8,(-4,-25),14,5,8,(2,23),1,022,02E,2,02A,1,8,(0,-21),2, 8,(4,0),14,6,14,8,(4,-9),0 *000CF,41,uc^ 2,14,8,(-4,-25),14,5,8,(1,24),1,01E,012,016,01A,2,040,1,01E,012, 016,01A,2,8,(-1,-3),1,8,(0,-21),2,8,(4,0),14,6,14,8,(4,-9),0 *000D1,41,uc 2,14,8,(-11,-25),14,5,040,1,8,(0,19),8,(14,-19),8,(0,19),2, 8,(-13,3),1,032,010,8,(4,-3),010,032,2,8,(5,-25),14,6, 14,8,(11,-9),0 *000D2,44,uc^ 2,14,8,(-11,-25),14,5,8,(6,25),1,08F,2,8,(-6,-2),1,029,02A,04B, 05C,04D,02E,02F,040,021,022,043,054,045,026,027,048,2,8,(13,-19), 14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *000D3,42,uc^ 2,14,8,(-11,-25),14,5,8,(6,21),1,081,2,06A,1,029,02A,04B,05C,04D, 02E,02F,040,021,022,043,054,045,026,027,048,2,8,(13,-19),14,6, 14,8,(11,-9),0 *000D4,57,uc^ 2,14,8,(-11,-25),14,5,8,(6,23),1,041,04F,2,8,(-6,-2),1,029,02A, 02B,8,(-1,-3),05C,8,(1,-3),02D,02E,02F,040,021,022,023,8,(1,3), 054,8,(-1,3),025,026,027,048,2,8,(13,-21),14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *000D5,66,uc^ 2,14,8,(-11,-25),14,5,8,(6,22),5,1,023,10,(2,-50),01E,10,(2,82), 023,2,6,8,(3,-1),1,029,02A,02B,8,(-1,-3),05C,8,(1,-3),02D,02E, 02F,040,021,022,023,8,(1,3),054,8,(-1,3),025,026,027,048,2, 8,(13,-21),14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *000D6,66,uc^ 2,14,8,(-11,-25),14,5,8,(6,24),1,01E,012,016,01A,2,080,1,01E,012, 016,01A,2,8,(-5,-3),1,029,02A,02B,8,(-1,-3),05C,8,(1,-3),02D,02E, 02F,040,021,022,023,8,(1,3),054,8,(-1,3),025,026,027,048,2, 8,(13,-21),14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *000D8,54,uc›

Sample Files | 383

2,14,8,(-11,-21),8,(9,21),1,029,02A,02B,8,(-1,-3),05C,8,(1,-3), 02D,02E,02F,040,021,022,023,8,(1,3),054,8,(-1,3),025,026,027,048, 2,8,(-6,-21),1,8,(16,21),2,8,(3,-21),14,8,(-11,-9),0 *000D9,43,uc^ 2,14,8,(-11,-25),14,5,8,(15,21),1,087,2,06B,1,0DC,8,(1,-3),02E, 8,(3,-1),020,8,(3,1),022,8,(1,3),0D4,2,8,(4,-19),14,6, 14,8,(11,-9),0 *000DA,45,uc^ 2,14,8,(-11,-25),14,5,8,(15,25),1,089,2,8,(-3,-2),1,0DC,8,(1,-3), 02E,8,(3,-1),020,8,(3,1),022,8,(1,3),0D4,2,8,(4,-19),14,6, 14,8,(11,-9),0 *000DB,46,uc^ 2,14,8,(-11,-25),14,5,8,(15,23),1,047,049,2,8,(-3,-2),1,0FC, 8,(1,-3),02E,8,(3,-1),020,8,(3,1),022,8,(1,3),0F4,2,8,(4,-21), 14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *000DC,55,uc^ 2,14,8,(-11,-25),14,5,8,(14,24),1,01E,012,016,01A,2,088,1,01E, 012,016,01A,2,8,(-2,-3),1,0FC,8,(1,-3),02E,8,(3,-1),020,8,(3,1), 022,8,(1,3),0F4,2,8,(4,-21),14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *000DD,38,uc^ 2,14,8,(-9,-25),14,5,8,(13,25),1,089,2,049,1,8,(8,-9),0AC,2, 8,(8,19),1,8,(-8,-9),2,8,(9,-10),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *000DF,53,kgers 2,14,8,(-9,-21),14,5,030,1,012,8,(0,16),023,012,021,020,02F,01E, 02D,02C,02B,01A,029,028,2,020,1,8,(3,-1),01E,02D,03C,02B,01A,029, 028,027,016,012,01E,2,8,(10,-2),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *000E0,63,lc… 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(5,21),1,8,(8,-4),2, 8,(2,-3),1,0EC,2,0B4,1,026,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C, 8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,8,(4,-3),14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000E1,63,lc 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(5,17),1,8,(8,4),2, 8,(2,-7),1,0EC,2,0B4,1,026,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C, 8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,8,(4,-3),14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000E2,64,lc^ 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(5,18),1,8,(4,3),8,(4,-3), 2,04D,1,0EC,2,0B4,1,026,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3), 02E,02F,030,021,022,2,8,(4,-3),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000E3,63,lcƒ 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,18),1,032,010,03E,010,

384 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

032,2,07C,1,0EC,2,0B4,1,026,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C, 8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,8,(4,-3),14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000E4,71,lc„ 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,20),1,01E,012,016,01A,2, 090,1,01E,012,016,01A,2,8,(2,-6),1,0EC,2,0B4,1,026,027,038,029, 02A,8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,8,(4,-3),14,6, 14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000E5,63,lc† 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(7,19),1,10,(2,64),2, 8,(8,-5),1,0EC,2,0B4,1,026,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C, 8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,8,(4,-3),14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000E6,51,lc 2,14,8,(-10,-14),14,5,8,(10,8),1,070,014,8,(-1,3),026,028,02A, 026,028,02A,8,(-1,-3),04C,8,(1,-3),02E,020,022,02E,020,021,023,2, 8,(-7,11),1,0EC,2,0A0,14,6,14,8,(10,-9),0 *000E7,49,lc‡ 2,14,8,(-9,-14),14,5,8,(15,11),1,026,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3), 02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,8,(-8,-9),1,01E,030,012,024, 016,028,034,2,090,14,6,14,8,(9,-16),0 *000E8,48,lcŠ 2,14,8,(-9,-21),14,5,8,(5,21),1,08F,2,8,(-10,-9),1,0C0,024,025, 016,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2, 8,(3,-3),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *000E9,48,lc‚ 2,14,8,(-9,-21),14,5,8,(5,17),1,081,2,8,(-10,-13),1,0C0,024,025, 016,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2, 8,(3,-3),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *000EA,51,lcˆ 2,14,8,(-9,-21),14,5,8,(5,18),1,8,(4,3),8,(4,-3),2,0AA,1,0C0,024, 025,016,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021, 022,2,8,(3,-3),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *000EB,58,lc‰ 2,14,8,(-9,-21),14,5,8,(4,20),1,01E,012,016,01A,2,080,1,01E,012, 016,01A,2,8,(-9,-12),1,0C0,024,025,016,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3), 02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,8,(3,-3),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *000EC,27,lc_ 2,14,8,(-7,-21),14,5,8,(3,21),1,08F,2,04A,1,0DC,2,8,(4,0),14,6, 14,8,(7,-9),0 *000ED,27,lc 2,14,8,(-7,-21),14,5,8,(3,17),1,081,2,08B,1,0DC,2,8,(4,0),14,6, 14,8,(7,-9),0

Sample Files | 385

*000EE,34,lcŒ 2,14,8,(-7,-21),14,5,8,(3,18),1,8,(4,3),8,(4,-3),2,8,(-4,-5),1, 0DC,2,8,(4,0),14,6,14,8,(7,-9),0 *000EF,39,lc‹ 2,14,8,(-7,-21),14,5,8,(3,20),1,01E,012,016,01A,2,060,1,01E,012, 016,01A,2,8,(-2,-7),1,0DC,2,8,(4,0),14,6,14,8,(7,-9),0 *000F1,56,lc 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,18),1,032,010,03E,010, 032,2,8,(-11,-7),1,0EC,2,0A4,1,032,021,030,02F,8,(1,-3),0AC,2, 8,(4,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000F2,64,lc• 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(5,21),1,8,(9,-4),2,069,1, 029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,8,(1,3),024, 8,(-1,3),026,027,038,2,8,(11,-14),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4, 2,0 *000F3,66,lc 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(5,17),1,8,(9,4),2, 8,(-6,-7),1,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022, 8,(1,3),024,8,(-1,3),026,027,038,2,8,(11,-14),14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000F4,73,lc“ 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(5,18),3,2,1,8,(9,6), 8,(9,-6),2,4,2,8,(-6,-4),1,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E, 02F,030,021,022,8,(1,3),024,8,(-1,3),026,027,038,2,8,(11,-14), 14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000F5,68,lc^ 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,18),1,032,010,03E,010, 032,2,8,(-7,-7),1,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021, 022,8,(1,3),024,8,(-1,3),026,027,038,2,8,(11,-14),14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000F6,74,lc” 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,20),1,01E,012,016,01A,2, 090,1,01E,012,016,01A,2,8,(-5,-6),1,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C, 8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,8,(1,3),024,8,(-1,3),026,027,038,2, 8,(11,-14),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000F7,41,kto 2,14,8,(-9,-14),14,5,8,(8,13),1,01E,012,016,01A,2,8,(-5,-6),1, 0C0,2,8,(-7,-6),1,01E,012,016,01A,2,8,(10,-1),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *000F8,24,lc› 7,06F,2,8,(-3,14),14,8,(9,9),1,8,(-13,-14),2,8,(17,0), 14,8,(-10,-9),0 *000F9,54,lc— 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(5,21),1,8,(9,-4),2,

386 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

8,(-10,-3),1,0AC,8,(1,-3),02F,030,021,032,2,0A4,1,0EC,2,8,(4,0), 14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000FA,54,lc 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(5,17),1,8,(9,4),2, 8,(-10,-7),1,0AC,8,(1,-3),02F,030,021,032,2,0A4,1,0EC,2,8,(4,0), 14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000FB,61,lc2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(5,18),3,2,1,8,(9,6), 8,(9,-6),4,2,2,8,(-10,-4),1,0AC,8,(1,-3),02F,030,021,032,2,0A4,1, 0EC,2,8,(4,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000FC,62,lc_ 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,20),1,01E,012,016,01A,2, 090,1,01E,012,016,01A,2,8,(-9,-6),1,0AC,8,(1,-3),02F,030,021,032, 2,0A4,1,0EC,2,8,(4,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *000FD,43,lc^ 2,14,8,(-8,-14),14,5,8,(2,14),5,032,1,8,(9,4),6,8,(6,-14),2, 8,(6,14),1,8,(-6,-14),04B,02A,029,018,2,8,(15,7),14,6, 14,8,(8,-16),0 *000FF,53,lc˜ 2,14,8,(-8,-21),14,5,8,(3,20),1,01E,012,016,01A,2,080,1,01E,012, 016,01A,2,8,(-9,-6),1,8,(6,-14),2,8,(6,14),1,8,(-6,-14),04B,02A, 029,018,2,8,(15,7),14,6,14,8,(8,-16),0 *00104,50,c164 2,14,8,(-9,-21),14,5,8,(9,21),1,8,(-8,-21),2,8,(8,21),1, 8,(8,-21),3,2,10,(5,36),1,10,(5,-100),4,2,2,8,(-13,7),1,0A0,2, 8,(4,-7),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *00105,66,c165 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(15,14),1,0EC,3,2,10, (5,36),2,10,(5,-100),4,2,2,0B4,1,026,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3), 02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,8,(4,-3),14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *00106,71,c143 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-21,-42),14,4,2,14,5,3,2,2,8,(18,48),1,8,(8,6),2, 8,(-26,-54),4,2,8,(18,16),1,025,026,027,048,029,02A,02B, 8,(-1,-3),05C,8,(1,-3),02D,02E,02F,040,021,022,023,2,8,(3,-5), 14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(21,-18),14,4,2,0 *00107,54,c134 2,14,8,(-9,-14),14,5,8,(15,11),3,2,8,(-15,10),1,8,(6,4),2, 8,(9,-14),4,2,1,026,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E, 02F,030,021,022,2,8,(3,-3),14,6,14,8,(9,-9),0 *0010C,49,c172 2,14,8,(-11,-27),8,(18,16),1,025,026,027,048,029,02A,02B, 8,(-1,-3),05C,8,(1,-3),02D,02E,02F,040,021,022,023,2,8,(-7,18),1,

Sample Files | 387

042,2,04A,1,046,2,8,(14,-27),14,8,(-10,-9),0 *0010D,41,c159 2,14,8,(-9,-20),0F0,0B4,1,026,027,038,029,02A,8,(-1,-3),02C, 8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,068,0D4,1,042,2,04A,1,046,2, 8,(13,-20),14,09A,0 *0010E,53,c210 2,14,8,(-11,-27),8,(4,21),1,0FC,06C,2,0F4,064,1,070,8,(3,-1),02E, 02D,8,(1,-3),05C,8,(-1,-3),02B,02A,8,(-3,-1),078,2,8,(7,23),1, 042,2,04A,1,046,2,8,(14,-27),14,8,(-10,-9),0 *0010F,46,c212 2,14,8,(-10,-21),8,(15,21),1,0FC,06C,2,0B4,1,026,027,038,029,02A, 8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,8,(4,18),1, 8,(-3,-4),2,8,(3,-17),14,09A,0 *00118,66,c168 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,21),1,8,(0,-21),2, 8,(0,21),1,0D0,2,8,(-13,-10),1,080,2,8,(-8,-11),1,0D0,3,2,10, (5,36),1,10,(5,-100),4,2,2,8,(2,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18), 14,4,2,0 *00119,66,c169 2,14,8,(-9,-14),14,5,8,(3,8),1,0C0,024,025,016,027,038,029,02A, 8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,3,2,10,(5,36),2,10,(5,-100),1, 4,2,021,022,2,3,2,10,(5,36),2,10,(5,-100),4,2,2,8,(3,-3),14,6, 14,8,(9,-9),0 *0011A,43,c183 2,14,8,(-10,-27),8,(4,21),1,0FC,06C,2,0F4,064,1,0D0,2,0D8,0AC,1, 080,2,088,0BC,1,0D0,2,8,(-7,23),1,042,2,04A,1,046,2,8,(13,-27), 14,09A,0 *0011B,44,c216 2,14,8,(-9,-20),030,084,1,0C0,024,025,016,027,038,029,02A, 8,(-1,-3),02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,2,068,0D4,1,042,2,04A, 1,046,2,8,(13,-20),14,09A,0 *00141,51,c157 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-17,-42),14,4,2,14,5,8,(3,21),1,8,(0,-21),2, 8,(-1,11),1,8,(7,8),2,8,(-6,-19),1,0C0,2,8,(3,0),14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(17,-18),14,4,2,0 *00142,33,c136 2,14,8,(-4,-21),14,5,8,(5,21),1,8,(0,-21),2,8,(-1,10),1,8,(4,6), 2,8,(3,-16),14,6,14,8,(4,-9),0 *00143,52,c227 2,14,8,(-11,-21),14,5,8,(4,21),8,(5,3),1,8,(4,3),2,8,(-9,-6),1, 8,(0,-21),2,8,(0,21),1,8,(14,-21),2,8,(0,21),1,8,(0,-21),2,

388 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

8,(4,0),14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *00144,57,c228 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,14),8,(4,2),1,8,(3,2),2, 8,(-7,-4),1,0EC,2,0A4,1,032,021,030,02F,8,(1,-3),0AC,2,8,(4,0), 14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *00147,38,c213 2,14,8,(-11,-27),8,(4,21),1,0FC,06C,2,0F4,064,1,8,(14,-21),0F4, 064,2,078,024,1,042,2,04A,1,046,2,8,(15,-27),14,8,(-11,-9),0 *00148,37,c229 2,14,8,(-10,-20),040,0E4,1,0EC,2,0A4,1,032,021,030,02F,8,(1,-3), 0AC,2,8,(-5,16),1,042,2,04A,1,046,2,8,(13,-20),14,09A,0 *00150,58,c138 2,14,8,(-11,-21),14,5,8,(9,21),1,029,02A,02B,8,(-1,-3),05C, 8,(1,-3),02D,02E,02F,040,021,022,023,8,(1,3),054,8,(-1,3),025, 026,027,048,2,034,1,044,2,040,1,04C,2,8,(9,-24),14,6, 14,8,(11,-9),0 *00151,68,c139 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(8,14),1,029,02A,8,(-1,-3), 02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,8,(1,3),024,8,(-1,3),026,027, 038,2,8,(4,4),1,044,2,058,1,04C,2,8,(12,-18),14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(19,-18),14,4,2,0 *00158,53,c252 2,14,8,(-11,-27),8,(4,21),1,0FC,06C,2,0F4,064,1,090,8,(3,-1),01E, 02D,02C,02B,01A,8,(-3,-1),098,2,070,1,8,(7,-11),2,8,(-7,23),1, 042,2,04A,1,046,2,8,(14,-27),14,8,(-10,-9),0 *00159,35,c253 2,14,8,(-7,-20),040,0E4,1,0EC,2,084,1,8,(1,3),022,021,030,2,058, 024,1,042,2,04A,1,046,2,0FD,05D,14,8,(-6,-9),0 *0015A,62,c151 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(17,18),8,(-9,6),1,8,(4,3),2,8,(5,-9),1, 026,8,(-3,1),048,8,(-3,-1),02A,02C,02D,01E,02F,8,(6,-2),02F,01E, 02D,03C,02A,8,(-3,-1),048,8,(-3,1),026,2,8,(17,-3),14,6, 14,8,(10,-9),0 *0015B,71,c152 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-17,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(14,11),8,(-7,5),1,8,(3,2), 2,8,(4,-7),1,025,8,(-3,1),038,8,(-3,-1),02B,02D,02F,8,(5,-1),02F, 02D,01C,02B,8,(-3,-1),038,8,(-3,1),025,2,8,(14,-3),14,6,14,3,2, 14,8,(17,-18),14,4,2,0 *00160,57,c230 2,14,8,(-10,-27),8,(17,18),1,026,8,(-3,1),048,8,(-3,-1),02A,02C, 02D,01E,02F,8,(6,-2),02F,01E,02D,03C,02A,8,(-3,-1),048,8,(-3,1), 026,2,8,(7,20),1,042,2,04A,1,046,2,8,(14,-27),14,8,(-10,-9),0

Sample Files | 389

*00161,52,c231 2,14,8,(-9,-20),0E0,0B4,1,025,8,(-3,1),038,8,(-3,-1),02B,02D,02F, 8,(5,-1),02F,02D,01C,02B,8,(-3,-1),038,8,(-3,1),025,2,060,0D4,1, 042,2,04A,1,046,2,8,(12,-20),14,8,(-8,-9),0 *00164,35,c155 2,14,8,(-8,-27),8,(8,21),1,0FC,06C,2,8,(-7,21),1,0E0,2,078,024,1, 042,2,04A,1,046,2,8,(12,-27),14,8,(-8,-9),0 *00165,36,c156 2,14,8,(-6,-21),8,(5,21),1,0FC,02C,8,(1,-3),02F,020,2,088,0E4,1, 070,2,074,1,8,(-3,-4),2,8,(6,-17),14,8,(-6,-9),0 *0016E,45,c222 2,14,8,(-11,-27),8,(4,21),1,0FC,8,(1,-3),02E,8,(3,-1),020, 8,(3,1),022,8,(1,3),0F4,2,078,024,1,021,024,027,029,02C,02F,2, 8,(11,-23),14,8,(-11,-9),0 *0016F,38,c133 2,14,8,(-10,-20),040,0E4,1,0AC,8,(1,-3),02F,030,021,032,2,0A4,1, 0EC,2,8,(-5,16),1,021,024,027,029,02C,02F,2,8,(9,-16),14,09A,0 *00170,52,c235 2,14,8,(-11,-21),14,5,8,(4,21),1,0FC,8,(1,-3),02E,8,(3,-1),020, 8,(3,1),022,8,(1,3),0F4,2,058,034,1,044,2,048,1,04C,2,8,(9,-2),2, 8,(4,-22),14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *00171,60,c251 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(4,14),1,0AC,8,(1,-3),02F, 030,021,032,2,0A4,1,0EC,2,8,(-8,18),1,044,2,050,1,04C,2, 8,(3,-18),2,8,(4,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-20),14,4,2,0 *00179,45,c141 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(17,21),1,8,(-14,-21),2,8,(5,24),1, 8,(4,3),2,8,(-9,-6),1,0E0,2,8,(-14,-21),1,0E0,2,8,(3,0),14,6, 14,8,(10,-9),0 *0017A,58,c171 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-17,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(14,14),8,(-7,2),1,8,(3,2), 2,8,(4,-4),1,8,(-11,-14),2,0E4,1,0B0,2,8,(-11,-14),1,0B0,2, 8,(3,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(17,-18),14,4,2,0 *0017B,45,c189 2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,8,(17,21),5,3,2,8,(-13,6),1,10,(2,96),4,2, 6,1,8,(-14,-21),0E0,2,8,(-14,21),1,0E0,2,8,(3,-21),14,6, 14,8,(10,-9),0 *0017C,59,c190 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-17,-28),14,4,2,14,5,8,(14,14),5,3,2,8,(-11,5),1, 10,(1,96),4,2,6,8,(-11,-14),2,0E4,1,0B0,2,8,(-11,-14),1,0B0,2, 8,(3,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(17,-18),14,4,2,0 *0017D,42,c166

390 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

2,14,8,(-10,-27),8,(17,21),1,8,(-14,-21),2,0F4,064,1,0E0,2, 8,(-14,-21),1,0E0,2,8,(-7,23),1,042,2,04A,1,046,2,8,(14,-27), 14,8,(-10,-9),0 *0017E,38,c167 2,14,8,(-9,-20),0E2,1,8,(-11,-14),2,0E4,1,0B0,2,0B8,0EC,1,0B0,2, 8,(-5,16),1,042,2,04A,1,046,2,8,(12,-20),14,8,(-8,-9),0 *00410,38,_ 2,14,8,(-9,-21),2,8,(4,7),1,9,(10,0),(0,0),2,8,(-13,-7),1,9, (8,21),(8,-21),(0,0),2,8,(1,0),1,2,14,8,(-9,-9),0 *00411,46,_ 2,14,8,(-10,-21),2,8,(15,21),1,9,(-11,0),(0,-21),(9,0),(3,1), (1,1),(1,2),(0,3),(-1,2),(-1,1),(-3,1),(-9,0),(0,0),2,8,(17,-11), 1,2,14,8,(-11,-9),0 *00412,68,‚ 2,14,8,(-11,-21),2,8,(13,21),1,9,(-9,0),(0,-21),(9,0),(3,1), (1,1),(1,2),(0,3),(-1,2),(-1,1),(-3,1),(-9,0),(0,0),2,8,(9,10),1, 9,(3,-1),(1,-1),(1,-2),(0,-2),(-1,-2),(-1,-1),(-3,-1),(0,0),2, 8,(9,-11),1,2,14,8,(-11,-9),0 *00413,28,ƒ 2,14,8,(-8,-21),2,8,(16,21),1,9,(-12,0),(0,-21),(0,0),2,8,(13,0), 1,2,14,8,(-9,-9),0 *00414,50,„ 2,14,8,(-12,-21),2,8,(22,-4),1,9,(0,4),(-20,0),(0,-4),(0,0),2, 8,(2,4),1,9,(3,3),(1,2),(1,4),(0,12),(11,0),(0,-21),(0,0),2, 8,(4,0),1,2,14,8,(-12,-13),0 *00415,40,… 2,14,8,(-9,-21),2,8,(17,21),1,9,(-13,0),(0,-21),(13,0),(0,0),2, 8,(-1,11),1,9,(-12,0),(0,0),2,8,(15,-11),1,2,14,8,(-10,-9),0 *00416,66,† 2,14,8,(-12,-21),2,8,(1,0),1,9,(9,12),(0,0),2,8,(2,9),1,9, (0,-21),(0,0),2,8,(11,21),1,9,(-11,-11),(0,0),2,8,(-11,11),1,9, (11,-11),(0,0),2,8,(11,-10),1,9,(-9,12),(0,0),2,8,(10,-12),1,2, 14,8,(-12,-9),0 *00417,68,‡ 2,14,8,(-9,-21),2,8,(3,20),1,9,(4,1),(3,0),(3,-1),(1,-2),(0,-2), (-1,-2),(-3,-2),(3,-1),(2,-2),(1,-2),(0,-2),(-1,-2),(-2,-2), (-3,-1),(-3,0),(-3,1),(-3,2),(0,0),2,8,(9,9),1,9,(-4,0),(0,0),2, 8,(12,-12),1,2,14,8,(-9,-9),0 *00418,30,ˆ 2,14,8,(-11,-21),2,8,(4,21),1,9,(0,-21),(14,21),(0,-21),(0,0),2, 8,(4,0),1,2,14,8,(-11,-9),0 *00419,48,‰

Sample Files | 391

2,14,8,(-11,-21),2,8,(4,21),1,9,(0,-21),(14,21),(0,-21),(0,0),2, 8,(-11,26),1,9,(1,-1),(2,-1),(2,0),(2,1),(1,1),(0,0),2,8,(7,-26), 1,2,14,8,(-11,-9),0 *0041A,46,Š 2,14,8,(-10,-21),2,8,(18,0),1,9,(-9,12),(0,0),2,8,(9,9),1,9, (-14,-14),(0,0),2,8,(0,14),1,9,(0,-21),(0,0),2,8,(16,0),1,2, 14,8,(-10,-9),0 *0041B,36,‹ 2,14,8,(-10,-21),2,8,(16,0),1,9,(0,21),(-11,0),(0,-17),(-1,-2), (-1,-1),(-2,-1),(0,0),2,8,(19,0),1,2,14,8,(-10,-9),0 *0041C,32,Œ 2,14,8,(-12,-21),2,8,(20,0),1,9,(0,21),(-8,-15),(-8,15),(0,-21), (0,0),2,8,(20,0),1,2,14,8,(-12,-9),0 *0041D,46,_ 2,14,8,(-11,-21),2,8,(4,21),1,9,(0,-21),(0,0),2,8,(0,11),1,9, (14,0),(0,0),2,8,(0,-11),1,9,(0,21),(0,0),2,8,(4,-21),1,2, 14,8,(-11,-9),0 *0041E,64,_ 2,14,8,(-11,-21),2,8,(9,21),1,9,(4,0),(2,-1),(2,-2),(1,-2), (1,-3),(0,-5),(-1,-3),(-1,-2),(-2,-2),(-2,-1),(-4,0),(-2,1), (-2,2),(-1,2),(-1,3),(0,5),(1,3),(1,2),(2,2),(2,1),(0,0),2, 8,(13,-21),1,2,14,8,(-11,-9),0 *0041F,30,_ 2,14,8,(-11,-21),2,8,(4,0),1,9,(0,21),(14,0),(0,-21),(0,0),2, 8,(4,0),1,2,14,8,(-11,-9),0 *00420,44,_ 2,14,8,(-10,-21),2,8,(4,0),1,9,(0,21),(9,0),(3,-1),(1,-1),(1,-2), (0,-3),(-1,-2),(-1,-1),(-3,-1),(-9,0),(0,0),2,8,(16,-10),1,2, 14,8,(-10,-9),0 *00421,62,' 2,14,8,(-10,-21),2,8,(18,16),1,9,(-1,2),(-1,1),(-1,1),(-2,1), (-4,0),(-2,-1),(-1,-1),(-1,-1),(-1,-2),(-1,-3),(0,-5),(1,-3), (1,-2),(2,-2),(2,-1),(4,0),(2,1),(2,2),(1,2),(0,0),2,8,(2,-5),1, 2,14,8,(-10,-9),0 *00422,36,' 2,14,8,(-8,-21),2,8,(8,21),1,9,(0,-21),(0,0),2,8,(-7,21),1,9, (14,0),(0,0),2,8,(1,-21),1,2,14,8,(-8,-9),0 *00423,44,“ 2,14,8,(-8,-21),2,8,(15,21),1,9,(-7,-17),(-1,-2),(-1,-1),(-2,-1), (-1,0),(0,0),2,8,(-2,21),1,9,(7,-17),(0,0),2,8,(8,-4),1,2, 14,8,(-8,-9),0 *00424,74,” 2,14,8,(-13,-21),2,8,(11,19),1,9,(4,0),(3,-1),(2,-1),(2,-2),

392 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

(1,-2),(0,-4),(-1,-2),(-2,-2),(-2,-1),(-3,-1),(-4,0),(-3,1), (-2,1),(-2,2),(-1,2),(0,4),(1,2),(2,2),(2,1),(3,1),(0,0),2, 8,(2,2),1,9,(0,-21),(0,0),2,8,(13,0),1,2,14,8,(-13,-9),0 *00425,36,• 2,14,8,(-8,-21),2,8,(15,21),1,9,(-14,-21),(0,0),2,8,(0,21),1,9, (14,-21),(0,0),2,8,(1,0),1,2,14,8,(-8,-9),0 *00426,40,2,14,8,(-11,-21),2,8,(4,21),1,9,(0,-21),(16,0),(0,-4),(0,0),2, 8,(-2,25),1,9,(0,-21),(0,0),2,8,(4,0),1,2,14,8,(-11,-13),0 *00427,44,— 2,14,8,(-10,-21),2,8,(3,21),1,9,(0,-8),(1,-3),(1,-1),(3,-1), (9,0),(0,0),2,8,(0,13),1,9,(0,-21),(0,0),2,8,(4,0),1,2, 14,8,(-11,-9),0 *00428,40,˜ 2,14,8,(-14,-21),2,8,(4,21),1,9,(0,-21),(21,0),(0,21),(0,0),2, 8,(-10,0),1,9,(0,-21),(0,0),2,8,(14,0),1,2,14,8,(-15,-9),0 *00429,50,™ 2,14,8,(-14,-21),2,8,(4,21),1,9,(0,-21),(23,0),(0,-4),(0,0),2, 8,(-12,25),1,9,(0,-21),(0,0),2,8,(10,21),1,9,(0,-21),(0,0),2, 8,(4,0),1,2,14,8,(-15,-13),0 *0042A,48,š 2,14,8,(-10,-21),2,8,(1,21),1,9,(4,0),(0,-21),(8,0),(2,0),(2,1), (1,1),(1,2),(0,4),(-1,2),(-1,1),(-2,1),(-10,0),(0,0),2, 8,(16,-12),1,2,14,8,(-11,-9),0 *0042B,54,› 2,14,8,(-12,-21),2,8,(4,21),1,9,(0,-21),(9,0),(2,1),(1,1),(1,2), (0,4),(-1,2),(-1,1),(-2,1),(-9,0),(0,0),2,8,(16,9),1,9,(0,-21), (0,0),2,8,(4,0),1,2,14,8,(-12,-9),0 *0042C,44,œ 2,14,8,(-10,-21),2,8,(4,21),1,9,(0,-21),(10,0),(2,1),(1,1),(1,2), (0,4),(-1,2),(-1,1),(-2,1),(-10,0),(0,0),2,8,(16,-12),1,2, 14,8,(-10,-9),0 *0042D,64,_ 2,14,8,(-9,-21),2,8,(6,11),1,9,(10,0),(0,0),2,8,(-14,7),1,9, (2,2),(2,1),(4,0),(2,-1),(2,-2),(1,-2),(1,-3),(0,-5),(-1,-3), (-1,-2),(-2,-2),(-2,-1),(-4,0),(-2,1),(-2,2),(0,0),2,8,(17,-3),1, 2,14,8,(-10,-9),0 *0042E,76,_ 2,14,8,(-13,-21),2,8,(14,21),1,9,(4,0),(2,-1),(2,-3),(1,-4), (0,-5),(-1,-4),(-2,-3),(-2,-1),(-4,0),(-2,1),(-2,3),(-1,4),(0,5), (1,4),(2,3),(2,1),(0,0),2,8,(-5,-10),1,9,(-5,0),(0,0),2,8,(0,10), 1,9,(0,-21),(0,0),2,8,(22,0),1,2,14,8,(-13,-9),0 *0042F,54,Ÿ

Sample Files | 393

2,14,8,(-10,-21),2,8,(2,0),1,9,(7,11),(0,0),2,8,(7,-11),1,9, (0,21),(-9,0),(-3,-1),(-1,-1),(-1,-2),(0,-2),(1,-2),(1,-1), (3,-1),(9,0),(0,0),2,8,(4,-11),1,2,14,8,(-10,-9),0 *00430,62, 2,14,8,(-9,-14),2,8,(15,3),1,9,(-2,-2),(-2,-1),(-3,0),(-2,1), (-1,1),(-1,1),(-1,3),(0,2),(1,3),(2,2),(2,1),(3,0),(2,-1),(2,-2), (0,0),2,8,(0,3),1,9,(0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(4,0),1,2,14,8,(-10,-9),0 *00431,64, 2,14,8,(-9,-21),2,8,(14,21),1,9,(-2,-1),(-5,-1),(-2,-1),(-1,-2), (0,-12),(1,-2),(1,-1),(2,-1),(3,0),(2,1),(2,2),(1,3),(0,2), (-1,3),(-1,1),(-1,1),(-2,1),(-3,0),(-2,-1),(-2,-2),(0,0),2, 8,(15,-11),1,2,14,8,(-10,-9),0 *00432,68, 2,14,8,(-9,-21),2,8,(4,11),1,9,(2,2),(2,1),(3,2),(1,2),(-1,2), (-1,1),(-3,0),(-2,-1),(-1,-1),(0,-15),(1,-2),(1,-1),(2,-1),(3,0), (2,1),(2,2),(1,3),(0,2),(-1,3),(-2,2),(-2,1),(-3,0),(0,0),2, 8,(11,-14),1,2,14,8,(-10,-9),0 *00433,56, 2,14,8,(-8,-14),2,8,(3,11),1,9,(1,2),(3,1),(3,0),(3,-1),(1,-2), (-1,-2),(-2,-1),(-5,-1),(-2,-1),(-1,-2),(0,-1),(1,-2),(3,-1), (3,0),(3,1),(1,2),(0,0),2,8,(3,-3),1,2,14,8,(-9,-9),0 *00434,72, 2,14,8,(-9,-14),2,8,(15,11),1,9,(-1,1),(-1,1),(-2,1),(-3,0), (-2,-1),(-2,-2),(-1,-3),(0,-2),(1,-3),(2,-2),(2,-1),(3,0),(2,1), (2,2),(0,0),2,8,(0,11),1,9,(0,-16),(-1,-3),(-1,-1),(-2,-1), (-3,0),(-2,1),(0,0),2,8,(13,6),1,2,14,8,(-10,-16),0 *00435,56, 2,14,8,(-9,-14),2,8,(3,8),1,9,(12,0),(0,2),(-1,2),(-1,1),(-2,1), (-3,0),(-2,-1),(-2,-2),(-1,-3),(0,-2),(1,-3),(2,-2),(2,-1),(3,0), (2,1),(2,2),(0,0),2,8,(3,-3),1,2,14,8,(-9,-9),0 *00436,58, 2,14,8,(-11,-14),2,8,(1,0),1,9,(7,8),(0,0),2,8,(12,6),1,9, (-9,-9),(-9,9),(0,0),2,8,(9,0),1,9,(0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(3,8),1,9, (7,-8),(0,0),2,8,(1,0),1,2,14,8,(-11,-9),0 *00437,62, 2,14,8,(-7,-14),2,8,(8,8),1,9,(2,-1),(1,-1),(1,-2),(-1,-2), (-1,-1),(-2,-1),(-4,0),(-3,1),(0,0),2,8,(0,12),1,9,(3,1),(3,0), (3,-1),(1,-2),(-1,-2),(-2,-1),(-3,0),(0,0),2,8,(9,-8),1,2, 14,8,(-7,-9),0 *00438,46, 2,14,8,(-9,-14),2,8,(4,14),1,9,(0,-10),(1,-3),(2,-1),(3,0),(2,1), (3,3),(0,0),2,8,(0,10),1,9,(0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(4,0),1,2, 14,8,(-10,-9),0

394 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

*00439,64, 2,14,8,(-9,-14),2,8,(4,14),1,9,(0,-10),(1,-3),(2,-1),(3,0),(2,1), (3,3),(0,0),2,8,(0,10),1,9,(0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(-9,18),1,9,(1,-1), (2,-1),(2,0),(2,1),(1,1),(0,0),2,8,(5,-18),1,2,14,8,(-10,-9),0 *0043A,46, 2,14,8,(-8,-14),2,8,(4,14),1,9,(0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(4,8),1,9, (7,-8),(0,0),2,8,(-1,14),1,9,(-10,-10),(0,0),2,8,(12,-4),1,2, 14,8,(-8,-9),0 *0043B,44, 2,14,8,(-9,-14),2,8,(14,14),1,9,(-6,0),(0,-10),(-1,-3),(-2,-1), (-2,0),(0,0),2,8,(11,14),1,9,(0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(4,0),1,2, 14,8,(-9,-9),0 *0043C,32, 2,14,8,(-11,-14),2,8,(18,0),1,9,(0,14),(-7,-11),(-7,11),(0,-14), (0,0),2,8,(18,0),1,2,14,8,(-11,-9),0 *0043D,46,2,14,8,(-9,-14),2,8,(4,7),1,9,(11,0),(0,0),2,8,(0,7),1,9,(0,-14), (0,0),2,8,(-11,14),1,9,(0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(15,0),1,2, 14,8,(-10,-9),0 *0043E,56, 2,14,8,(-9,-14),2,8,(8,14),1,9,(3,0),(2,-1),(2,-2),(1,-3),(0,-2), (-1,-3),(-2,-2),(-2,-1),(-3,0),(-2,1),(-2,2),(-1,3),(0,2),(1,3), (2,2),(2,1),(0,0),2,8,(11,-14),1,2,14,8,(-10,-9),0 *0043F,46, 2,14,8,(-9,-14),2,8,(4,14),1,9,(0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(0,10),1,9, (3,3),(2,1),(3,0),(2,-1),(1,-2),(0,-11),(0,0),2,8,(4,0),1,2, 14,8,(-10,-9),0 *00440,60, 2,14,8,(-9,-14),2,8,(4,14),1,9,(0,-21),(0,0),2,8,(0,18),1,9, (2,2),(2,1),(3,0),(2,-1),(2,-2),(1,-3),(0,-2),(-1,-3),(-2,-2), (-2,-1),(-3,0),(-2,1),(-2,2),(0,0),2,8,(15,-3),1,2, 14,8,(-10,-16),0 *00441,50, 2,14,8,(-8,-14),2,8,(15,11),1,9,(-2,2),(-2,1),(-3,0),(-2,-1), (-2,-2),(-1,-3),(0,-2),(1,-3),(2,-2),(2,-1),(3,0),(2,1),(2,2), (0,0),2,8,(2,-3),1,2,14,8,(-9,-9),0 *00442,66, 2,14,8,(-14,-14),2,8,(4,14),1,9,(0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(0,10),1,9, (3,3),(2,1),(2,0),(2,-1),(1,-3),(0,-10),(0,0),2,8,(0,10),1,9, (3,3),(2,1),(2,0),(2,-1),(1,-3),(0,-10),(0,0),2,8,(4,0),1,2, 14,8,(-14,-9),0 *00443,44,

Sample Files | 395

2,14,8,(-7,-14),2,8,(1,14),1,9,(6,-14),(0,0),2,8,(6,14),1,9, (-6,-14),(-2,-4),(-2,-2),(-2,-1),(-1,0),(0,0),2,8,(14,7),1,2, 14,8,(-7,-16),0 *00444,66, 2,14,8,(-11,-14),2,8,(14,14),1,9,(-6,0),(-2,-1),(-2,-2),(-1,-3), (0,-2),(1,-3),(2,-2),(2,-1),(6,0),(2,1),(2,2),(1,3),(0,2),(-1,3), (-2,2),(-2,1),(0,0),2,8,(-3,0),1,9,(0,-21),(0,0),2,8,(11,7),1,2, 14,8,(-11,-16),0 *00445,36, 2,14,8,(-6,-14),2,8,(1,14),1,9,(11,-14),(0,0),2,8,(0,14),1,9, (-11,-14),(0,0),2,8,(12,0),1,2,14,8,(-7,-9),0 *00446,50, 2,14,8,(-9,-14),2,8,(4,14),1,9,(0,-10),(1,-3),(2,-1),(3,0),(2,1), (3,3),(0,0),2,8,(0,10),1,9,(0,-14),(2,0),(0,-3),(0,0),2,8,(2,3), 1,2,14,8,(-10,-12),0 *00447,46, 2,14,8,(-9,-14),2,8,(3,14),1,9,(0,-5),(1,-3),(2,-1),(3,0),(2,1), (3,3),(0,0),2,8,(0,5),1,9,(0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(4,0),1,2, 14,8,(-9,-9),0 *00448,66, 2,14,8,(-14,-14),2,8,(24,0),1,9,(0,14),(0,0),2,8,(0,-10),1,9, (-3,-3),(-2,-1),(-2,0),(-2,1),(-1,3),(0,10),(0,0),2,8,(0,-10),1, 9,(-3,-3),(-2,-1),(-2,0),(-2,1),(-1,3),(0,10),(0,0),2,8,(24,-14), 1,2,14,8,(-14,-9),0 *00449,70, 2,14,8,(-14,-14),2,8,(14,4),1,9,(-3,-3),(-2,-1),(-2,0),(-2,1), (-1,3),(0,10),(0,0),2,8,(20,-10),1,9,(-3,-3),(-2,-1),(-2,0), (-2,1),(-1,3),(0,10),(0,0),2,8,(10,0),1,9,(0,-14),(2,0),(0,-3), (0,0),2,8,(2,3),1,2,14,8,(-14,-12),0 *0044A,64, 2,14,8,(-9,-14),2,8,(4,8),1,9,(1,1),(2,1),(3,0),(1,0),(2,-1), (1,-1),(1,-2),(0,-2),(-1,-2),(-1,-1),(-2,-1),(-4,0),(-2,1), (-1,1),(0,0),2,8,(-3,12),1,9,(3,0),(0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(14,0),1,2, 14,8,(-9,-9),0 *0044B,72, 2,14,8,(-10,-14),2,8,(4,8),1,9,(1,1),(2,1),(3,0),(1,0),(2,-1), (1,-1),(1,-2),(0,-2),(-1,-2),(-1,-1),(-2,-1),(-4,0),(-2,1), (-1,1),(0,0),2,8,(0,12),1,9,(0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(13,14),1,9, (0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(4,0),1,2,14,8,(-11,-9),0 *0044C,62, 2,14,8,(-9,-14),2,8,(4,8),1,9,(1,1),(2,1),(3,0),(1,0),(2,-1), (1,-1),(1,-2),(0,-2),(-1,-2),(-1,-1),(-2,-1),(-4,0),(-2,1), (-1,1),(0,0),2,8,(0,12),1,9,(0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(14,0),1,2,

396 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

14,8,(-9,-9),0 *0044D,60, 2,14,8,(-8,-14),2,8,(2,11),1,9,(2,2),(2,1),(3,0),(2,-1),(2,-2), (1,-3),(0,-2),(-1,-3),(-2,-2),(-2,-1),(-3,0),(-2,1),(-2,2),(0,0), 2,8,(12,4),1,9,(-6,0),(0,0),2,8,(9,-7),1,2,14,8,(-9,-9),0 *0044E,70, 2,14,8,(-12,-14),2,8,(4,14),1,9,(0,-14),(0,0),2,8,(0,7),1,9, (5,0),(0,1),(1,3),(2,2),(2,1),(2,0),(2,-1),(2,-2),(1,-3),(0,-2), (-1,-3),(-2,-2),(-2,-1),(-2,0),(-2,1),(-2,2),(-1,3),(0,1),(0,0), 2,8,(15,-7),1,2,14,8,(-12,-9),0 *0044F,54, 2,14,8,(-8,-14),2,8,(3,0),1,9,(4,5),(0,0),2,8,(6,-5),1,9,(0,14), (-6,0),(-2,-1),(-1,-1),(-1,-2),(0,-1),(1,-2),(1,-1),(2,-1),(6,0), (0,0),2,8,(4,-5),1,2,14,8,(-9,-9),0 *020A0,4,keuroRef2 7,0020AC,0 *020A7,49,kpes 2,14,8,(-11,-21),14,5,030,1,8,(0,21),050,02F,01E,02D,05C,02B,01A, 029,058,2,8,(12,13),1,8,(0,-18),02D,02F,010,2,8,(-6,14),1,060,2, 8,(3,-14),14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *020AC,45,keuro 2,14,8,(-10,-21),8,(2,10),5,1,014,00A,(9,043),2,6,5,1,01C,00A,(9,043), 2,6,8,(-1,2),5,1,8,(13,0),2,6,04C,1,0B0,2,08C,080,14,8,(-10,-9),0 *02126,53,komega 2,14,8,(-11,-21),14,5,8,(3,1),1,01E,040,014,036,025,8,(-1,3),044, 8,(1,3),023,022,021,040,02F,02E,02D,8,(1,-3),04C,8,(-1,-3),02B, 03A,01C,040,012,2,8,(3,-1),14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *02205,64,kdiam 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-19,-40),14,4,2,14,5,8,(8,17),1,029,02A,8,(-1,-3), 02C,8,(1,-3),02E,02F,030,021,022,8,(1,3),024,8,(-1,3),026,027, 038,2,061,1,8,(-9,-20),2,8,(14,0),14,6,14,3,2,14,8,(19,-18),14,4, 2,0 *0221E,45,kinfin 2,14,8,(-11,-14),14,5,8,(11,11),1,025,027,028,029,02B,01C,02D, 02F,020,021,023,014,023,021,020,02F,02D,01C,02B,029,028,027,025, 2,8,(11,-10),14,6,14,8,(11,-9),0 *02264,36,kleq 2,14,8,(-13,-21),14,5,8,(22,21),1,8,(-18,-9),8,(18,-9),2, 8,(-18,-2),1,8,(18,0),2,8,(4,-1),14,6,14,8,(13,-9),0 *02302,25,ktria

Sample Files | 397

2,14,8,(-10,-21),14,5,040,1,0C0,084,066,06A,08C,2,8,(16,0),14,6, 14,8,(10,-9),0

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

398 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Extended Standard Font for UNICODE

Sample Files | 399

;; ;; txt.shp - Extended Standard Font for UNICODE ;; ;; Copyright 1997 by Autodesk, Inc. ;; ;; Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for ;; any purpose and without fee is hereby granted, provided that the ;; above copyright notice appears in all copies and that the re stricted ;; rights notice below appear in all supporting documentation. ;; ;; Use, duplication, or disclosure by the U.S. Government is sub ject ;; to restrictions set forth in FAR 52.227-19 (Commercial Computer ;; Software - Restricted Rights) and DFAR 252.227-7013(c)(1)(ii) ;; (Rights in Technical Data and Computer Software), as applicable. ;; *UNIFONT,6,TXT Copyright 1997 by Autodesk, Inc. 6,2,2,0,0,0 *0000A,7,lf 2,0AC,14,8,(9,10),0 *00020,7,spc 2,060,14,8,(-6,-8),0 *00021,17,kexc 2,14,06C,1,014,2,014,1,044,2,020,06C,14,8,(-2,-3),0 *00022,20,kdblqt 2,14,8,(-1,-6),044,1,023,2,010,1,02B,2,04C,030,14,8,(-3,1),0 *00023,27,kns 2,14,8,(-2,-6),024,1,040,2,024,1,048,2,023,1,06C,2,020,1,064,2, 06D,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00024,25,kds 2,14,8,(-2,-6),014,1,030,012,016,028,016,012,030,2,027,1,06C,2, 040,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00025,31,kpc 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,01C,010,014,018,2,040,1,8,(-4,-6),2,040,1, 018,014,010,01C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00026,24,kand 2,14,8,(-2,-6),041,1,02A,018,016,014,022,014,016,01A,01C,04E,2, 020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00027,28,kapos

400 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

2,14,3,2,14,8,(-1,-12),14,4,2,044,1,023,2,06C,020,14,3,2, 14,8,(-5,2),14,4,2,0 *00028,16,klp 2,14,8,(-1,-6),064,020,1,02A,02C,02E,2,020,14,03A,0 *00029,15,krp 2,14,8,(-1,-6),064,1,02E,02C,02A,2,040,14,03A,0 *0002A,27,kas 2,14,8,(-2,-5),021,1,044,2,02E,1,048,2,041,1,04A,2,044,1,04E,2, 02F,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0002B,19,kpls 2,14,8,(-2,-5),021,1,044,2,02E,1,048,2,06F,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0002C,28,kcma 2,14,3,2,14,02B,14,4,2,014,010,1,01C,01A,2,012,020,14,3,2, 14,8,(-3,-8),14,4,2,0 *0002D,14,ksub 2,14,8,(-2,-3),034,1,040,2,020,03C,14,048,0 *0002E,12,kper 2,14,01C,1,014,2,02F,14,8,(-2,-3),0 *0002F,17,kdiv 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,8,(4,6),2,020,06C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00030,34,n0 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-3,-12),14,4,2,010,1,016,044,012,010,01E,04C,01A, 018,2,040,14,3,2,14,8,(-7,-6),14,4,2,0 *00031,18,n1 2,14,8,(-1,-6),054,1,012,06C,2,018,1,020,2,020,14,03A,0 *00032,23,n2 2,14,8,(-2,-6),054,1,012,020,01E,01C,01A,028,01A,02C,040,2,020, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00033,29,n3 2,14,8,(-2,-6),054,1,012,020,01E,01C,01A,018,2,010,1,01E,01C,01A, 028,016,2,01C,060,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00034,19,n4 2,14,8,(-2,-6),041,1,048,8,(3,4),06C,2,030,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00035,23,n5 2,14,8,(-2,-6),014,1,01E,020,012,024,016,038,024,040,2,020,06C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00036,24,n6 2,14,8,(-2,-6),034,1,030,01E,01C,01A,028,016,034,022,010,2,030, 06C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00037,16,n7 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,040,06B,2,050,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00038,32,n8 2,14,8,(-2,-6),010,1,016,014,012,020,012,014,016,028,01A,01C,01E,

Sample Files | 401

2,020,1,01E,01C,01A,028,2,050,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00039,24,n9 2,14,8,(-2,-6),010,1,010,022,034,016,028,01A,01C,01E,030,2,020, 03C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0003A,17,kcol 2,14,04C,044,1,01C,2,01C,1,01C,2,02F,14,8,(-2,-3),0 *0003B,34,ksmc 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-1,-8),14,4,2,010,044,1,01C,2,01C,1,02C,01A,2,012, 020,14,3,2,14,8,(-5,-8),14,4,2,0 *0003C,29,klt 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-3,-12),14,4,2,064,030,1,03A,03E,2,020,14,3,2, 14,8,(-5,-6),14,4,2,0 *0003D,18,keq 2,14,04B,044,1,040,2,02C,1,048,2,060,02C,14,8,(-4,-1),0 *0003E,28,kgt 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-3,-12),14,4,2,064,1,03E,03A,2,050,14,3,2, 14,8,(-7,-6),14,4,2,0 *0003F,36,kqm 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-3,-12),14,4,2,054,1,012,010,01E,01C,01A,01C,2, 01C,1,01C,2,030,14,3,2,14,8,(-7,-6),14,4,2,0 *00040,28,kea 2,14,8,(-2,-6),032,1,01A,018,014,012,010,02C,012,024,016,028,01A, 04C,01E,030,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00041,21,uca 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,024,043,04D,02C,2,047,1,040,2,02E,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00042,29,ucb 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,030,012,014,016,028,2,020,1,012,014,016,038,2, 010,1,06C,2,050,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00043,23,ucc 2,14,8,(-2,-6),040,014,1,01A,028,016,044,012,020,01E,2,02E,03C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00044,22,ucd 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,030,012,044,016,038,2,010,1,06C,2,050, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00045,25,uce 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,040,2,048,03C,1,020,2,028,03C,1,040,2,020, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00046,21,ucf 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,040,2,048,03C,1,020,2,03C,040,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00047,22,ucg 2,14,8,(-2,-6),032,1,010,03C,038,016,044,012,030,2,020,06C,

402 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00048,22,uch 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,2,03C,1,040,2,034,1,06C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00049,21,uci 2,14,8,(-1,-6),064,1,020,2,018,1,06C,2,018,1,020,2,020,14,03A,0 *0004A,19,ucj 2,14,8,(-2,-6),014,1,01E,020,012,054,2,020,06C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0004B,23,uck 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,2,040,1,03A,018,2,010,1,03E,2,020, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0004C,16,ucl 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,06C,040,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0004D,17,ucm 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,04D,043,06C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0004E,19,ucn 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,8,(4,-6),064,2,06C,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0004F,17,uco 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,040,06C,048,2,060,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00050,19,ucp 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,030,01E,01C,01A,038,2,06F,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00051,25,ucq 2,14,8,(-2,-6),022,1,01E,01A,018,016,044,012,020,01E,03C,01A,01E, 2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00052,23,ucr 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,030,01E,01C,01A,038,2,010,1,03E,2,020, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00053,22,ucs 2,14,8,(-2,-6),014,1,01E,020,012,046,012,020,01E,2,020,05C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00054,19,uct 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,040,2,028,1,06C,2,040,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00055,20,ucu 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,05C,01E,020,012,054,2,020,06C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00056,15,ucv 2,14,06B,064,1,06D,063,2,020,06C,14,8,(-5,-3),0 *00057,24,ucw 2,14,06B,064,1,9,(2,-6),(1,3),(1,-3),(2,6),(0,0),2,020,06C, 14,8,(-5,-3),0 *00058,22,ucx 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,8,(4,6),2,048,1,8,(4,-6),2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00059,25,ucy

Sample Files | 403

2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,8,(2,-3),03C,2,034,1,8,(2,3),2,020,06C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0005A,19,ucz 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,040,8,(-4,-6),040,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0005B,17,klb 2,14,8,(-1,-6),1,064,020,2,06C,1,028,2,040,14,03A,0 *0005C,17,kbkslsh 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,8,(4,-6),2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0005D,15,krb 2,14,8,(-1,-6),064,1,020,06C,028,2,040,14,03A,0 *0005E,16,kcaret 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,022,02E,2,04D,14,8,(-4,1),0 *0005F,11,kundrl 2,14,028,01C,1,040,2,021,14,04A,0 *00060,27,krvap 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-1,-12),14,4,2,064,1,02D,2,04D,14,3,2,14,8,(-5,2), 14,4,2,0 *00061,24,lca 2,14,04B,020,1,018,016,024,012,010,01E,02C,01A,2,012,1,01E,2,020, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00062,25,lcb 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,2,04C,1,022,010,01E,02C,01A,018,026,2,02C, 060,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00063,17,lcc 2,14,04B,042,1,038,01A,02C,01E,030,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00064,25,lcd 2,14,8,(-2,-6),041,1,02A,018,016,024,012,010,02E,2,044,1,06C,2, 020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00065,20,lce 2,14,04B,024,1,030,012,016,028,01A,02C,01E,020,2,030, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00066,22,lcf 2,14,8,(-2,-6),034,1,030,2,023,1,016,018,01A,05C,2,050, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00067,22,lcg 2,14,04B,01C,1,01E,020,012,044,016,028,01A,02C,01E,030,2,020, 14,8,(-4,-5),0 *00068,21,lch 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,2,04C,1,022,010,01E,03C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00069,17,lci 2,14,06C,1,044,2,014,1,014,2,020,06C,14,8,(-2,-3),0 *0006A,35,lcj

404 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

2,14,3,2,14,8,(-3,-12),14,4,2,01C,1,01E,010,012,054,2,014,1,014, 2,020,06C,14,3,2,14,8,(-7,-10),14,4,2,0 *0006B,23,lck 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,2,04C,1,020,022,2,02A,1,02E,2,020, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0006C,28,lcl 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-1,-12),14,4,2,064,1,05C,01E,2,020,14,3,2, 14,8,(-5,-6),14,4,2,0 *0006D,24,lcm 2,14,04B,1,044,2,01C,1,012,01E,01C,2,014,1,012,01E,03C,2,020, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0006E,21,lcn 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,2,02C,1,022,010,01E,03C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0006F,20,lco 2,14,04B,030,1,028,016,024,012,020,01E,02C,01A,2,030, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00070,22,lcp 2,14,04B,02C,1,064,2,01C,1,012,020,01E,02C,01A,038,2,060, 14,8,(-4,-5),0, *00071,22,lcq 2,14,04B,04F,1,064,2,01C,1,016,028,01A,02C,01E,030,2,020, 14,8,(-4,-5),0, *00072,19,lcr 2,14,04B,1,044,2,02C,1,022,010,01E,2,020,03C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00073,18,lcs 2,14,04B,1,030,012,016,028,016,012,030,2,04D,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00074,21,lct 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,040,2,026,1,05C,01E,012,2,02F,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00075,20,lcu 2,14,04B,044,1,03C,01E,010,022,2,024,1,04C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00076,14,lcv 2,14,04B,044,1,04D,043,2,04D,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00077,23,lcw 2,14,04B,044,1,9,(1,-4),(1,4),(1,-4),(1,4),(0,0),2,04D, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00078,16,lcx 2,14,04B,1,042,2,048,1,04E,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00079,19,lcy 2,14,04B,044,1,04D,2,043,1,06B,018,2,024,060,14,8,(-4,-5),0 *0007A,15,lcz 2,14,04B,044,1,040,04A,040,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0

Sample Files | 405

*0007B,19,klbr 2,14,8,(-1,-6),064,020,1,01A,01C,01A,01E,01C,01E,2,020,14,03A,0 *0007C,13,kvbar 2,14,06C,1,064,2,06C,020,14,8,(-2,-3),0 *0007D,18,krbr 2,14,8,(-1,-6),1,012,014,012,016,014,016,2,06C,040,14,03A,0 *0007E,15,ktlde 2,14,04B,034,1,012,02F,012,2,04D,14,8,(-4,-2),0 *00080,4,keuroRef 7,020AC,0 *000A0,7,NoBrkSpc 2,060,14,8,(-6,-8),0 *000A1,18,kiexc 2,14,06C,1,044,2,014,1,014,2,8,(2,-6),14,8,(-2,-3),0 *000A2,23,kcent 2,14,8,(-2,-5),01E,1,8,(2,6),2,01E,1,038,01A,02C,01E,030,2,020, 14,04A,0, *000A3,23,kpound 2,14,8,(-2,-6),040,1,048,012,044,012,01E,2,02B,1,028,2,06F, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000A5,34,kyen 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,8,(2,-3),03C,2,025,1,020,2,027,1,020,2,018, 1,8,(2,3),2,8,(2,-6),14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000A7,45,kpar 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-3,-12),14,4,2,014,1,01E,010,012,016,018,016,012, 2,021,1,016,018,01A,01E,010,01E,01A,2,8,(3,-2),14,3,2, 14,8,(-7,-6),14,4,2,0 *000AA,36,lcau 2,14,8,(-1,-6),2,3,2,8,3,9,1,01A,018,016,024,012,010,01E,02C,01E, 2,049,1,040,2,4,2,8,2,-3,14,8,(-3,1),0 *000AB,21,kfrew 2,14,8,(-2,-5),021,1,026,022,2,020,1,02A,02E,2,02F,14,8,(-4,-2),0 *000B0,19,kdeg 2,14,8,(-1,-6),054,1,012,01E,01A,016,2,05C,040,14,8,(-3,2),0 *000B1,23,kpls-min 2,14,8,(-2,-6),014,1,040,2,027,1,044,2,02A,1,040,2,04D, 14,8,(-4,-2),0 *000B5,24,kmicro 2,14,04B,02C,1,8,(1,6),1,03C,01E,010,023,2,024,1,04C,2,020, 14,8,(-4,-5),0 *000BA,35,lcou 2,14,8,(-1,-6),3,2,2,8,3,12,1,028,01A,02C,01E,020,012,024,016,2,

406 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

06B,1,040,2,4,2,8,2,-3,14,8,(-3,1),0 *000BB,22,kffrw 2,14,8,(-2,-5),014,1,022,026,2,020,1,02E,02A,2,040,01C, 14,8,(-4,-2),0 *000BC,41,kquart 2,3,2,14,8,(-5,-12),1,8,(10,12),2,8,(-8,-6),1,064,01A,2,05C,1, 020,2,8,(6,-4),1,048,8,(3,4),06C,2,060,14,8,(-9,-6),4,2,0 *000BD,45,khalf 2,3,2,14,8,(-5,-12),1,8,(10,12),2,8,(-8,-6),1,064,01A,2,05C,1, 020,2,8,(3,-1),1,012,020,01E,01C,01A,028,01A,02C,040,2,040, 14,8,(-9,-6),4,2,0 *000BF,32,kiqm 2,3,2,14,8,(-3,-12),8,(6,2),1,02A,028,026,024,022,024,2,024,1, 024,2,8,(8,-12),14,8,(-7,-6),4,2,0 *000C0,31,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,024,022,02E,02C,2,8,(-4,1),1,040,2,8,(-2,4),1, 027,2,8,(6,-6),14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000C1,31,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,024,022,02E,02C,2,8,(-4,1),1,040,2,8,(-2,4),1, 021,2,8,(2,-6),14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000C2,32,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,024,022,02E,02C,2,8,(-4,1),1,040,2,8,(-4,3),1, 022,02E,2,8,(2,-4),14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000C3,33,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,024,022,02E,02C,2,8,(-4,1),1,040,2,8,(-4,4),1, 012,02F,012,2,8,(2,-6),14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000C4,32,uc„ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,024,043,2,029,1,014,2,040,1,01C,2,027,1,04D,02C, 2,047,1,040,2,02E,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000C5,25,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,024,032,016,01A,03E,02C,2,8,(-4,1),1,040,2,02F, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000C6,33,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,034,8,(2,3),020,2,8,(-2,-3),1,020,2,03C,1,028, 064,2,04B,1,020,2,04F,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000C7,29,uc‡ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),02E,1,010,014,018,014,2,021,1,01A,028,016,044,012, 020,01E,2,02E,03C,14,8,(-4,-5),0 *000C8,28,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,040,2,016,1,027,2,04C,018,1,020,2,02A,1,040, 2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000C9,28,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,040,2,025,1,029,2,03C,018,1,020,2,02A,1,040,

Sample Files | 407

2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000CA,29,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,040,2,016,1,016,01A,2,03C,018,1,020,2,02A,1, 040,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000CB,32,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,040,2,016,1,014,2,028,1,01C,2,03C,018,1,020, 2,02A,1,040,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000CC,25,uc^ 2,14,8,(-1,-6),044,1,020,2,014,1,027,2,02D,1,04C,2,018,1,020,2, 020,14,03A,0 *000CD,25,uc^ 2,14,8,(-1,-6),044,1,020,2,024,1,029,2,01E,1,04C,2,018,1,020,2, 020,14,03A,0 *000CE,26,uc^ 2,14,8,(-1,-6),044,1,020,2,014,1,016,01A,2,01E,1,04C,2,018,1,020, 2,020,14,03A,0 *000CF,29,uc^ 2,14,8,(-1,-6),044,1,020,2,014,1,014,2,028,1,01C,2,01E,1,04C,2, 018,1,020,2,020,14,03A,0 *000D0,25,uc 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,030,01E,04C,01A,038,2,024,015,1,020,2,01D, 04F,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000D1,25,uc 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,04E,044,2,048,014,1,012,02F,012,2,8,(2,-6), 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000D2,25,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,040,2,016,1,027,2,02C,030,1,04C,048,2,060, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000D3,25,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,040,2,025,1,029,2,01C,030,1,04C,048,2,060, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000D4,26,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,040,2,016,1,016,01A,2,01C,030,1,04C,048,2, 060,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000D5,27,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,040,2,024,1,01A,027,01A,2,01C,040,1,04C,048, 2,060,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000D6,31,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,2,012,1,014,2,02B,1,040,2,016,1,014,2,02D,1, 04C,048,2,060,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000D8,29,ucd”

408 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,8,(4,6),2,018,1,01E,04C,01A,028,016,044,012,020, 2,8,(3,-6),14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000D9,24,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,05C,01E,020,012,054,2,01A,1,027,2,050,06C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000DA,24,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,05C,01E,020,012,054,2,018,1,029,2,050,05C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000DB,25,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,05C,01E,020,012,054,2,01A,1,016,01A,2,050, 05C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000DC,27,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,05C,01E,020,012,054,2,01A,1,014,2,028,1,01C, 2,05E,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000DD,25,uc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,02E,02C,2,024,1,022,2,025,1,029,2,050,05C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000DE,27,lc 2,14,8,(-2,-6),02C,1,084,2,03C,1,012,020,01E,02C,01A,028,016,2, 8,(6,-1),14,8,(-4,-5),0 *000DF,24,kgers 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,012,044,012,010,01E,01C,01A,01E,01C,01A,018,2, 040,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000E0,39,lc… 2,14,8,(-2,-6),020,1,018,016,024,012,010,01E,02C,01A,2,012,1,01E, 2,2,3,2,8,(-3,10),1,047,2,8,(11,-12),4,2,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000E1,39,lc 2,14,8,(-2,-6),020,1,018,016,024,012,010,01E,02C,01A,2,012,1,01E, 2,2,3,2,8,(-3,12),1,049,2,8,(11,-10),4,2,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000E2,40,lcƒ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),020,1,018,016,024,012,010,01E,02C,01A,2,012,1,01E, 2,2,3,2,8,(-3,10),1,026,02A,2,8,(11,-10),4,2,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000E3,40,lcƒ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),020,1,018,016,024,012,010,01E,02C,01A,2,012,1,01E, 2,3,2,8,(-7,10),1,012,02F,012,2,8,(7,-11),4,2,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000E4,37,lc„ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),020,1,018,016,024,2,034,1,01C,2,030,1,014,2,03A,1, 012,010,01E,02C,01A,2,012,1,01E,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000E5,38,lc† 2,14,8,(-2,-6),3,2,8,(3,8),1,022,026,02A,02E,2,8,(3,-6),4,2,1, 01A,018,016,024,012,010,01E,02C,01E,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000E6,30,lc

Sample Files | 409

2,14,04B,021,1,01A,016,024,012,01E,03C,2,034,1,012,01E,01C,028,2, 01C,1,01E,010,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000E7,24,lc‡ 2,14,04B,042,1,038,01A,02C,01E,030,2,028,1,01C,010,01C,018,2,041, 14,8,(-4,-5),0 *000E8,27,lcŠ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),024,1,030,012,016,028,01A,02C,01E,020,2,054,1,027, 2,050,06C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000E9,26,lc‚ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),024,1,030,012,016,028,01A,02C,01E,020,2,064,1,029, 2,05E,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000EA,27,lcˆ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),024,1,030,012,016,028,01A,02C,01E,020,2,054,1,016, 01A,2,05E,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000EB,31,lc‰ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),024,1,030,012,016,028,01A,02C,01E,020,2,064,010,1, 01C,2,048,1,014,2,06E,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000EC,18,lc_ 2,14,8,(-1,-6),010,1,044,2,025,1,02F,2,020,05C,14,03A,0 *000ED,18,lc 2,14,8,(-1,-6),010,1,044,2,016,1,021,2,020,06C,14,03A,0 *000EE,19,lcŒ 2,14,8,(-1,-6),010,1,044,2,016,1,012,01E,2,020,05C,14,03A,0 *000EF,22,lc‹ 2,14,8,(-1,-6),010,1,044,2,016,1,014,2,020,1,01C,2,020,05C, 14,03A,0 *000F0,30,lc 2,14,8,(-2,-6),8,(3,4),1,028,01A,02C,01E,020,012,024,036,2,01C,1, 021,2,8,(3,-6),14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000F1,27,lc 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,2,014,1,012,02F,012,2,04A,1,022,010,01E,03C, 2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000F2,27,lc• 2,14,8,(-2,-6),030,1,028,016,024,012,020,01E,02C,01A,2,054,1,027, 2,050,06C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000F3,26,lc 2,14,8,(-2,-6),030,1,028,016,024,012,020,01E,02C,01A,2,064,1,029, 2,05E,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000F4,27,lc“ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),030,1,028,016,024,012,020,01E,02C,01A,2,054,1,016, 01A,2,05E,14,8,(-4,-3),0

410 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

*000F5,32,lc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),030,1,028,016,024,012,020,01E,02C,01A,2,8,(-3,5), 1,012,02F,012,2,8,(2,-6),14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000F6,35,lc” 2,14,8,(-2,-6),030,1,028,016,024,2,034,1,01C,2,040,1,014,2, 8,(-4,-3),1,012,020,01E,02C,01A,2,030,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000F7,23,kto 2,14,8,(-2,-5),021,1,014,2,021,1,048,2,022,1,01C,2,04E, 14,8,(-4,-2),0 *000F8,24,lcd” 2,14,04B,010,1,020,012,024,016,028,01A,02C,01E,2,018,1,042,2,04D, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000F9,27,lc— 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,03C,01E,010,022,2,038,044,1,02F,2,01E,1,04C, 2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000FA,26,lc 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,03C,01E,010,022,2,036,1,021,2,02D,1,04C,2, 020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000FB,27,lc2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,03C,01E,010,022,2,036,1,012,01E,2,01E,1,04C, 2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000FC,32,lc_ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,010,1,01C,2,01A,1,03C,01E,010,022,2,044,018,1, 01C,2,01E,1,04C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000FD,27,lc^ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,04D,2,8,(-1,5),1,021,2,02D,1,06B,018,2,024, 060,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000FE,25,uc 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,2,01E,019,1,030,01E,01C,01A,038,2,01F,01C, 050,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *000FF,30,lc˜ 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,04D,2,054,018,1,014,2,020,1,01C,2,01E,1,06B, 018,2,024,060,14,8,(-4,-5),0 *00104,26,c164 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,024,043,04D,02C,2,047,1,040,2,02C,1,01A,01E,2, 022,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00105,30,c165 2,14,04B,020,1,018,016,024,012,010,01E,02C,01A,2,012,1,01E,3,2, 01A,01E,4,2,2,021,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00106,28,c143 2,14,8,(-2,-6),040,014,1,01A,028,016,044,012,020,01E,2,038,024,1, 021,2,08C,030,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00107,30,c134

Sample Files | 411

2,14,04B,042,1,038,01A,02C,01E,030,2,3,2,8,(-5,10),1,021,2,029, 8,(9,-10),4,2,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0010C,31,c172 2,14,8,(-2,-8),040,014,1,01A,028,016,044,012,020,01E,2,026,1,012, 2,01A,1,016,2,050,08C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0010D,29,c159 2,14,8,(-2,-6),042,1,038,01A,02C,01E,030,2,028,054,1,012,2,01A,1, 016,2,050,06C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0010E,32,c210 2,14,8,(-2,-8),1,030,012,044,016,038,2,010,1,06C,2,010,074,1,012, 2,01A,1,016,2,050,08C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0010F,31,c212 2,14,8,(-2,-6),041,1,02A,018,016,024,012,010,02E,2,044,1,06C,2, 020,064,1,01A,2,010,05C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00118,28,c168 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,040,2,048,03C,1,020,2,028,03C,1,040,1,01A, 01E,2,022,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00119,27,c169 2,14,04B,024,1,030,012,016,028,01A,02C,01E,020,3,2,01A,01E,4,2,2, 014,030,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0011A,35,c183 2,14,8,(-2,-8),1,064,040,2,048,03C,1,020,2,028,03C,1,040,2,028, 074,1,012,2,01A,1,016,2,050,08C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0011B,32,c216 2,14,8,(-2,-6),024,1,030,012,016,028,01A,02C,01E,020,2,018,054,1, 012,2,01A,1,016,2,050,06C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00141,29,c157 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,06C,040,2,048,034,1,3,2,8,(4,5),2,8,(8,-11), 4,2,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00142,47,c136 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-1,-12),14,4,2,064,3,2,010,4,2,1,05C,01E,2,3,2, 8,(-3,5),1,8,(3,4),2,8,(4,-9),4,2,14,3,2,14,8,(-5,-6),14,4,2,0 *00143,24,c227 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,8,(4,-6),064,2,038,014,1,021,2,08C,030, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00144,42,c228 2,14,3,2,14,8,(-3,-8),14,4,2,1,044,2,01C,1,012,010,01E,03C,2, 8,(-2,5),1,011,2,019,8,(4,-5),14,3,2,14,8,(-7,-6),14,4,2,0 *00147,27,c213 2,14,8,(-2,-8),1,064,8,(4,-6),064,2,027,1,012,2,01A,1,016,2,050, 08C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00148,29,c229 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,2,01C,1,012,010,01E,03C,2,018,054,1,012,2,

412 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

01A,1,016,2,040,06C,14,03A,0 *00150,27,c138 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,040,06C,048,2,074,010,1,03C,2,020,1,034,2, 07C,030,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00151,29,c139 2,14,04B,030,1,028,016,024,012,020,01E,02C,01A,2,074,1,02C,2,028, 1,024,2,07C,050,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00158,33,c252 2,14,8,(-2,-8),1,064,030,01E,01C,01A,038,2,010,1,03E,2,028,074,1, 012,2,01A,1,016,2,050,08C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00159,29,c253 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,2,02C,1,022,010,01E,2,026,1,012,2,01A,1,016, 2,050,06C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0015A,27,c151 2,14,8,(-2,-6),014,1,01E,020,012,046,012,020,01E,2,024,038,1,021, 2,08C,030,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0015B,31,c152 2,14,04B,1,030,012,016,028,016,012,030,2,3,2,8,(-5,2),1,021,2, 029,8,(9,-10),4,2,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00160,30,c230 2,14,8,(-2,-8),014,1,01E,020,012,046,012,020,01E,2,026,1,012,2, 01A,1,016,2,050,08C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00161,29,c231 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,030,012,016,028,016,012,030,2,027,1,012,2,01A,1, 016,2,050,06C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00164,28,c155 2,14,8,(-2,-8),064,1,040,2,028,1,06C,2,074,1,012,2,01A,1,016,2, 050,08C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00165,26,c156 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,040,2,026,1,05C,01E,012,2,054,1,01A,2,030, 05C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0016E,27,c222 2,14,8,(-2,-9),064,1,05C,01E,020,012,054,2,027,1,012,016,01A,01E, 2,040,07C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0016F,31,c133 2,14,8,(-2,-7),044,1,03C,01E,010,022,2,024,1,04C,2,028,054,1,012, 016,01A,01E,2,040,05C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00170,28,c235 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,05C,01E,020,012,054,2,016,1,03C,2,028,1,034, 2,07C,050,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00171,30,uue

Sample Files | 413

2,14,04B,044,1,03C,01E,010,022,2,024,1,04C,2,074,018,1,02C,2,028, 1,024,2,07C,050,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00179,25,c141 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,040,8,(-4,-6),040,2,038,074,1,021,2,08C,030, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0017A,28,c171 2,14,04B,044,1,040,04A,040,2,3,2,8,(-5,10),1,021,2,029,8,(9,-10), 4,2,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0017B,32,c189 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,040,8,(-4,-6),040,2,084,028,1,3,4,01A,01E, 012,016,4,4,2,040,08C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0017C,34,c190 2,14,04B,044,1,040,04A,040,2,3,2,8,(-4,11),3,4,1,01A,01E,012,016, 4,4,2,8,(8,-11),4,2,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0017D,29,c166 2,14,8,(-2,-8),064,1,040,8,(-4,-6),040,2,028,074,1,012,2,01A,1, 016,2,050,08C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0017E,27,c167 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,040,04A,040,2,028,054,1,012,2,01A,1,016,2, 050,06C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00410,21,ucra 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,024,043,04D,02C,2,047,1,040,2,02E,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00411,24,ucrb 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,030,01C,014,038,03C,030,01E,01C,01A,038,2, 060,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00412,29,ucrv 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,030,012,014,016,028,2,020,1,012,014,016,038,2, 010,1,06C,2,050,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00413,17,ucrg 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,040,01C,2,05C,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00414,23,ucrd 2,14,8,(-2,-6),01C,1,014,050,064,028,04B,02C,050,01C,2,014,020, 14,8,(-6,-3),0 *00415,25,ucre 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,040,2,048,03C,1,020,2,028,03C,1,040,2,020, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00416,22,ucr! 2,14,8,(-2,-6),062,2,038,1,06C,2,038,064,1,06E,2,020, 14,8,(-6,-3),0 *00417,27,ucr! 2,14,8,(-2,-6),014,1,01E,020,012,014,016,018,010,012,014,016,028, 01A,2,060,05C,14,8,(-4,-3),0

414 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

*00418,20,ucri 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,042,04C,064,2,048,1,06C,2,060,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00419,24,ucrikr 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,042,04C,064,2,018,1,028,2,018,1,06C,2,060, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0041A,23,ucrk 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,2,040,1,03A,018,2,010,1,03E,2,020, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0041B,17,ukrl 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,010,063,010,06C,2,020,14,8,(-5,-3),0 *0041C,17,ucrm 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,04D,043,06C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0041D,22,ucrn 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,2,03C,1,040,2,034,1,06C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0041E,23,ucro 2,14,8,(-2,-6),014,1,044,012,020,01E,04C,01A,028,016,2,060,01C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0041F,16,ucrp 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,040,06C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00420,19,ucrr 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,030,01E,01C,01A,038,2,06F,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00421,23,ucrs 2,14,8,(-2,-6),040,014,1,01A,028,016,044,012,020,01E,2,02E,03C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00422,19,ucrt 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,040,2,028,1,06C,2,040,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00423,23,ucru 2,14,8,(-2,-6),014,1,01E,020,012,054,04C,038,016,034,2,060,06C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00424,25,ucrf 2,14,8,(-2,-6),020,1,064,018,01A,02C,01E,020,012,024,016,018,2, 040,06C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00425,22,ucrx 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,8,(4,6),2,048,1,8,(4,-6),2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00426,21,ucr! 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,06C,040,064,06C,010,01C,2,014,020, 14,8,(-5,-3),0 *00427,19,ucrch 2,14,8,(-2,-6),064,1,03C,01E,030,044,06C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00428,21,ucrsh 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,06C,030,044,04C,030,064,06C,2,020, 14,8,(-6,-3),0

Sample Files | 415

*00429,24,ucr! 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,06C,030,044,04C,030,064,06C,010,01C,014,2, 020,14,8,(-7,-3),0 *0042A,23,ucr' 2,14,8,(-2,-6),054,1,014,010,06C,030,012,014,016,038,2,060,03C, 14,8,(-5,-3),0 *0042B,24,ucrs 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,030,012,014,016,038,03C,064,2,050,1,06C,2,020, 14,8,(-5,-3),0 *0042C,21,ucr] 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,030,012,014,016,038,03C,064,2,060,06C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0042D,25,ucr' 2,14,8,(-2,-6),014,1,01E,020,012,024,028,020,024,016,028,01A,2, 060,05C,14,8,(-4,-3),00, *0042E,26,ucr! 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,064,03C,010,024,012,010,01E,04C,01A,018,016,024, 2,050,03C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0042F,22,ucrya 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,022,020,044,038,01A,02C,01E,030,02C,2,020, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00430,25,lcra 2,14,8,(-2,-6),014,1,024,012,020,01E,014,04C,014,01A,028,016,2, 060,01C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00431,22,lcrb 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,030,1,038,04C,030,012,016,038,2,02C,060, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00432,24,lcrv 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,020,10,(1,-36),028,030,10,(1,-36),038,2,060, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00433,16,lcrg 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,030,2,04C,020,14,8,(-3,-3),0 *00434,24,lcrd 2,14,8,(-2,-6),01C,1,014,010,034,012,010,04C,028,030,01C,2,014, 020,14,8,(-4,-3),00, *00435,20,lcre 2,14,04B,024,1,030,012,016,028,01A,02C,01E,020,2,030, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00436,23,lcrg 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,042,2,048,1,04E,2,028,1,044,2,040,04C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00437,25,lcrz 2,14,8,(-2,-6),034,1,012,020,01E,01A,018,010,01E,01A,028,016,2,

416 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

060,01C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00438,17,lcri 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,04C,042,04C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00439,23,lcrii 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,04C,042,04C,2,044,018,1,028,2,050,04C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0043A,19,lcrk 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,02C,020,022,02A,02E,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0043B,16,lcrl 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,043,020,04C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0043C,17,lcrm 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,02E,022,04C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0043D,18,lcrn 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,02C,040,024,04C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0043E,25,lcro 2,14,04B,14,8,(0,-2),014,1,024,012,020,01E,02C,01A,028,016,2,060, 01C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0043F,16,lcrp 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,040,04C,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00440,20,lcrr 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,030,01E,01C,01A,038,2,060,01C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00441,23,lcrs 2,14,8,(-2,-6),040,014,1,01A,028,016,024,012,020,01E,2,020,03C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00442,18,lcrt 2,14,8,(-2,-6),020,1,044,028,040,2,020,04C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00443,22,lcru 2,14,8,(-2,-6),014,1,01E,020,012,034,02C,028,026,2,060,04C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00444,25,lcrf 2,14,8,(-2,-6),020,1,044,018,01A,01C,01E,020,012,014,016,018,2, 040,04C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00445,20,lcrh 2,14,04B,14,8,(0,-2),1,042,2,048,1,04E,2,020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00446,21,lcrc 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,04C,030,044,04C,010,01C,2,014,020, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *00447,18,lcrch 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,03C,030,034,04C,2,020,14,8,(-3,-3),0 *00448,21,lcrsh 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,04C,020,024,02C,020,044,2,04C,020, 14,8,(-4,-3),0

Sample Files | 417

*00449,24,lcrshch 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,04C,020,024,02C,020,044,04C,010,01C,2,014, 020,14,8,(-5,-3),0 *0044A,21,lcrtvznak 2,14,8,(-2,-6),044,1,010,04C,020,012,016,028,2,050,02C, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0044B,24,lcryyy 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,02C,020,01E,01A,028,2,040,1,044,2,04C,020, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0044C,19,lcrmznak 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,02C,020,01E,01A,028,2,050,14,8,(-3,-3),0 *0044D,25,lcreee 2,14,8,(-2,-6),014,1,01E,020,012,014,028,020,014,016,028,01A,2, 060,03C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0044E,26,lcryu 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,044,02C,010,014,012,010,01E,02C,01A,018,016,014, 2,050,02C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0044F,22,lcrya 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,022,018,016,012,030,02C,028,020,02C,2,020, 14,8,(-4,-3),0 *020A0,4,keuroRef2 7,0020AC,0 *020A7,32,kpes 2,14,06B,14,010,1,064,020,01E,01C,01A,028,2,8,(4,3),1,05C,01E, 012,2,025,1,028,2,03E,020,14,8,(-6,-3),0 *020AC,45,keuro 3,2,2,14,8,(-4,12),080,024,1,01C,01A,048,026,044,5,044,022,040,01E,01C 6,2,8,(-1,-1),5,1,050,6,2,024,1,060,2,8,(6,-7),14,8,(-8,-6),4,2,0 *02126,24,komega 2,14,8,(-2,-6),1,010,014,025,024,012,020,01E,02C,02B,01C,010,2, 020,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *02205,28,kdiam 2,14,8,(-2,-6),012,1,016,024,012,020,01E,02C,01A,028,2,01B,1,063, 2,010,03D,03C,14,8,(-4,-3),0 *0221E,18,kinfin 2,14,04B,034,1,01E,022,01E,01A,026,01A,2,06F,14,8,(-4,-1),0 *02264,20,kleq 2,14,8,(-2,-6),014,1,040,2,054,1,049,04F,2,02E,14,8,(-4,-2),0 *02302,16,ktri 2,14,04B,1,024,022,02E,02C,048,2,060,14,8,(-4,-3),0

418 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Big Font Descriptions Some languages, such as Japanese, use text fonts with thousands of non-ASCII characters. In order for drawings to contain such text, AutoCAD supports a special form of shape definition file called a Big Font file. Some languages, such as Japanese, use text fonts with thousands of non-ASCII characters. In order for drawings to contain such text, AutoCAD supports a special form of shape definition file called a Big Font file.

Define a Big Font Special codes in the first line of a Big Font file specify how to read two-byte hexidecimal codes. A font with hundreds or thousands of characters must be handled differently from a font containing the ASCII set of up to 256 characters. In addition to using more complicated techniques for searching the file, AutoCAD needs a way to represent characters with two-byte codes as well as one-byte codes.

Big Font Descriptions | 419

Both situations are addressed by the use of special codes at the beginning of a Big Font file. The first line of a Big Font shape definition file must be as follows: *BIGFONT nchars,nranges,b1,e1,b2,e2,...

where nchars is the approximate number of character definitions in this set; if it is off by more than about 10 percent, either speed or file size suffers. You can use the rest of the line to name special character codes (escape codes) that signify the start of a two-byte code. For example, on Japanese computers, Kanji characters start with hexadecimal codes in the range 90-AF or E0-FF. When the operating system sees one of these codes, it reads the next byte and combines the two bytes into a code for one Kanji character. In the *BIGFONT line, nranges tells how many contiguous ranges of numbers are used as escape codes; b1, e1, b2, e2, and so on, define the beginning and ending codes in each range. Therefore, the header for a Japanese Big Font file might look like this: *BIGFONT 4000,2,090,0AF,0E0,0FF

After the *BIGFONT line, the font definition is just like a regular AutoCAD text font, except that character codes (shape numbers) can have values up to 65535.

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

420 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Define an Extended Big Font File To reduce the size of composite Kanji characters, you can define an extended Big Font file. Extended big fonts use the subshape code, followed immediately by a 0. The first line of an extended Big Font file is the same as the regular Big Font file. This is the format for the remaining lines of the file: *0,5,font-name character-height, 0, modes, character-width,0 . . . *shape-number,defbytes,shape-name . code,0,primitive#,basepoint-x,basepoint-y,width,height, . . code,0,primitive#,basepoint-x,basepoint-y,width,height, . terminator

The following list describes the fields of a Big Font definition file: character height Used along with character width to indicate the number of units that define the font characters. character width Used along with character height to indicate the number of units that define the font characters. The character-height and character-width values are used to scale the primitives of the font. In this context, primitives are the points, lines, polygons, or character strings of the

Big Font Descriptions | 421

font geometrically oriented in two-dimensional space. A Kanji character consists of several primitives used repeatedly in different scales and combinations. modes The modes byte should be 0 for a horizontally oriented font and 2 for a dual-orientation (horizontal or vertical) font. The special 00E (14) command code is honored only when modes is set to 2. shape-number Character code. defbytes Byte size. It is always 2 bytes, consisting of a hexadecimal or a combination of decimal and hexadecimal codes. shape-name Character name. code Shape description special code. It is always 7 so that it can use the subshape feature. primitive# Reference to the subshape number. It is always 2. basepoint-x X origin of the primitive. basepoint-y Y origin of the primitive. width Scale of the width of the primitive. height Scale of the height of the primitive. terminator End-of-file indicator for the shape definition. It is always 0. To arrive at the scale factor, AutoCAD scales down the primitive to a square unit and then multiplies it by the height and width to get the shape of the character. Character codes (shape numbers) in the Big Font shape definition file can have values up to 65535. The following table describes the fields of the extended Big Font file. Fields of the extended Big Font file Variable

Value

Byte size

Description

shape-number

xxxx

2 bytes

Character code

code

7,0

2 bytes

Extended font definition

primitive#

xxxx

2 bytes

Refer to subshape number

1 byte

Primitive X origin

basepoint-x

422 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

Fields of the extended Big Font file Variable

Byte size

Description

basepoint-y

1 byte

Primitive Y origin

width

1 byte

Scale of primitive width

height

1 byte

Scale of primitive height

1 byte

End of shape definition

terminator

Value

0

The following figure is an example of a 16 x 16 dot matrix that you could use to design an extended Big Font, such as a Kanji character. In the example, the distance between each dot is one unit. The callout points to a square unit.

A square matrix for a Kanji character The following figure shows examples of Kanji characters. Each character occupies an M×N matrix (matrices don't have to be square), similar to the one shown in the previous figure. The numbers above each figure are the associated shape numbers.

Big Font Descriptions | 423

Examples of Kanji characters The following figure shows Kanji primitives.

Examples of Kanji primitives NOTE Not all fonts are defined in a square matrix; some are defined in rectangular matrices.

424 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

Example: Shape Definition File for an Extended Big Font

Big Font Descriptions | 425

*BIGFONT 50,1,080,09e *0,5,Extended Font 15,0,2,15,0 *08D91,31,unspecified 2,0e,8,-7,-15, 7,0,08cfb,0,0,16,16,7,0,08bca,2,3,12,9, 2,8,18,0,2,0e,8,-11,-3,0 *08CD8,31,unspecified 2,0e,8,-7,-15, 7,0,08be0,0,0,8,16,7,0,08cc3,8,0,8,16, 2,8,18,0,2,0e,8,-11,-3,0 *08ADF,31,unspecified 2,0e,8,-7,-15, 7,0,089a4,0,0,8,16,7,0,08cb3,8,0,8,16, 2,8,18,0,2,0e,8,-11,-3,0 *08CE8,39,unspecified 2,0e,8,-7,-15, 7,0,089a4,0,1,5,14,7,0,08cc3,5,2,5,14,7,0,08c8e,9,0,7, 16,2,8,18,0,2,0e,8,-11,-3,0 *089A4,39,primitive 2,0e,8,-7,-15,2,8,1,14,1,0c0, 2,8,-11,-6,1,0a0,2,8,-12,-7,1, 0e0,2,8,-7,13,1,0dc,2,8,11,-1, 2,0e,8,-11,-3,0 *08BCA,41,primitive 2,0e,8,-7,-15,2,8,1,14,1,0c0, 2,8,-11,-6,1,0a0,2,8,-12,-8,1, 0e0,2,0e5,1,0ec,2,063,1,8, 2,-3,2,06f,2,0e,8,-11,-3,0 *08BE0,81,primitive 2,0e,8,-7,-15,2,8,3,9,1,080, 2,8,-10,-4,1,0c0,2,8,-13,-5,1, 0e0,2,8,-7,9,1,09c,2,8,-1,14, 1,8,-6,-5,2,8,8,5,1,8,6,-5, 2,8,-11,-6,1,8,1,-3,2,8,7,3, 1,8,-1,-3,2,8,-3,15,1,01a,2, 012,1,01e,2,8,10,-14,2,0e,8, -11,-3,0 *08C8E,44,primitive 2,0e,8,-7,-15,2,8,3,15,1,090,0fc,038, 2,8,-6,11,1,090,2,8,-9,-5,1, 090,2,096,1,0ac,8,-1,-3,01a,01a,2,8, 18,0,2,0e,8,-11,-3,0

426 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

*08CB3,61,primitive 2,0e,8,-7,-15,2,042,1,02b,02a,018,2, 0d0,1,012,034,2,069,1,01e,040,2,8, -8,6,1,02b,2,8,4,5,1,08c,2,8, -3,8,1,03c,2,8,-5,3,1,0e0,2,8, -12,5,1,0a0,2,8,6,-14,2,0e,8, -11,-3,0 *08CC3,34,primitive 2,0e,8,-7,-15,2,0c1,1,06c,0a8,064,0a0,2,8, -5,9,1,09c,2,8,-7,5,1,0e0,2,8, 4,-11,2,0e,8,-11,-3,0 *08CFB,22,primitive 2,0e,8,-7,-15,2,0d2,1,0cc,0c8,0c4,0c0,2,8, 5,-13,2,0e,8,-11,-3,0

Quick Reference Commands COMPILE Compiles shape files and PostScript font files into SHX files LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

Big Font Descriptions | 427

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Use Big Font Text in a Drawing To use a Big Font for drawing text, you set up a text style and then specify the name of the Big Font file. To use a Big Font for drawing text, you must set up a text style by using the STYLE command and then specify the name of the Big Font file. The same text style can use a normal ASCII font as well; enter only the two file names, separated by a comma. The following example uses the command line version of the STYLE command. To enable Big Fonts from the Text Style dialog box, choose the Use Big Font option. Command: -style Enter name of text style or [?] : style_name Specify full font name or font file name (TTF or SHX): txt,greek AutoCAD assumes that the first name is the normal font and that the second is the big font. If you enter only one name, AutoCAD assumes it is the normal font and removes any associated Big Font. By using leading or trailing commas when specifying the font file names, you can change one font without affecting the other, as shown in the following table. Input for changing fonts Input

Result

normal, big

Both normal and Big Font specified

428 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

Input for changing fonts Input

Result

normal,

Normal font only (Big Font unchanged)

,big

Big Font only (normal font unchanged)

normal

Normal font only (if necessary, Big Font removed)

ENTER (null response)

No change

When you use the STYLE command to list styles or to revise an existing style, AutoCAD displays the normal font file, a comma, and the Big Font file. If the style has only a Big Font file, it is displayed with a leading comma: ,greek. For each character in a text string, AutoCAD searches the Big Font file first. If the character is not found there, the normal font file is searched.

Big Font Descriptions | 429

Quick Reference Commands STYLE

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Use a Big Font to Extend a Font To include special symbols in text strings, you can use a Big Font instead of extending a standard text font. In some drafting disciplines, many special symbols can appear in text strings. The AutoCAD standard text fonts can be extended to include special symbols. However, extending standard text fonts has several limitations: ■

The number of shapes is 255 per font file.



Standard character set uses almost half the available shape numbers. Only codes 1 through 9, 11 through 31, and 130 through 255 are available.



Multiple text fonts require duplication of the symbol definitions in each font.



Special symbols require that you enter %%nnn, where nnn is the symbol's shape number.

The Big Font mechanism avoids these problems. You can select one or more seldom-used characters, such as the tilde (˜) or the vertical bar (|), as an escape code, and use the next character to select the appropriate special symbol. For instance, you can use the following Big Font file to draw Greek letters by entering a vertical bar (|, ASCII code 124) followed by the equivalent Roman

430 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

letter. Because the first byte of each character is 124, the character codes are biased by 124 x 256, or 31744. *BIGFONT 60,1,124,124 *0,4,Greek above, below, modes, 0 *31809,n,uca . . . uppercase Alpha definition, invoked by "|A" *31810,n,ucb . . . uppercase Beta definition, invoked by "|B" *31841,n,lca . . . lowercase Alpha definition, invoked by "|a" *31842,n,lcb . . . lowercase Beta definition, invoked by "|b" *31868,n,vbar . . . vertical bar definition, invoked by "||" . . .

Quick Reference Commands COMPILE Compiles shape files and PostScript font files into SHX files LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

Big Font Descriptions | 431

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Unicode Font Descriptions A single Unicode font, due to its large character set, is capable of supporting all languages and platforms. Unicode shape definition files are virtually identical in format and syntax to regular AutoCAD shape definition files. The main difference is in the syntax of the font header as shown in the following code: *UNIFONT,6,font-name above,below,modes,encoding,type,0

The font-name, above, below, and modes parameters are the same as in regular fonts. The remaining two parameters are defined as follows: encoding Font encoding. Uses one of the following integer values. 0 Unicode 1 Packed multibyte 1 2 Shape file type Font embedding information. Specifies whether the font is licensed. Licensed fonts must not be modified or exchanged. Bitcoded values can be added. 0 Font can be embedded 1 Font cannot be embedded 2 Embedding is read-only Another important difference is the handling of the code 7 subshape reference. If a shape description includes a code 7 subshape reference, the data following the code 7 is interpreted as a two-byte value. This affects the total number of

432 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

data bytes (defbytes) in the shape description header. For example, the following shape description is found in the romans.shp file: *00080,4,keuroRef 7,020AC,0

The second field in the header represents the total number of bytes in the shape description. If you are not used to working with Unicode font descriptions, you may be inclined to use three bytes rather than four, but this would cause an error during the compiling of the SHP file. This is true even if the shape number you are referencing is not in the two-byte range (below 255); the compiler always uses two bytes for this value, so you must account for that in the header. The only other difference between Unifont shape definitions and regular shape definitions is the shape numbers. The Unifont shape definitions that AutoCAD provides use hexadecimal shape numbers as opposed to decimal values. Although hexadecimal numbers are not required, their use makes it easier to cross-reference the shape numbers with the \U+ control character values.

Quick Reference Commands LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

Unicode Font Descriptions | 433

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

Superscripts and Subscripts in SHX Files You can modify shape definition files to improve their ability to display superscripts and subscripts. The AutoCAD SHX fonts have limited superscript and subscript capabilities. However, it is relatively easy to modify shape definition files to improve superscript and subscript capability. Creating superscripts and subscripts requires two steps. First, the “imaginary pen” that is creating the text, vector by vector, on your screen needs to be shifted up or down. Then, the font “scale” needs to be reduced. In addition, the reverse process has to take place to return to the normal font. The font needs to recognize four new keys: two for superscripts and two for subscripts. To avoid altering the existing font definitions, you can access these with the numeric keypad on your keyboard.

To add superscript and subscript definitions to a font This example procedure is based on the AutoCAD Romans font file, although a similar method applies to any AutoCAD font. This procedure adds four new shape definitions to a font: super_on, super_off, sub_on, and sub_off, which control the position and size of the characters that follow. For simplicity, this example replaces the left- and right-bracket characters ([and]) and the left and right curly brace characters ({and}) with the new characters. You may choose to replace other characters or use a shape number in the extended range (ASCII codes 128 through 256). If you use an extended shape number, you need to use the %%nnn method (where nnn is the ASCII value of the character) for placing the new characters. 1 Edit your SHP file with an ASCII text editor.

434 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

2 Search for the shape definitions of the characters you are replacing. To comment out those definitions so the new definitions can take their place, insert a semicolon in front of each line of the shape definition. The shape definition may continue for a number of lines. The left- and right-bracket characters have ASCII values of 91 and 93 (05B and 05D hex values, if the font is Unicode). The left and right curly brace characters have ASCII values of 123 and 125 (07B and 07D hex). 3 Add the first and second values on the second line of the definition, and divide the total by 2 as shown in the following example: *UNIFONT,6,Extended Simplex Roman for UNICODE 21,7,2,0 21 + 7 = 28, then 28 / 2 = 14. This number is used later.

4 Add the following lines to the end of the SHP file: *91,8,super_on 2,8,(0,14),003,2,1,0 *93,8,super_off 2,004,2,8,(0,-14),1,0 *123,8,sub_on 2,8,(0,-14),003,2,1,0 *125,8,sub_off 2,004,2,8,(0,14),1,0

Notice the 14 and -14 values in the preceding lines. They are Y axis offsets for the imaginary pen. The value 14 is half the maximum height of a character in this font, which is the correct approximation for superscripts and subscripts. This value needs to be calculated for each font file, but you can modify it any way you want. 5 Save the file. 6 Use the COMPILE command to compile the SHP file. Once the shape is compiled and an appropriate style is defined, you can access the new pen-up and pen-down commands by entering the [, ], {, and } characters. The [ character initiates superscript and the ] character returns from superscript to normal. The { character initiates subscript and the } character returns from subscript to normal.

Superscripts and Subscripts in SHX Files | 435

Quick Reference Commands COMPILE Compiles shape files and PostScript font files into SHX files LOAD Makes shapes available for use by the SHAPE command SHAPE Inserts a shape from a shape file that has been loaded using LOAD

System Variables No entries

Utilities No entries

Command Modifiers No entries

436 | Chapter 9 Shapes and Shape Fonts

Index _ (underscore character) 36, 121 in hatch pattern definitions 36 !. (exclamation point period) 167 in menu item labels 167 !., in menu item labels 104 . (period), to access a built-in AutoCAD command 122 .NET environment 345 + (plus sign) 116 ~ (tilde) 100, 103 in menu item labels 100, 103 $ (dollar sign) 167 $ commands 36, 268 in DIESEL expressions 268 in hatch pattern definitions 36 2D Draw dashboard panel 177 properties 177 3D Objects image tile dialog box

229

A A-type alignment of linetypes 26–27 abbreviations for commands. See aliases absolute referencing of menus 170–171 defined 170 syntax 171 acad.bat file 12 acad.cfg file 11 acad.lin (linetype library) file 24 acad.lsp file 332, 334 acad.pat (hatch pattern library) file 37 acad.pgp (program parameters) file 17, 21, 320 acad.rx file 344 acad2007.lsp (reserved AutoLISP file required by AutoCAD) file 335 acad2007doc.lsp (reserved AutoLISP file required by AutoCAD) file 336 acadapps folder 8 acaddoc.lsp file 332, 336

acadiso.lin (metric linetype definition) file 24 acadiso.pat (metric hatch pattern definition) file 37 ACADLSPASDOC system variable 332, 334 accelerator keys. See shortcut keys actions 212, 214, 216 double click actions 212, 214, 216 activating menus 170 ActiveX Automation 318–322 about 318 controllers 318, 322 defining commands to start applications 320 objects 319 starting applications from a menu/toolbar 321 Visual Basic for Applications and 318, 322 addition (+) DIESEL function 276 aliases 4, 21, 135, 146, 154, 158, 161– 162, 164, 168, 173, 226, 228 for commands 4, 21 object shortcut menus 164 pull-down menus 154, 173 screen menus 226, 228 shortcut menus 158, 161–162 submenus 168 toolbars 135, 146 Aliases dialog box 226 ampersand character 167 anchored windows 252 and DIESEL function 283 angtos DIESEL function 284 applications 320–321, 324, 329–330, 342 AutoLISP 329–330 ObjectARX 342 starting 320–321 from a command 320 from a menu/toolbar 321 VBA 324

437 | Index

APPLOAD command 326, 331–332, 344 arcs 362–363, 365 bulge-specified 365 fractional 363 octant 362 Array of Thumbnails template (Publish to Web wizard) 14–15 Array Plus Summary template (Publish to Web wizard) 14–15 ARX command 342 arxload AutoLISP function 342, 344 arxunload AutoLISP function 343 ASCII codes 117, 369–370 for characters 117 in text font shape numbers 369–370 ASCII customization files 54 aspect ratio 229 image tile menus 229 asterisk (*) 123 repeating commands in macros 123 Auto Hide function, for dockable windows 252 autoarxload AutoLISP function 333, 345 AutoCAD Runtime Extension. See ObjectARX AutoLISP (LSP) applications 273, 329– 332, 334, 336, 338, 343 about 329 acad.lsp file 332, 334 acaddoc.lsp file 332, 336 DIESEL returned values in 273 errors when loading 338 loading 329, 331 loading/running automatically 332 MNL file 332 specifying a directory path for 331, 343 storage of 330 AutoLISP (LSP) files 235 loading in Customize User Interface editor 235 scripts for customization of interface 235 AutoLISP code 114, 129, 269, 272, 328– 329 about 328

438 | Index

examples 269 for customizing the status line 269 in macros 114, 129 in menu macros 272 reading of, by AutoCAD 329 setting MODEMACRO values with 269 AutoLISP functions 52, 170–171, 174, 269–270, 320, 329, 331, 333–334, 336–340, 342–345 arxload 342, 344 arxunload 343 autoarxload 333, 345 autoload 333 command 329, 333, 339 defun 339–340 defun-q 340 load 331, 333–334, 336, 338 menucmd 170–171, 174 princ 337–338 S STARTUP 270 startapp 320 strcat 269 use in customization 52 AutoLISP routines. See AutoLISP (LSP) applications autoload AutoLISP function 333 Automation. See ActiveX Automation

B b switch, running scripts and 311 backslash 331, 343 in AutoLISP 331, 343 backslash character 114, 116–117, 119– 120, 219 blank spaces after 116 in macros 114, 117 pausing macros 119, 219 prohibited as path delimiter in macros 120 BACKSPACE key 117 backup customization files 66–68 backwards compatibility, in customization 52

Big Font file 419–422, 428, 430 byte size 422 character height/width 421 defining 419 drawing text with 428 end-of-file indicator 422 examples 420 extended 421 extending text fonts with 430 fields described 421 height/width of the primitive 422 modes byte 422 one-byte vs. two-byte codes in 419 shape description special code 422 shape names 422 shape numbers 422 specifying names of 428 subshape number 422 X and Y origins of the primitive 422 bitmaps (BMP images) 85, 106 command image properties 85 toolbar button images 106 blank lines in screen menus 226 blank spaces in macros 115, 127 block insertion preset values 129 blocks 350 BMP (bitmap) files 106 toolbar button images 106 BMP (bitmp) files 85 command image properties 85 borders around menu items 102 bulge factor, in arc specifications 365 bulge-specified arc codes in shape specification bytes 365 Button Editor dialog box 107 button images 106–107, 131 customizing 106–107, 131 Button Images pane (Customize User Interface editor) 107 buttons 50, 106–107, 110, 131, 142– 146, 173, 176, 218–219, 224 as interface items 50 crosshair coordinates 219 customizing on toolbars 131 dashboard panels 176 deleting 144–145

digitizing tablets 219, 224 images on 106–107, 110, 131 menu swapping and 173 moving on toolbars 142–144 on pointing devices 218–219 tooltips 146

C C# programming language 346 CAD managers 50 enterprise customization files 50 calling macros 129 canceling 115, 127 running commands in macros 115, 127 captions for menu items 157 caret syntax in macros 114–115, 117, 123 cascading menus. See pull-down menus cascading menus. See shortcut menus categories (commands) 61 character height/width in Big Font file 421 check marks 100, 102–105 on menu item labels 100 on menu items 102–105 clicking actions, mouse button 218 CMCOMMAND shortcut menu alias 158 cmd (Windows system command) 18 CMDEFAULT shortcut menu alias 158 CMEDIT shortcut menu alias 158 command aliases 4 command AutoLISP function 329, 333, 339 command autoloader 333 command field, in the external commands section 17 command labels. See menu item labels command line switches 311 running scripts and 311 Command List pane (Customize User Interface editor) 61, 86 Command mode shortcut menu 158 command name validity, search procedure for 8

439 | Index

command scripts. See scripts Command window 239 changing properties 239 commands 61, 79, 85–88, 90–91, 100, 103, 105–106, 108–110, 112, 114– 116, 119, 122–123, 135, 140–142, 146, 153–154, 156–157, 161–162, 164, 167–168, 171, 184, 187–189, 214, 219, 224–225, 227, 320 adding to dashboard panels 184 adding to double click actions 214 adding to partial CUI (customization) files 79 adding to shortcut menus 161–162 adding to toolbars 135, 140–142 assigning to screen menus 225, 227 assigning to submenus 168 assigning to tablet buttons 219, 224 canceling in macros 115 captions for 157 categories 61 copying and pasting into CUI files 90 creating 86 customized 85, 100 changing command properties 85 controlling display 100 deleting 87 disabling 100, 103, 105, 171 dragging onto menus 154, 156 duplicating in CUI files 91 editing 86, 88 element IDs 86 entering 86, 88 macros for 86, 88 images for 108–110 labels. See menu item labels limits on menus 153 listing 61 macros and 85, 114, 122 naming and defining properties 86 object shortcut menus 164 pausing macros for input 119 properties 85–86 rearranging 61

440 | Index

rearranging in dashboard panels 187–188 reflecting in screen menus 227 removing from dashboard panels 188–189 repeating 123 in macros 123 reusing 86, 90 special codes in macros 167 starting with toolbar buttons 106 status line Help messages 112 terminating 116 to start applications 320 tooltips 146 transparent 119 comment lines, in scripts 308–309 comparing old and new customization files 54 COMPILE command 350–351, 355 compiling shape or font files 350–351 complex linetypes, including shapes in 31 component objects 318 model architecture 318 conditional expressions in macros 127 configuration files 10 about 10 multiple 10 context menus. See shortcut menus context-sensitive shortcut menus. See shortcut menus control characters in macros 117 table of 117 controls on dashboard 176, 187–190, 193–195 adding to panels 193–194 creating on dashboard panels 176 rearranging in panels 187–188 removing from panels 188–189 switching 190 switching on panels 195 table of, for customization 190 controls on toolbars 148–151 adding 149–150 switching 148, 151 table of, for customization 148

coordinate filters 119 macros and 119 coordinate position in shape specification bytes 359 coordinates 219 mouse crosshairs 219 copying 70, 73–74, 90, 131, 197 buttons to other toolbars 131 commands in CUI files 90 customization file data 73–74 interface elements in CUI files 70 list of shortcut keys 197 creating 66–67, 86, 135–136, 138–140, 204, 208 commands 86 enterprise customization files 66– 67 flyouts 136, 139–140 from another toolbar 139 from pull-down menus 140 from scratch 136 shortcut keys 204 temporary override keys 208 toolbars 135, 138 crosshairs 219 coordinates of 219 CTRL key 117, 197, 218 CTRL modifier 197 CUI (customization) files 49–50, 52, 54, 57, 65–71, 73–74, 76–79, 82–83, 90–91, 93, 95–98, 175 about 65–66 backups 66–67 backwards compatibility 52 copying and pasting commands 90 copying and pasting interface elements 70 creating, from existing CUI files 67 creating, from scratch 66 defined 50 duplicating commands 91 duplicating interface elements 71 Dynamic Help 57

enterprise customization files 82– 83 defining, on user workstations 82 modifying 83 finding commands in Command List pane 96 finding search strings in 93, 95 migration of older file structures to 73 modifying 68 partial CUI files 76–79, 175 adding commands to 79 controlling toolbars and 175 loading 76–77 unloading 76, 78 replacement of MNU and MNS files 52 replacing commands 98 replacing search strings 97 resetting 68 role of 49 searches 93 specifying main customization file 69 structure of 54 transferring 74 XML-based format 52 CUILOAD command 76 loading partial CUI files with 76 CUIUNLOAD command 78 unloading partial CUI files with 78 current workspace, setting 255 custom linetypes. See linetypes custom menus 302 using slides with 302 custom templates. See templates custom-defined commands 19 See also external commands customization 49–50, 52 See also customizing changes 52 glossary of terms 49–50 overview 49

441 | Index

customization (CUI) files 4, 8, 49–50, 52, 54, 65–71, 73–74, 76–79, 82– 83, 90–91, 93, 95–98, 175, 272 about 65–66 backups 66–67 backwards compatibility 52 copying and pasting commands 90 copying and pasting interface elements 70 creating, from existing CUI files 67 creating, from scratch 66 defined 50 DIESEL expressions in 272 duplicating commands 91 duplicating interface elements 71 editing 4 enterprise customization files 82– 83 defining, on user workstations 82 modifying 83 finding commands in Command List pane 96 finding search strings in 93, 95 limited/expanded searches 93 migration of older file structures to 73 modifying 68 partial CUI files 76–79, 175 adding commands to 79 controlling toolbars and 175 loading 76–77 unloading 76, 78 recommendation for directory structure 8 replacement of MNU and MNS files 52 replacing commands 98 replacing search strings 97 resetting 68 role of 49 searches 93 specifying main customization file 69 structure of 54 transferring 74

442 | Index

XML-based format 52 customization groups 50, 57, 68–69, 80 changing names 68 compared to menu groups 57 defined 50 names 69, 80 spaces in names 69 Customizations In pane 61 Customize tab (Customize User Interface editor) 77–78, 85 loading partial CUI files with 77 unloading partial CUI file with 78 Customize User Interface editor 50, 52, 60–61, 63, 73, 85, 167, 241 Command List pane 61 Customizations In pane 61 Customize tab 85 Dynamic Display pane 63 Interface tab 241 location for all customization changes 52 overview 60 special characters 167 Transfer tab 73 tree nodes 50 Customize User Interface files. See customization (CUI) files customizing 50, 52, 73, 85, 100, 112, 131, 176, 218–219, 224–225, 236 See also customization changes in 52 commands 85 customization options 52 dashboard 176 menu item labels 100 migrating older customization files 73 pointing device buttons 218 screen menus 225 status line Help messages 112 tablet buttons 219, 224 toolbars 131 overview 131 user interface, terminology for 50 workspaces 236

D dashboard 176–177, 180–189, 193–195, 250, 252 2D Draw dashboard panel 177 adding commands to panels 184 adding controls to panels 193–194 adding rows to panels 182 basing panels on toolbars 182 control panels in 176 creating panels 180 customizing 176 displaying panels 250 flyouts on panels 186 moving panels 252 moving rows in panels 184 panel interface element properties 177 previewing panels 185 rearranging items in panels 187–188 removing items from panels 188– 189 removing panels 181 removing rows from panels 183 switching controls on panels 195 dashes 25–27, 37, 39 in hatch pattern definitions 37, 39 in linetype definitions 25–27 data bytes, required to describe shapes 353 date and time formats, DIESEL function for 285 DCL (dialog control language) files 329 deactivating menus 170 Default mode shortcut menu 158 defaults 197, 241, 255 shortcut keys 197 workspaces 241, 255 defbytes 353, 422, 432 in Big Font files 422 in shape descriptions 353 in Unicode font descriptions 432 defun AutoLISP function 339–340 defun-q AutoLISP function 340

DEL key 197 using with shortcut key modifiers 197 DELAY command 312 DELAY command (in scripts) 308 deleting 87, 131, 144–145, 173, 181, 183, 188 commands 87 dashboard panel items 188 dashboard panels 181 menus 173 rows in dashboard panels 183 toolbar buttons 131, 144–145 Deployment wizard 82 designating enterprise customization files with 82 descriptions 85, 88, 135, 154, 161–162, 164, 208–209, 226, 228, 244 object shortcut menus 164 pull-down menus 154 screen menus 226, 228 shortcut menus 161–162 status line text for commands 85, 88 temporary override keys 208–209 toolbars 135 workspaces 244 DesignCenter window 239 changing properties 239 dialog boxes 229 image tile menus 229 DIESEL (Direct Interpretively Evaluated String Expression Language) 265 about 265 DIESEL expressions 5, 52, 100, 102, 114, 127, 154, 267–268, 272–275, 298 disabling/enabling menu item labels 100 error messages 298 examples 267, 272, 274 for changing menu width 274 for customizing the status line 5, 267 in macros 114, 127 in menu macros 272

443 | Index

in pull-down menu labels 274–275 marking menu item labels 102 nesting 268 pull-down menus 154 use in customization 52 using getvar in 268 using quoted strings in 268 using returned values in AutoLISP routines 273 using the dollar sign ($) in 268 DIESEL functions 268, 276–285, 287– 297 addition (+) 276 and 283 angtos 284 division (/) 278 edtime 285 eq 287 equal to (=) 279 eval 288 getenv 289 getvar 268, 290 greater than 280 greater than or equal to 282 if 291 index 291–292 less than 279 less than or equal to 282 multiplication 277 not equal to (!=) 281 nth 292 or 293 parameter limits 276 rtos 294 strlen 295 substr 295 subtraction (-) 277 upper 296 xor 297 digitizing tablets 219, 224 buttons 219, 224 Dim Style Control (Customize User Interface editor) 148, 190 dimensioning 369 text font characters required for 369

444 | Index

Direct Interpretively Evaluated String Expression Language. See DIESEL expressions directories 7–8 structure for program and support files 7–8 changing 7 recommendations for 8 directory path 7, 331, 343 for AutoLISP files 331, 343 for program and support files 7 disabling 100, 103, 105, 171 menu item labels 100, 103, 105, 171 displaying 100, 135, 167, 197, 227, 244– 245, 248, 250, 252 dashboard panels 250 dockable windows 252 list of shortcut keys 197 menu item labels 100 pull-down menus 245 screen menus 227 text in menu items 167 toolbars 135, 248 workspaces 244 division (/) DIESEL function 278 dockable windows 50, 239, 252 as interface elements 50 changing properties 239, 252 docking properties 252 list 239 size 252 transparency 252 dollar signs ($) 36, 167, 268 in DIESEL expressions 268 in hatch pattern definitions 36 in menu macros 167 dots in linetype definitions 25–27 double click actions 212, 214, 216 about 212 creating 214 editing 216 Double Click Actions node 213 double-click editing 212 dragging 52, 90, 140–142 commands onto toolbars 140–142

commands to customize interface 52 commands to reuse in other interfaces 90 Draw mode codes in shape specification bytes 357 drawing 107 button images 107 drawing interchange format (DXF) object names 158 drop-down lists 148–151, 190 adding to toolbars 148–150, 190 switching on toolbars 151 dual-orientation text font descriptions 367, 369 duplicating workspaces 254 DXF (drawing interchange format) 158, 213 names of objects in 158, 213 Dynamic Display pane 63 Dynamic Help 57

E echoes 116 suppressing, in macros 116 Edit mode shortcut menu 158 editing 83, 86, 88, 106–107, 124, 131, 146, 197, 206, 209, 212, 216, 226, 249, 252, 304 commands 86, 88, 304 slide files and 304 dockable window properties 252 double click actions for 212 enterprise CUI files 83 existing double click actions 216 screen menu properties 226 shortcut keys 197, 206 single object selection mode 124 temporary override keys 209 toolbar button images 107 toolbar button tooltips 146 toolbar buttons 106 toolbars 131, 249 edtime DIESEL function 285

element IDs 51, 85, 88 commands 85, 88 defined 51 ENTER key 116–117, 127 enterprise customization files 50, 65– 69, 80, 82–83 about 65–66 backups 66–67 creating, from existing CUI files 67 creating, from scratch 66 defined 50 defining, on user workstations 82 designating one as main customization file 69 modifying 83 overview 80 process to create 80 resetting 68 specifying location 80 ep.shx file 32 eq DIESEL function 287 equal to (=) DIESEL function 279 error messages 298, 339 AutoLISP 339 DIESEL 298 errors 52 in customization syntax 52 ESC key 123 using with shortcut key modifiers 123 eval DIESEL function 288 examples 19, 25, 29, 32, 36, 39, 43, 267, 269, 272–275, 286, 305, 308, 310, 313, 320, 327, 333–334, 336, 340, 343, 355, 361, 363– 364, 366–367, 370, 420, 423–425, 428, 430, 434 arc definitions 363–364, 366 arxload AutoLISP function 343 AutoLISP 272–273 expressions in menu items 272 routines 273 autoload AutoLISP function 333 Big Font file header 420 commands that start applications 320

445 | Index

custom-defined commands 19 DIESEL expressions 272, 274–275 in menu items 272 in pull-down menu labels 274– 275 to change menu width 274 DIESEL language macro expressions 267 dual-orientation text font descriptions 367 edtime DIESEL function 286 extended Big Fonts 423, 425 extending text fonts using Big Fonts 430 hatch pattern definitions 36, 39, 43 Kanji characters 423 Kanji primitives 424 linetype definitions 25, 32 linetypes, text characters in 29 load AutoLISP function 334, 336 loading VBA projects 327 MODEMACRO system variable 267, 269 nonstandard vectors 361 S STARTUP AutoLISP function 340 scripts 308, 310, 313 shape files 355 slide library 305 status line customization 267 STYLE command 428 superscript/subscript definitions 434 text shape definitions 370 exclamation point period (!.) 102, 104, 167 in menu item labels 102, 104, 167 executable field, in the external commands section 17 extended Big Font files 421–423, 425 defining 421 end-of-file indicator 423 examples 423, 425 extended font definition 422 fields described 422 height/width of primitives 423 shape and subshape numbers 422 X and Y origins of the primitive 422

446 | Index

external applications 4 running from within AutoCAD external commands 16–18 about 16 command field 17 defining 17–18 executable field 17 flags field 17 prompt field 18 return_code field 18

4

F FAS files 329 FILEDIA system variable 306 viewing slides and 306 finding 93, 95–96 commands in CUI files 96 search strings in CUI files 93, 95 flag vertical text code in shape specification bytes 367 flags field, in the external commands section 17 floating toolbars 135 floating windows 50, 252 as interface elements 50 orientation of 252 flyouts (in buttons) 107, 131, 136, 139– 140, 176, 186 creating 131, 136, 139–140 from another toolbar 139 from pull-down menus 140 from scratch 136 defined 131 images 107 on dashboard panels 176, 186 font files 350–351, 367, 428, 434 adding superscript/subscript definitions to 434 compiling 350–351 dual-orientation font descriptions, codes for 367 See also fonts specifying names of 428

fonts 4, 368–369, 430 character requirements for dimensioning 369 creating 4, 368 extending to include special symbols 430 See also font files shape numbers in 369 forward slash 119–120 as path delimiter in macros 120 fractional arc code in shape specification bytes 364 function keys (F1-F12) 197 using with shortcut key modifiers 197

G getenv DIESEL function 289 getvar DIESEL function 268, 290 global referencing. See relative referencing glossary of user interface terms for customization 49–50 graphical symbols in image tile menus 229 GRAPHSCR command, using in command scripts 308 graying out menu item labels 100, 103, 105 greater than DIESEL function 280 greater than or equal to DIESEL function 282 grips 130, 158 resizing, in macros 130 shortcut menu 158 GRIPS shortcut menu alias 158

H hatch patterns 35–39, 41, 43–45 about 36 creating 37, 41, 44 descriptor line 38, 41, 45 examples 36, 39, 43 format for 36 header line 37, 41, 44

line families 37 rejection of 37 rules for 36 standard library file of 35 with dashes 37, 39 with multiple lines 43 height/width of primitives, in Big Font files 422 Help 57, 112 Dynamic Help 57 messages in status line 112 hiding 131, 135, 252 dockable windows 252 toolbar buttons 131 toolbars 135 Hot Grip shortcut menu 158 hyphen 22 as prefix for command aliases 22 hyphen (-) 114, 167 command availability and 167 in macros 114 hyphens 36 in hatch pattern definitions 36

I IDE. See integrated development environment if DIESEL function 291 if-then tests, in macros 127 image tile menus 123, 173, 229, 232– 233, 302, 305 creating 233 defining 232 legacy interface elements 229 menu swapping 173 repeating commands 123 slide files and 302 image tile slide libraries 232 image tile slides 232–233 assigning for image tile menus 233 creating 232 libraries 232 viewing 232 images 106–110, 131, 229, 231 for commands 108–110

447 | Index

importing 110 on image tile menus 229, 231 suggested process 231 on toolbar buttons 106–107, 131 importing 73–74, 110, 257 customization file data 73–74 images for commands 110 workspaces 257 index DIESEL function 291–292 input in macros 119–120, 130 delay in pausing 120 pausing 119 prompting for 130 inserting 173 menus 173 integrated development environment 325, 328 VBA 325 Visual LISP 328 interface elements 50, 52, 61, 70–71, 125, 173, 175, 177, 221, 224– 225, 229 collection, as workspace 50 copying and pasting in CUI files 70 creating/editing/deleting in customization 52 dashboard panels 177 defined 50 duplicating in CUI files 71 legacy image tile menus 229 legacy screen menus 225 legacy tablet buttons 224 legacy tablet menus 221 supported for menu swapping 173 swapping 125, 175 tree view 61 interface items 50 Interface tab (Customize User Interface editor) 241 international language support 121, 420–421, 423 Japanese/Kanji 420–421, 423 macros 121

448 | Index

K Kanji primitives, examples 424 Kanji text 420–421, 423 examples 423 handling 420–421 keyboard input in macros 119 keyboard shortcuts 50, 197, 199, 204, 206 as interface elements 50 creating 197, 204 editing 197, 206 list of 199

L labels (menu items) 157 large images in command properties 85 Layer Control (Customize User Interface editor) 148, 190 legacy interface elements 49, 221, 224– 225, 229 defined 221 image tile menus 229 menus 49 MNS files 49 MNU files 49 screen menus 225 tablet buttons 224 tablet menus 221 length of macros 117 less than DIESEL function 279 less than or equal to DIESEL function 282 libraries 232 image tile slides 232 See also standard libraries library search path, for program and support files 7 limitations on macros 117 LIN (linetype library) files 24 line feed shape definition 369 Line Type Control (Customize User Interface editor), toolbar function described 148, 190

Line Weight Control (Customize User Interface editor), toolbar function described 148, 190 linetypes 23–32 about 24 alignment field (A) 26 complex 31 creating 27 dashes/dots in 25–27 description field 26 examples 25, 32 format for 25, 29, 31 including shapes in 31 including text characters in 28, 30 linetype name field 25, 27 loading 28 pattern descriptor fields 26–27 simple 25 standard library file of 23 transform field 31 List of Drawings template (Publish to Web wizard) 14–15 List Plus Summary template (Publish to Web wizard) 14–15 listing 61 commands 61 load AutoLISP function 331, 333–334, 336, 338 LOAD command 350, 355 Load option (ARX command) 342 loading 76–77, 325–326, 331–332, 342, 344 AutoLISP applications 331–332 ObjectARX applications 342, 344 partial CUI (customization) files 76– 77 VBA applications 325–326 location save/restore codes in shape specification bytes 359 LSP (AutoLISP) files 329–330

M macros

52, 85, 88, 106, 114–117, 119– 125, 127, 129–130, 197, 208–209 assigning to commands 88

assigning to temporary override keys 208–209 AutoLISP functions in 129 calling, with AutoLISP 129 character significance in 115 commands in 122 conditional expressions in 127 contents 114 creating/editing 85 defined 114 delay in pausing 120 DIESEL expressions in 127 example of components, shown in table 115 international language support 121 limitations 117 overview 114 pausing for user input 116, 119 repeating commands 123 resizing grips 130 shortcut keys and 197 Single Object Selection mode 124 special character codes for commands, table of 117 starting with toolbar buttons 106 suppressing echoes and prompts 116 swapping interface elements with 125 syntax for commands 85 terminating 116, 127 use in customization 52 user input prompts 130 Macros dialog box 325 main customization file 50, 69, 80, 241, 257 defined 50 importing workspaces 241, 257 specifying CUI files as 69 managed wrapper classes (ObjectARX) 346 marking 100, 102–105, 171 menu item labels 100, 102–105, 171 Markup Set Manager 239 changing properties of window 239 MaxHatch system registry variable 37

449 | Index

MDE. See Multiple Design Environment menu files 49 See also customization (CUI) files See also MNU (menu template) files CUI (customization) files replacement of 49 legacy menu files (MNS) 49 menu files.See customization (CUI) files menu groups. See customization groups menu item labels 100, 102–105, 171, 274 AutoLISP access to 171 controlling display 100 DIESEL expressions in 102, 274 disabling 100, 103, 105 examples 274 graying out 100, 103, 105 marking 102, 104 menu items 50, 153 as interface items 50 defining the action of. See menu macros limits on menus 153 menu LISP files. See MNL (menu LISP) files menu LISP files. See MNL files menu macros 221, 272, 321 AutoLISP expressions in 272 DIESEL expressions in 272 for tablet menus 221 starting applications from a menu/toolbar 321 menu resource files. See MNR (menu resource) files menu resource files. See MNR files menu swapping 125, 175 controlling toolbars and 175 macros and 125 menu tags 85 command names 85 menu template files See also customization (CUI) files menucmd AutoLISP function 101, 170– 171, 174 absolute referencing of menu items 171 accessing label status 171

450 | Index

enabling/disabling items from macro or application 101 inserting/removing menus 174 relative referencing of menu items 170 MENUCTL system variable 225, 227 MENUECHO system variable 116 menus 49, 61, 121, 153–154, 156–157, 162, 167, 170, 172–173, 241, 245, 247, 321 adding commands 156 captions for items 157 creating 153, 162 creating submenus 167 developed for non-English-language versions of product 121 in workspaces 154, 241 legacy interface elements 49 pull-down 154, 172, 245, 247 creating 154 displaying 245 need for swapping 172 rearranging 247 rearranging commands 61 referencing 170 removing 173 See also image tile menus See also partial customization files See also pull-down menus See also shortcut menus starting applications from 321 swapping, overview of 172 swapping. See menu swapping titles in title bars, in menu swapping 173 types of 153 migrating custom settings from previous releases 73–74 earlier customization files 73–74 migration 73 menu files to customization files 73 MNC files. See CUI (customization) files MNL (menu LISP) files 52, 129, 235, 332 loading 332 loading in Customize User Interface editor 235

named the same as main, enterprise, or partial CUI files 235 scripts for customization of interface 235 MNR (menu resource) files 52 MNS (source menu) files 49, 52, 73 See alsoCUI (customization) files migrating 73 superceding of 49, 52 MNU (template menu) files 49, 52, 73 See also CUI (customization) files migrating 73 superceding of 49, 52 MNU (template menu) files.See customization (CUI) files model space 302 slides created in 302 MODEMACRO system variable 5, 266– 269 about 5, 266 examples 267 setting values for 267, 269 string length and character limitations 266 using getvar 268 modes byte in Big Font files 422 mouse buttons 125, 212, 214, 216, 218– 219 coordinates of crosshairs 219 customizing 218 double click actions 212, 214, 216 swapping actions 125 moving 142–144, 184, 252 buttons on toolbars 142–144 dashboard panels 252 rows in dashboard panels 184 MSLIDE command 229, 232, 303 MTEXT command 350 shape files 350 multiple configurations 10 Multiple Design Environment 328 multiple-line hatch patterns 43 multiplication DIESEL function 277

N Named View Control (Customize User Interface editor) 148 Named View Control (Customize User Interface editor), toolbar function described 190 namespaces, in Visual LISP 328 naming 68, 85–86, 131, 154, 161–162, 164, 179, 208–209, 213, 226, 228, 232, 241 commands 85–86 customization groups 68 dashboard interface elements 179 image tile slides 232 object shortcut menus 164 objects 213 pull-down menus 154 screen menus 226, 228 shortcut menus 161–162 temporary override keys 208–209 toolbars 131 workspaces 241 nodes 50 Customize User Interface editor panes 50 defined 50 nonstandard vectors 361 not equal to (!=) DIESEL function 281 nth DIESEL function 292 number pad keys 197

O object names 158, 213 double click actions and 213 shortcut menus and 158 object reactors, AutoLISP and 328 object snap 119, 158 macros and 119 shortcut menus 158 ObjectARX applications 342–344 loading 342 loading automatically 344 unloading 342–343 ObjectARX environment 341

451 | Index

objects 164 adding to shortcut menus 164 octant arc code in shape specification bytes 362 octant boundaries 364 offset 30, 33, 364 in arc specifications 364 of shapes in linetypes 33 of text characters in linetypes 30 OPT Color Control (Customize User Interface editor) 148 OPT Color Control (Customize User Interface editor), toolbar function described 190 or DIESEL function 293 orientation 135, 252, 367, 369 dockable windows 252 text fonts 367, 369 toolbars 135 override keys. See temporary override keys

P paper space 302 slides created in 302 parameter limits DIESEL function 276 Partial CUI Files tree (Customize User Interface editor) 76 partial customization files 50, 52, 76– 79, 125, 175, 241 adding commands to 79 controlling toolbars 175 creating 52 defined 50 in workspaces 241 loading 76–77 swapping interface elements 125 unloading 78 partial menu files 173 swapping, syntax for 173 pasting 70, 90 commands in CUI files 90 interface elements in CUI files 70 path name. See directory path pd.shx file 32

452 | Index

pen-down lengths (dashes) in linetype definitions 25–26 pen-up lengths (spaces) in linetype definitions 25–26 period (.) 122 to access a built-in AutoCAD command 122 PFB (printer font binary) files 350–351 PICKADD system variable 119, 308, 329 command AutoLISP function and 329 macros and 119 scripts and 308 PICKAUTO system variable 119, 308, 329 command AutoLISP function and 329 macros and 119 scripts and 308 Plot Style Control (Customize User Interface editor) 148 Plot Style Control (Customize User Interface editor), toolbar function described 190 plus sign (+) 116 pointing devices 119, 125, 212, 214, 216, 218–219 coordinates of crosshairs 219 customizing 218 double click actions 212, 214, 216 in macros 119 swapping actions 125 polyarcs 365 PostScript fonts 350–351 compiling 350–351 copyright restrictions 351 presets (block insertions), menu macros and 129 princ AutoLISP function 337–338 printing 197, 210 lists 197, 210 shortcut keys 197, 210 temporary override keys 210 program files 4, 7 changing the directory structure for 7

library search path for 7 organizing 4, 7 programming interfaces 318, 322, 328, 341, 345 .NET 345 ActiveX Automation 318 AutoCAD VBA 322 AutoLISP 328 ObjectARX 341 Visual LISP 328 prompt field, in the external commands section 18 prompts 116, 130 for user input, in macros 130 suppressing, in macros 116 properties 85–86, 146, 154, 161–162, 164, 168, 177, 226, 228, 233, 238–239, 241, 244, 249, 252 commands 85–86 Dashboard panels 177 dockable windows 239, 252 image tile menus 233 object shortcut menus 164 pull-down menus 154 screen menus 226, 228 shortcut menus 161–162 submenus 168 toolbars 146, 241, 249 workspaces 238, 244 Properties palette 239 changing properties 239 Properties pane (Customize User Interface editor) 86 PTWTemplates folder 15 Publish to Web templates 14–15 creating access to 14 customizing 15 Publish to Web wizard 4 customizing a template for 4 pull-down menus 50, 153–154, 156, 170, 172–173, 245, 247, 274, 321 adding commands 156 aliases 154 as interface elements 50 cascading 173 creating 154

defined 153 displaying on menu bar 245 in workspaces 154 inserting 173 rearranging on menu bar 247 referencing 170 removing 173 starting applications from 321 swapping 172–173 AutoLISP menucmd example 173 interface elements supported 173 macro example 173 need for 172 nonconformance with Microsoft user interface guidelines 173 width of 274

Q QuickCalc calculator window 239 changing properties 239 quoted strings, in DIESEL expressions 268

R radius 363–364 in arc specifications 363–364 rearranging 184, 187, 252 dashboard panel items 187 dashboard panels 252 rows in dashboard panels 184 Redo Skinny Button Control (Customize User Interface editor) 148 Redo Skinny Button Control (Customize User Interface editor), toolbar function described 190 Reference Block Name Control (Customize User Interface editor) 148 Reference Block Name Control (Customize User Interface editor), toolbar function described 190

453 | Index

referencing menus 170, 172 defined 170 relative (global) 172 relative referencing 170 based on customization group and element ID 170 relative referencing of menus, defined 170 removing 87, 131, 144–145, 173, 181, 183, 188 commands 87 dashboard panel items 188 dashboard panels 181 menus 173 rows in dashboard panels 183 toolbar buttons 131, 144–145 repeating commands 123 in menu macros 123 replacing 97–98 commands in CUI files 98 search strings in CUI files 97 resetting 68 customization files 68 resizing 130 grips, in macros 130 restoring 67, 256 customization files 67 workspaces 256 RESUME command (in scripts) 308 return_code field, in the external commands section 18 reusing 86, 90 commands 86, 90 right-click menus. See shortcut menus rotating 30–31, 33 shapes in linetypes 31, 33 text characters in linetypes 30 rows (in dashboard panels) 176, 182– 184 adding 182 displaying 176 moving 184 removing 183 rows (in toolbars) 135 creating 135 RSCRIPT command (in scripts) 308

454 | Index

rtos DIESEL function 294 running commands, canceling (in macros) 115

S S STARTUP AutoLISP function 270, 332, 339–340 including in startup LISP files 332, 339 overwriting 340 setting the MODEMACRO variable with 270 scale factors 30, 33, 358, 369, 422 for text characters in linetypes 30 in a shape specification byte 358 linetypes 33 text objects 369, 422 SCR (script) files 307, 309 screen menus 125, 225, 227–228 adding commands 227 assigning commands 227 creating 225 displaying 227 in future releases of the product 225 showing current command 227 submenus 225, 228 swapping actions 125 SCREENBOXES system variable 225 SCRIPT command 307 scripts 5, 301–302, 307–313 about 5, 301, 307 blank spaces in 307 change settings in drawing, creating 308 comment lines in 308–309 continuously repeating 313 creating 307 DELAY command and 308, 312 displaying slides with 302 double quotes in 308 embedded spaces in file names and 308, 311 examples 308, 310, 313 GRAPHSCR command and 308 preloading slides and 312–313

RESUME command and 308 RSCRIPT command and 308 running 307 running at startup 310–311 running slide shows from 312–313 TEXTSCR command and 308 undo feature and 312 using double quotes in 311 VSLIDE command and 312 scroll bars in workspaces 244 search paths (for program files) 7 search paths (for support files) 7 searches of customization files 93, 95– 98 finding commands in Command List pane 96 finding search strings 93, 95 limited/expanded 93 overview 93 replacing commands 98 replacing search strings 97 searching 93, 95–98 CUI files 93, 95–98 finding commands in Command List pane 96 finding search strings in 93, 95 for commands and search strings 93 overview 93 replacing commands 98 replacing search strings 97 section labels 221 for tablet menus 221 SELECT command 119 semicolon 116–117, 308, 330 in AutoLISP application files 330 in command scripts 308 in macros 116–117 SHAPE command 350, 355 shape definition files 350–352, 355, 368, 419, 432 about 350 Big Font files 419 compiling 350–351 creating 350, 352 examples 355

text fonts 368 Unicode fonts and 432 shape descriptions 352–354, 356 about 352 fields described 353 shape specification byte 353–354, 356 shape names 353, 422 in Big Font files 422 in shape descriptions 353 shape numbers 353, 360, 369, 422, 433 in Big Font files 422 in extended Big Font file 422 in shape descriptions 353, 360 in text fonts 369 in Unicode fonts 433 shape specification bytes 353–354, 356– 362, 364–365, 367 about 353 bulge-specified codes for 365 Draw mode codes for 357 flag vertical text code for 367 fractional arc code for 364 location save/restore codes for 359 octant arc code for 362 size control codes for 358 special codes for 356 subshape code for 360 vector length and direction codes in 354 X-Y displacement codes for 361 shapes 4, 31, 353 creating 4 data bytes required for description of 353 including in linetypes 31 shared network location 80 enterprise customization file saved to 80 SHIFT key 218 shortcut keys 50, 197, 204, 206, 210 as interface elements 50 creating 197, 204 editing 197, 206 printing list 210 Shortcut Keys dialog box 204, 206

455 | Index

shortcut menus 153, 158, 161–162, 164, 170, 212, 214, 216, 274 aliases 158 context-sensitive shortcut menus 158 creating 161–162 defined 153, 158 double click actions 212, 214, 216 for objects 164 naming and defining properties 161 overview 158 referencing 170 width of 274 SHP (shape definition) files 350–352, 434 SHP (shape definition) fonts 350 SHX (compiled shape) files 350, 352 Single Object Selection mode, in macros 124 size control codes in shape specification bytes 358 slide files 229, 231–232 in image tile menus 229, 231–232 creating 232 suggested process 231 slide libraries 302, 305–306 about 302 creating 305 displaying a slide in 306 examples 305 slide shows 312–313 running from scripts 312–313 SLIDELIB (slide library creation) utility 305 slides 232, 301–305, 312–313 about 301–302 creating 302–303 editing commands and 304 image tile menus and 302, 305 libraries of 232 preloading 312–313 remaking 302 using command scripts with 302 using in custom menus 302 viewing 232, 302, 304 small images in command properties 85

456 | Index

source menu (MNS) files. See customization (CUI) files SPACEBAR key 116–117 spaces 25–27 in linetype definitions 25–27 specbyte. See shape specification bytes special characters 114, 117, 167 macros and commands 114, 167 table of 117 special codes for shape specification bytes 356 standard libraries 23, 35 hatch patterns 35 linetypes 23 Start (Windows system command) 18 start lines for screen menus 228 startapp AutoLISP function 320 status bar 85, 112 command text 85 Help messages 112 status line 5, 266 customizing 5, 266 MODEMACRO system variable and 266 strcat AutoLISP function 269 strlen DIESEL function 295 STYLE command 350, 368, 428 submenus 167–168, 226, 228 creating 167–168 naming and defining properties 168 screen menus 226, 228 subscripts 434 adding font definitions for 434 example 434 subshape code in shape specification bytes 360 subshape number 422 in Big Font files 422 in extended Big Font files 422 substr DIESEL function 295 subtraction (-) DIESEL function 277 superscripts 434 adding font definitions for 434 example 434

support files 4, 7 changing the directory structure for 7 library search path for 7 organizing 4, 7 support folders 7 support files in 7 suppressing 116 echoes and prompts, in macros 116 swapping 125, 172–173, 175 interface elements 125, 175 pull-down menus 172–173 AutoLISP menucmd example 173 interface elements supported 173 macro example 173 nonconformance with Microsoft user interface guidelines 173 swapping menus. See menu swapping switches. See command line switches switching 148, 151, 190, 195 controls on dashboard panels 195 toolbar controls 148, 151, 190 symbols 114, 117, 229 image tile menus 229 in macros and commands, table of 117 macros and commands 114 system variables 127 toggling values of 1 or 0, in macros 127

T t switch, running scripts and 311 TAB key 117 Table Style Control (Customize User Interface editor), toolbar function described 148, 190 tablet buttons 125, 219, 224 customizing 219, 224 swapping actions 125 TABLET command 221

tablet menus 125, 173, 221–223 creating 221 legacy interface elements 221 rows and columns 222–223 clearing 223 defining 222 sections 173 size limitations 222 swapping actions 125 templates 4, 14–15 for the Publish to Web wizard 4 Publish to Web 14–15 creating access to 14 customizing 15 temporary override keys 50, 197, 208– 210 as interface items 50 creating 197, 208 editing 197, 209 printing list 210 terminating macros 116, 127 terminators 422–423 for shape definitions 422–423 terminology for user interface customization 49–50 text characters in linetypes 28–30 examples 29 format for 29 including 28, 30 TEXT command 350, 369 text file structure, in menu files 54 compared to structure of customization files 54 text fonts. See fonts Text Style Control (Customize User Interface editor) 148 Text Style Control (Customize User Interface editor), toolbar function described 190 text styles 350, 428 defining 350, 428 TEXTSCR command, in command scripts 308 tilde (~) 100, 103 in menu item labels 100, 103

457 | Index

time/date 285 formats, DIESEL function for 285 Tool Palettes window 239 changing properties 239 toolbar buttons 50, 61, 106–107, 131, 142–146, 176 as interface items 50 creating 106 custom button images 106–107, 131 customizing toolbars 131 dashboard panels 176 deleting 144–145 editing 106 flyouts. See flyouts (in toolbar buttons) rearranging 61 repositioning 142–144 tooltips 146 toolbar flyouts. See flyouts (in toolbar buttons) toolbars 50, 61, 131, 135–136, 138–146, 148–151, 175, 182, 190, 241, 248– 249, 321 adding commands to 135, 140–142 adding controls to 149–150 aliases 146 as interface elements 50 basing dashboard panels on 182 controlling across partial CUI files 175 creating 135, 138 customizing 131 deleting buttons 144–145 displaying customized toolbars in workspaces 131, 248 editing properties of 146, 249 flyouts 136, 139–140 creating from another toolbar 139 creating from pull-down menus 140 creating from scratch 136 in workspaces 241 moving buttons 142–144 naming and defining properties 131, 135 properties of 241

458 | Index

rearranging elements on 61 See also flyouts (in toolbar buttons) See also toolbar buttons starting applications from 321 switching controls 151 table of controls for customization 148, 190 tooltips 85, 146 changing 146 command name display 85 Transfer tab (Customize User Interface editor) 73 transferring 73–74 customization files 73–74 translating macros 121 transparency 252 palettes 252 transparent commands 119 tree nodes 50 defined 50 tree view 61 new user interface elements 61 Type 1 PostScript fonts 350–351 compiling 350–351

U UCS Control (Customize User Interface editor) 148 UCS Control (Customize User Interface editor), toolbar function described 190 underscore characters (_) 121 in menu development for non-English-language versions of product 121 Undo Skinny Button Control (Customize User Interface editor) 148 Undo Skinny Button Control (Customize User Interface editor), toolbar function described 190 undoing 312 command scripts and 312 Unicode shape definition files 432–433 font encoding 432 font header syntax 432

licensing information 432 shape numbers 433 subshape references 432 unique IDs for interface elements. See element IDs Unload option of ARX command 342 unloading 76, 78 partial CUI (customization) files 76, 78 updating 73 older customization files 73 upper DIESEL function 296 user input 119 in macros 119 user interface 49–50 customization overview 49 terminology for customization 50 user-defined area on status line 266 utilities 4 running from within AutoCAD 4

V v switch, running scripts and 311 VB. See Visual Basic VB.NET programming language 346 VBA macros 325 running from the command line 325 VBA projects 324–327 example 327 loading 325 loading/running automatically 326 storing 324 VBA. See Visual Basic for Applications VBALOAD command 325 VBARUN command 325 vector length/direction in a shape specification byte 354 vectors, specification codes for 361 View Control (Customize User Interface editor) 148 View Control (Customize User Interface editor), toolbar function described 190

viewing 232, 304, 306 image tile slides 232 single slide 306 slides 304 Viewport Scale Control (Customize User Interface editor), toolbar function described 148, 190 Visual Basic for Applications 318, 322– 327 about 322 ActiveX Automation and 318, 322 advantages of 323 AutoCAD VBA and 324 developing with 322 DVB files 324, 327 loading projects 325 loading/running projects automatically 326 project compatibility issues 325 project file storage 324 Visual LISP interactive development environment 328–329 about 328 file format options 329 namespaces in 328 VLISP. See Visual LISP VLX (Visual LISP executable) files 329 VSLIDE command 304, 306, 312

W width 274 of menus, changing 274 windows 50, 239, 252 anchored 252 as interface elements 50 palettes 239, 252 Windows (operating system) 18 system commands 18 wizards 4 Publish to Web wizard 4 Workspace Contents pane (Customize User Interface editor) 239, 252 Workspace toolbar 243

459 | Index

workspaces 50, 131, 236, 238, 241, 243– 244, 248, 254–257 changing properties 238, 244 creating 241, 243 customizing 236 default 241, 255 defined 50 displaying customized toolbars 131 duplicating 254 importing to main customization file 241, 257 naming and defining properties 241 restoring 256 setting to current 255 toolbars 248 Workspaces Control (Customize User Interface editor) 148

460 | Index

Workspaces Control (Customize User Interface editor), toolbar function described 190

X X and Y origins of primitives 422 in Big Font files 422 X-Y displacement codes in shape specification bytes 361 XML-based format of CUI (customization) files 52 xor DIESEL function 297

Z z switch in macros

127

View more...

Comments

Copyright ©2017 KUPDF Inc.
SUPPORT KUPDF